SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

_________________________

FORM 6-K

REPORT OF FOREIGN ISSUER
PURSUANT TO RULE 13A-16 OR 15D-16 OF
THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

11 September 2006

Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited

ACN 005 357 522

(Translation of registrant’s name into English)

Level 6, 100 Queen Street Melbourne Victoria 3000 Australia

(Address of principal executive offices)

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant files or will file annual reports under cover of Form 20-F or Form 40-F.

Form 20-F:  ü             Form 40-F

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant by furnishing the information contained in this Form is also thereby furnishing the information to the Commission pursuant to Rule 12g3-2(b) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

Yes                            No:  ü

If “Yes” is marked, indicate below the file number assigned to the registrant in connection with Rule 12g3-2(b):

This Report on Form 6-K shall be deemed to be incorporated by reference in the prospectus included in the Registration Statement on Form F-3 (No. 333 - 113524) of Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited and to be part thereof from the date on which this Report is filed, to the extent not superseded by documents or reports subsequently filed or furnished.

This Form 6-K may contain certain forward-looking statements, including statements regarding (i) economic and financial forecasts, (ii) anticipated implementation of certain control systems and programs, (iii) the expected outcomes of legal proceedings and (iv) strategic priorities.  Such forward- looking statements are not guarantees of future performance and involve known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors, many of which are beyond our control and which may cause actual results to differ materially from those expressed in the forward-looking statement contained in these forward- looking statements.  For example, these forward-looking statements may be affected by movements in exchange rates and interest rates, general economic conditions, our ability to acquire or develop necessary technology, our ability to attract and retain qualified personnel, government regulation, the competitive environment and political and regulatory policies.  There can be no assurance that actual outcomes will not differ materially from the forward-looking statements contained in the Form 6-K.

Signatures

Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.

 

 

Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(Registrant)

 

 

 

 

 

By:

/s/ John Priestley

 

 

 

 

Company Secretary

 

 

 

 

(Signature)*

 

 

Date: 11 September 2006

* Print the name and title of the signing officer under his signature.




 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia and New Zealand
Banking Group Limited

ABN 11 005 357 522

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consolidated Financial Report

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Half Year
31 March 2006

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 




AUSTRALIA AND NEW ZEALAND BANKING GROUP LIMITED

 

ABN 11 005 357 522

 

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL REPORT
Half year ended 31 March 2006

CONTENTS

 

PAGE

 

 

 

HIGHLIGHTS

 

1

 

 

 

FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS

 

2

Net Profit

 

2

Profit on a fully comparable AIFRS basis

 

2

Cash profit

 

2

Earnings per share

 

3

Balance Sheet

 

3

Financial Ratios

 

4

Net profit by business unit

 

6

 

 

 

CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW

 

8

March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

 

8

March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

 

10

Cash profit / non core items

 

11

AIFRS 2005 adjustments

 

11

Summary of major AIFRS impacts

 

12

Reconciliation of Net Profit to Cash Profit

 

14

Income and expenses

 

15

Earnings per share

 

22

Dividends

 

23

EVA Reconciliation

 

23

Credit Risk

 

25

Market Risk

 

28

Balance Sheet

 

29

Capital Management

 

31

ANZ National Bank - Integration

 

33

ING Australia performance

 

34

ING New Zealand joint venture

 

36

Deferred acquisition costs and deferred income

 

36

Software capitalisation

 

37

 

 

 

BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW

 

38

 

 

 

GEOGRAPHIC SEGMENT PERFORMANCE

 

51

 

 

 

FOUR YEAR SUMMARY BY HALF YEAR

 

52

 

 

 

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

55

 

 

 

DEFINITIONS

 

124

 

 

 

ALPHABETICAL INDEX

 

126

 

This Results Announcement has been prepared for Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited (the “Company”) together with its subsidiaries which are variously described as “ANZ”, “Group”, “ANZ Group”, “us”, “we” or “our”.

All amounts are in Australian dollars unless otherwise stated.  The Company has a formally constituted Executive Committee of the Board of Directors.  This report was approved by resolution of a Committee of the Board of Directors on 11 September 2006.

When used in this Results Announcement the words “estimate”, “project”, “intend”, “anticipate”, “believe”, “expect”, “should” and similar expressions, as they relate to ANZ and its management, are intended to identify forward-looking statements.  Readers are cautioned not to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements, which speak only as of the date hereof.  Such statements constitute “forward-looking statements” for the purposes of the United States Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995.  ANZ does not undertake any obligation to publicly release the result of any revisions to these forward-looking statements to reflect events or circumstances after the date hereof or to reflect the occurrence of unanticipated events.




HIGHLIGHTS

ANZ interim profit $1,811 million

All figures compared to March 2005 half year unless otherwise indicated

Profit after tax

 

·

Statuatory profit $1,811 million

up 16%

·

Cash* profit $1,731 million

up 10%

·

Cash* profit before provisions

up 10%

 

Earnings per share

 

·

EPS 98.4 cents

up 18%

·

Cash* EPS 94.0 cents 1

up 10%

 

Dividend

 

·

Interim dividend 56 cents

up 10%

 

Ratios

 

·

Return on equity 20.9% (18.3%)

·

Adjusted common equity ratio stable at 5.0% 2

 

Business comment

 

·

Earnings increased 16% in Personal Banking, record lead in customer satisfaction

·

Earnings increased 14% in New Zealand and Institutional

·

Continued frontline investment with 1,231 additional FTE

·

Provision for credit impairment at cyclical low

·

Growth and Transformation program on track

 

-  Revenue* growth 8%

(target range 7% - 9%)

 

-  Cost-Income* ratio 45.8%

(1.0% improvement)

 

*

Adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items (including significant items, ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs and AIFRS mark to market of certain hedge gains/losses). Refer pages 13 and 14 of enclosed report for a detailed reconciliation of GAAP figures to non GAAP cash figures. Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believe measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations.

1.

Refer page 22

2.

Adjusted common equity is calculated as Tier 1 capital less preference shares at current rates and deductions from total capital. This measure is commonly used to assess the adequacy of common equity held. Refer page 31 for a reconciliation to Tier 1 capital

 

1




FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS

Net Profit

 

Half
year
Mar 06
$M

 

Half
year
Sep 05
$M

 

Half
year
Mar 05
$M

 

Movt
Mar 06
v. Sep 05
%

 

Movt
Mar 06
v. Mar 05
%

 

Net interest income

 

3,368

 

2,953

 

2,865

 

14%

 

18%

 

Other operating income

 

1,595

 

1,861

 

1,717

 

-14%

 

-7%

 

Operating income

 

4,963

 

4,814

 

4,582

 

3%

 

8%

 

Operating expenses

 

(2,185)

 

(2,266)

 

(2,152)

 

-4%

 

2%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

2,778

 

2,548

 

2,430

 

9%

 

14%

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

(224)

 

(296)

 

(284)

 

-24%

 

-21%

 

Profit before income tax

 

2,554

 

2,252

 

2,146

 

13%

 

19%

 

Income tax expense

 

(742)

 

(630)

 

(590)

 

18%

 

26%

 

Minority interest

 

(1)

 

(2)

 

(1)

 

-50%

 

0%

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

 

Profit on a fully comparable AIFRS basis

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the company has been amended as follows to arrive at profit on a fully comparable AIFRS basis.

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

AIFRS adjustments to bring prior periods onto a fully comparable basis1

 

N/A

 

(46)

 

15

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Profit on a fully comparable AIFRS basis1,5

 

1,811

 

1,574

 

1,570

 

15%

 

15%

 

 

Cash profit

Profit on a fully comparable AIFRS basis has been adjusted to exclude the following non-core items to arrive at cash profit. Throughout this document figures and ratios that are calculated on a ‘cash’ basis have been shaded to distinguish them from figures calculated on a statutory AIFRS basis.

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Profit on a fully comparable AIFRS basis1

 

1,811

 

1,574

 

1,570

 

15%

 

15%

 

Non-core items

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Significant items2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gain on sale of NBNZ Life

 

-

 

14

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Settlement of NBNZ warranty claims

 

14

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Settlement of NHB insurance claim

 

79

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Total significant items2

 

93

 

14

 

-

 

large

 

n/a

 

Fair value hedge gains/losses3

 

13

 

12

 

19

 

8%

 

-32%

 

NBNZ incremental integration costs after tax2,4

 

(26)

 

(35)

 

(17)

 

-26%

 

53%

 

Total non-core items

 

80

 

(9)

 

2

 

large

 

large

 

Cash profit6,7

 

1,731

 

1,583

 

1,568

 

9%

 

10%

 

 

1.

ANZ has reduced the September 2005 profit after tax by $46 million (Mar 2005: $15 million increase) to bring the result for that period to an AIFRS basis that is fully comparable with March 2006 figures (refer pages 11 to 14), allowing readers to see the impact on 2005 results of accounting standards that have only been applied from 1 October 2005. No adjustment has been made to retrospectively designate derivatives hedging the Group’s funding on the basis of impracticability

2.

In the March 2006 half ANZ has classified the $113 million ($79 million after tax) settlement of the National Housing Bank (NHB) insurance matter and the $14 million after tax settlement of warranty claims on Lloyds TSB plc (tax on warranty settlement: $nil) as significant items. In the September 2005 half ANZ classified $14 million after tax profit on the sale of NBNZ life and funds management businesses as a significant item (tax on gain on sale of NBNZ life and funds management businesses: $nil). ANZ excludes significant items to eliminate the distorting effect of one-off transactions on the results of its core business (refer page 11)

3.

In the March 2006 half ANZ has classified $13 million after tax profit (Sep 2005: $12 million; Mar 2005 $19 million) on derivatives entered into to manage interest rate and foreign exchange risk on funding instruments, not designated as accounting hedges, ineffective portions of cash flow hedges, profit or loss on disposal of investment securities, and fair value movement in bonds and notes designated at fair value as a non-core item. ANZ excludes volatility associated with fair value movements on these transactions to provide a better indication of the core business performance (tax on hedge gains/losses $5 million (Sep 2005: $5 million; Mar 2005: $8 million))

4.

In the March 2006 half ANZ has incurred $26 million after tax ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs (Sep 2005 half: $35 million; Mar 2005 half: $17 million). Tax on ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs is $13 million (Sep 2005: $18 million; Mar 2005: $8 million). ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs are excluded to better reflect the core cost base and assist analysis of the cost base following completion of the integration (refer page 11)

5.

Refer page 13 for a reconciliation of Profit on a fully comparable AIFRS basis to Net Profit

6.

Refer page 14 for a reconciliation of Cash Profit to Net Profit

7.

Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believes measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations

 

2




FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS (continued)

Cash profit, cont’d

Analysis of Cash1 profit by key line item:

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year
Mar 06
$M

 

year
Sep 05
$M

 

year
Mar 05
$M

 

Mar 06
v. Sep 05
%

 

Mar 06
v. Mar 05
%

 

Net interest income

 

3,368

 

3,231

 

3,140

 

4%

 

7%

 

Other operating income

 

1,563

 

1,528

 

1,407

 

2%

 

11%

 

Operating income

 

4,931

 

4,759

 

4,547

 

4%

 

8%

 

Operating expenses

 

(2,259)

 

(2,213)

 

(2,127)

 

2%

 

6%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

2,672

 

2,546

 

2,420

 

5%

 

10%

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

(224)

 

(325)

 

(240)

 

-31%

 

-7%

 

Profit before income tax

 

2,448

 

2,221

 

2,180

 

10%

 

12%

 

Income tax expense

 

(716)

 

(636)

 

(611)

 

13%

 

17%

 

Minority interest

 

(1)

 

(2)

 

(1)

 

-50%

 

0%

 

Cash1 profit2,3

 

1,731

 

1,583

 

1,568

 

9%

 

10%

 

Earnings per share

 

Half
year
Mar 06

 

Half
year
Sep 05

 

Half
year
Mar 05

 

Movt
Mar 06
v. Sep 05
%

 

Movt
Mar 06
v. Mar 05
%

 

Earnings per ordinary share (cents)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

98.4

 

86.3

 

83.2

 

14%

 

18%

 

Diluted

 

96.1

 

84.3

 

80.6

 

14%

 

19%

 

Cash1 (basic adjusted for non-core items)3,4

 

94.0

 

86.1

 

85.7

 

9%

 

10%

 

 

1.

ANZ has reduced the September 2005 profit after tax by $46 million (Mar 2005: $15 million increase) to bring the result for that period to an AIFRS basis that is fully comparable with March 2006 figures (refer pages 11 to 14), allowing readers to see the impact on 2005 results of accounting standards that have only been applied from 1 October 2005. No adjustment has been made to retrospectively designate derivatives hedging the Group’s funding on the basis of impracticability

 

In the March 2006 half ANZ has classified the $113 million ($79 million after tax) settlement of the NHB insurance matter and the $14 million after tax settlement of warranty claims on Lloyds TSB plc (tax on warranty settlement: $nil) as significant items. In the September 2005 half ANZ classified $14 million after tax profit on the sale of NBNZ life and funds management businesses as a significant item (tax on gain on sale of NBNZ life and funds management businesses: $nil). ANZ excludes significant items to eliminate the distorting effect of one-off transactions on the results of its core business (refer page 11)

 

In the March 2006 half ANZ has classified $13 million after tax profit (Sep 2005: $12 million; Mar 2005 $19 million) on derivatives entered into to manage interest rate and foreign exchange risk on funding instruments, not designated as accounting hedges, ineffective portions of cash flow hedges, profit or loss on disposal of investment securities, and fair value movement in bonds and notes designated at fair value as a non-core item. ANZ excludes volatility associated with fair value movements on these transactions to provide a better indication of the core business performance (tax on hedge gains/losses $5 million (Sep 2005: $5 million; Mar 2005: $8 million))

 

In the March 2006 half ANZ has incurred $26 million after tax ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs (Sep 2005 half: $35 million; Mar 2005 half: $17 million). Tax on ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs is $13 million (Sep 2005: $18 million; Mar 2005: $8 million). ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs are excluded to better reflect the core cost base and assist analysis of the cost base following completion of the integration (refer page 11)

2.

Refer page 14 for a reconciliation to Net Profit

3.

Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believes measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations

4.

Refer page 22

Balance Sheet

 

As at
Mar 06

$M

 

As at
Sep 05

$M

 

As at
Mar 05

$M

 

Movt
Mar 06
v. Sep 05
%

 

Movt
Mar 06
v. Mar 05
%

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liquid assets

 

13,870

 

11,601

 

8,856

 

20%

 

57%

 

Due from other financial institutions

 

8,336

 

6,348

 

6,428

 

31%

 

30%

 

Trading and available for sale assets

 

22,008

 

16,327

 

15,694

 

35%

 

40%

 

Net loans and advances including acceptances

 

255,238

 

245,939

 

233,316

 

4%

 

9%

 

Other

 

19,911

 

17,889

 

18,490

 

11%

 

8%

 

Total assets

 

319,363

 

298,104

 

282,784

 

7%

 

13%

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due to other financial institutions

 

13,345

 

12,027

 

10,056

 

11%

 

33%

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

196,850

 

190,322

 

185,177

 

3%

 

6%

 

Liability for acceptances

 

13,692

 

13,449

 

12,922

 

2%

 

6%

 

Bonds and notes

 

46,923

 

39,073

 

32,321

 

20%

 

45%

 

Other

 

29,757

 

23,695

 

23,381

 

26%

 

27%

 

Total liabilities

 

300,567

 

278,566

 

263,857

 

8%

 

14%

 

Total shareholders’equity

 

18,796

 

19,538

 

18,927

 

-4%

 

-1%

 

3




FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS (continued)

Financial Ratios

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

Cash1 profit

 

1,731

 

1,583

 

1,568

 

EVA TM 2

 

1,013

 

991

 

920

 

Profitability ratios

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Return on:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Average ordinary shareholders’ equity3,4

 

20.9%

 

18.3%

 

18.3%

 

Average ordinary shareholders’ equity3,4 (cash1 earnings basis)

 

20.0%

 

19.0%

 

19.0%

 

Average assets

 

1.15%

 

1.10%

 

1.14%

 

Average risk weighted assets4

 

1.60%

 

1.50%

 

1.54%

 

Average risk weighted assets4 (cash1 earnings basis)

 

1.53%

 

1.47%

 

1.55%

 

Total income4

 

14.5%

 

14.1%

 

15.0%

 

Net interest margin

 

2.29%

 

2.26%

 

2.36%

 

Net interest margin (cash1 earnings basis)

 

2.29%

 

2.36%

 

2.46%

 

Profit per average FTE ($)

 

58,202

 

53,097

 

53,161

 

Efficiency ratios

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses to operating income

 

44.0%

 

47.1%

 

47.0%

 

Operating expenses to average assets

 

1.39%

 

1.54%

 

1.57%

 

Operating expenses to operating income (cash1 earnings basis)

 

45.8%

 

46.5%

 

46.8%

 

Operating expenses to average assets (cash1 earnings basis)

 

1.44%

 

1.50%

 

1.55%

 

Credit impairment provisioning

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Collective/general provision charge ($M)

 

36

 

90

 

133

 

Individual/specific provision charge ($M)

 

188

 

206

 

151

 

Total provision charge ($M)

 

224

 

296

 

284

 

Total provision charge (on fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

224

 

325

 

240

 

Collective provision charge (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

36

 

119

 

89

 

Individual provision charge (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

188

 

206

 

151

 

Ordinary share dividends (cents)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interim - 100% franked (Mar 05: 100% franked)

 

56

 

n/a

 

51

 

Final - 100% franked

 

N/A

 

59

 

n/a

 

Ordinary share dividend payout ratio5

 

56.9%

 

68.4%

 

61.3%

 

Cash1 ordinary share dividend payout ratio5

 

59.6%

 

68.6%

 

59.5%

 

Preference share dividend

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dividend paid ($M)6

 

12

 

46

 

38

 

Dividend paid ($M)7 (on fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

12

 

12

 

6

 

 

1.

Adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items. Refer footnote 1 page 3. Refer pages 13 and 14 of enclosed report for a detailed reconciliation of GAAP figures to non GAAP cash figures. Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believe measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations.

2.

EVATM refers to Economic Value Added, a measure of shareholder value. See page 23 for a reconciliation of EVATM to reported net profit and a discussion of EVATM and an explanation of its usefulness as a performance measure

3.

Average ordinary shareholders’ equity excludes minority interest

4.

Excludes preference share dividend

5.

Dividend payout ratio is calculated using the proposed interim dividend as at 31 March 2006 and the 30 September 2005 and 31 March 2005 dividends

6.

2005 includes distributions on ANZ StEPS (Sep 2005: $34 million; Mar 2005: $32 million). Under AIFRS, distributions on ANZ StEPS are reported as interest expense in March 2006

7.

Represents dividends paid on Euro Hybrid

4




FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS (continued)

Financial Ratios, cont’d

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Net Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net tangible assets1 per ordinary share ($)

 

8.00

 

7.77

 

7.38

 

3%

 

8%

 

Net tangible assets1 attributable to ordinary shareholders ($M)

 

14,622

 

14,199

 

13,443

 

3%

 

9%

 

Total number of ordinary shares (M)

 

1,828.7

 

1,826.4

 

1,822.7

 

0%

 

0%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Capital adequacy ratio (%)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tier 1

 

6.8%

 

6.9%

 

7.0%

 

 

 

 

 

Tier 2

 

4.0%

 

3.9%

 

3.6%

 

 

 

 

 

Total capital ratio

 

10.4%

 

10.5%

 

10.3%

 

 

 

 

 

Adjusted common equity ratio2

 

5.0%

 

5.1%

 

5.1%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Impaired assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Collective/general provision ($M)

 

1,903

 

2,167

 

2,080

 

-12%

 

-9%

 

Collective/general provision as a % of risk weighted assets

 

0.83%

 

0.99%

 

0.99%

 

 

 

 

 

Collective/general provision3 on fully comparable AIFRS basis ($M)

 

1,903

 

1,879

 

1,768

 

1%

 

8%

 

Collective/general provision3 on fully comparable AIFRS basis

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

as a % of risk weighted assets

 

0.83%

 

0.86%

 

0.84%

 

 

 

 

 

Gross impaired loans ($M)

 

726

 

642

 

640

 

13%

 

13%

 

Individual provisions on impaired loans4 ($M)

 

(305)

 

(256)

 

(314)

 

19%

 

-3%

 

Net impaired loans

 

421

 

386

 

326

 

9%

 

29%

 

Individual provision as a % of total impaired loans

 

42.0%

 

39.9%

 

49.1%

 

 

 

 

 

Gross impaired loans as % of net advances

 

0.28%

 

0.26%

 

0.27%

 

 

 

 

 

Net impaired loans as a % of net advances

 

0.16%

 

0.16%

 

0.14%

 

 

 

 

 

Net impaired loans as a % of shareholders’ equity5

 

2.2%

 

2.0%

 

1.7%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other information

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Full time equivalent staff (FTEs)

 

31,063

 

30,976

 

29,832

 

0%

 

4%

 

Assets per FTE ($M)

 

10.3

 

9.6

 

9.5

 

7%

 

8%

 

Market capitalisation of ordinary shares ($M)

 

48,461

 

43,834

 

37,584

 

11%

 

29%

 

 

1.

Equals Shareholders’ equity less preference share capital, minority interest and unamortised intangibles

2.

Adjusted common equity is calculated as Tier 1 capital less preference shares at current rates and deductions from total capital. This measure is commonly used to assess the adequacy of common equity held. See page 31 for a reconciliation to Tier 1 capital

3.

Refer footnote 1 page 3. Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believes measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations

4.

Excludes individual provision on unproductive facilities

5.

Includes minority interest

5




FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS (continued)

Net profit by business unit

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v Sep 05

 

v Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net profit after income tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

542

 

485

 

468

 

12%

 

16%

 

Institutional

 

486

 

461

 

450

 

5%

 

8%

 

New Zealand Business

 

335

 

265

 

295

 

26%

 

14%

 

Corporate Australia

 

212

 

194

 

182

 

9%

 

16%

 

Esanda and UDC

 

53

 

55

 

66

 

-4%

 

-20%

 

Asia Pacific

 

46

 

44

 

39

 

5%

 

18%

 

Non continuing business

 

30

 

63

 

63

 

-52%

 

-52%

 

Group centre

 

107

 

53

 

(8)

 

large

 

large

 

Net profit

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net profit after income tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

542

 

485

 

468

 

12%

 

16%

 

Institutional

 

486

 

461

 

450

 

5%

 

8%

 

New Zealand Businesses

 

335

 

265

 

295

 

26%

 

14%

 

Corporate Australia

 

212

 

194

 

182

 

9%

 

16%

 

Esanda and UDC

 

53

 

55

 

66

 

-4%

 

-20%

 

Asia Pacific

 

46

 

44

 

39

 

5%

 

18%

 

Non-continuing businesses

 

30

 

63

 

63

 

-52%

 

-52%

 

Group Centre

 

27

 

16

 

5

 

69%

 

large

 

Cash1 profit

 

1,731

 

1,583

 

1,568

 

9%

 

10%

 

AIFRS 2005 adjustments1 and non-core items1

 

80

 

37

 

(13)

 

large

 

large

 

Net profit

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

 

1.

Refer footnote 1 page 3. Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believes measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations

Net loans and advances including acceptances by business unit

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

112,212

 

105,681

 

99,681

 

6%

 

13%

 

Institutional

 

46,344

 

43,404

 

40,168

 

7%

 

15%

 

New Zealand Businesses1

 

55,441

 

55,152

 

52,094

 

1%

 

6%

 

Corporate Australia

 

23,941

 

22,793

 

21,655

 

5%

 

11%

 

Esanda and UDC

 

14,365

 

14,186

 

13,749

 

1%

 

4%

 

Asia Pacific

 

2,069

 

1,777

 

1,615

 

16%

 

28%

 

Non-continuing businesses

 

822

 

1,584

 

3,091

 

-48%

 

-73%

 

Group Centre

 

44

 

1,362

 

1,263

 

-97%

 

-97%

 

Net loans and advances including acceptances

 

255,238

 

245,939

 

233,316

 

4%

 

9%

 

 

1.

New Zealand businesses growth rates in NZD terms were 7% and 14% on September 2005 and March 2005 respectively

 

6




FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS (continued)

Deposits and other borrowings by business unit

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

46,261

 

43,773

 

41,750

 

6%

 

11%

 

Institutional

 

36,205

 

32,403

 

31,886

 

12%

 

14%

 

New Zealand Businesses1

 

42,127

 

46,078

 

46,470

 

-9%

 

-9%

 

Corporate Australia

 

18,987

 

18,091

 

17,070

 

5%

 

11%

 

Esanda and UDC

 

13,409

 

12,907

 

12,167

 

4%

 

10%

 

Asia Pacific

 

6,032

 

5,602

 

5,305

 

8%

 

14%

 

Other

 

33,829

 

31,432

 

29,883

 

8%

 

13%

 

Non-continuing businesses

 

-

 

36

 

647

 

-100%

 

-100%

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

196,850

 

190,322

 

185,177

 

3%

 

6%

 

 

1.

New Zealand businesses growth rates in NZD terms were -3% and -3% on September 2005 and March 2005 respectively

 

7




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW

March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

ANZ recorded a profit after tax of $1,811 million for the half year ended 31 March 2006, an increase of 12% over the September 2005 half year.  After adjusting for AIFRS 2005 adjustments1 and non-core items1 referred to on pages 11 to 14, cash1 profit increased 9% to $1,731 million.  Earnings per share increased 14.0% to 98.4 cents over the September 2005 half.  After adjusting AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items1 Cash EPS increased 9.2% to 94.0 cents.

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

AIFRS 2005 Adjustments1

 

N/A

 

(46)

 

15

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Profit on a fully comparable AIFRS basis

 

1,811

 

1,574

 

1,570

 

15%

 

15%

 

Less: Non-core items1

 

(80

)

9

 

(2)

 

large

 

large

 

Cash1 profit

 

1,731

 

1,583

 

1,568

 

9%

 

10%

 

Net profit

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net interest income

 

3,368

 

2,953

 

2,865

 

14%

 

18%

 

Other operating income

 

1,595

 

1,861

 

1,717

 

-14%

 

-7%

 

Operating income

 

4,963

 

4,814

 

4,582

 

3%

 

8%

 

Operating expenses

 

(2,185)

 

(2,266)

 

(2,152)

 

-4%

 

2%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

2,778

 

2,548

 

2,430

 

9%

 

14%

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

(224)

 

(296)

 

(284)

 

-24%

 

-21%

 

Profit before income tax

 

2,554

 

2,252

 

2,146

 

13%

 

19%

 

Income tax expense

 

(742)

 

(630)

 

(590)

 

18%

 

26%

 

Minority interest

 

(1)

 

(2)

 

(1)

 

-50%

 

0%

 

Net Profit

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

 

1.

ANZ has reduced the September 2005 profit after tax by $46 million (Mar 2005: $15 million increase) to bring the result for that period to an AIFRS basis that is fully comparable with March 2006 figures (refer page 11 to 14), allowing readers to see the impact on 2005 results of accounting standards that have only been applied from 1 October 2005. No adjustment has been made to retrospectively designate derivatives hedging the Group’s funding on the basis of impracticability

 

In the March 2006 half ANZ has classified the $113 million ($79 million after tax) settlement of the NHB insurance matter and the $14 million after tax settlement of warranty claims on Lloyds TSB plc (tax on warranty settlement: $nil) as significant items. In the September 2005 half ANZ classified $14 million after tax profit on the sale of NBNZ life and funds management businesses as a significant item (tax on gain on sale of NBNZ life and funds management businesses: $nil). ANZ excludes significant items to eliminate the distorting effect of one-off transactions on the results of its core business (refer page 11)

 

In the March 2006 half ANZ has classified $13 million after tax profit (Sep 2005: $12 million; Mar 2005 $19 million) on economic hedges as a non-core item. ANZ excludes volatility associated with fair value movements on these transactions to provide a better indication of the core business performance (tax on hedge gains/losses $5 million (Sep 2005: $5 million; Mar 2005: $8 million))

 

In the March 2006 half ANZ has incurred $26 million after tax ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs (Sep 2005 half: $35 million; Mar 2005 half: $17 million). Tax on ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs is $13 million (Sep 2005: $18 million; Mar 2005: $8 million). ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs are excluded to better reflect the core cost base and assist analysis of the cost base following completion of the integration (refer page 11)

Profit growth

Profit increased 12% to $1,811 million.  Revenue increased 14% with volume growth partly offset by reduced margins (-7 basis points).  Operating expense growth was contained to 2%.

Profit in Australia increased 8% over the September 2005 half year with strong growth in Personal (12%) and Corporate (9%).  Profit in Esanda reduced 9%.

Profit in New Zealand increased 24% (25% in NZD terms) with higher lending volumes, a strong performance in the Markets business in Institutional, lower provisions in Corporate Banking and increased earnings on additional equity capital.  These increases were partly offset by reduced earnings in UDC and lower earnings in non-continuing businesses from certain structured finance transactions which have been exited. Profit in Asia Pacific increased 9%, driven by volume growth in Fiji, PNG and the Indonesian cards business being partly offset by lower earnings from PT Panin Bank.

Profit in the UK and US decreased driven by reduced profit in non-continuing businesses with the sale of the London headquartered project finance business in 2005 and repatriation of capital.

8




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

 

Cash1 profit

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net interest income

 

3,368

 

3,231

 

3,140

 

4%

 

7%

 

Other operating income

 

1,563

 

1,528

 

1,407

 

2%

 

11%

 

Operating income

 

4,931

 

4,759

 

4,547

 

4%

 

8%

 

Operating expenses

 

(2,259)

 

(2,213)

 

(2,127)

 

2%

 

6%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

2,672

 

2,546

 

2,420

 

5%

 

10%

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

(224)

 

(325)

 

(240)

 

-31%

 

-7%

 

Profit before income tax

 

2,448

 

2,221

 

2,180

 

10%

 

12%

 

Income tax expense

 

(716)

 

(636)

 

(611)

 

13%

 

17%

 

Minority interest

 

(1)

 

(2)

 

(1)

 

-50%

 

0%

 

Cash1 profit2,3

 

1,731

 

1,583

 

1,568

 

9%

 

10%

 

 

1.

ANZ has reduced the September 2005 profit after tax by $46 million (Mar 2005: $15 million increase) to bring the result for that period to an AIFRS basis that is fully comparable with March 2006 figures (refer page 11 to 14), allowing readers to see the impact on 2005 results of accounting standards that have only been applied from 1 October 2005. No adjustment has been made to retrospectively designate derivatives hedging the Group’s funding on the basis of impracticability

 

In the March 2006 half ANZ has classified the $113 million ($79 million after tax) settlement of the NHB insurance matter and the $14 million after tax settlement of warranty claims on Lloyds TSB plc (tax on warranty settlement: $nil) as significant items. In the September 2005 half ANZ classified $14 million after tax profit on the sale of NBNZ life and funds management businesses as a significant item (tax on gain on sale of NBNZ life and funds management businesses: $nil). ANZ excludes significant items to eliminate the distorting effect of one-off transactions on the results of its core business (refer page 11)

 

In the March 2006 half ANZ has classified $13 million after tax profit (Sep 2005: $12 million; Mar 2005 $19 million) on economic hedges as a non-core item. ANZ excludes volatility associated with fair value movements on these transactions to provide a better indication of the core business performance (tax on hedge gains/losses $5 million (Sep 2005: $5 million; Mar 2005: $8 million))

 

In the March 2006 half ANZ has incurred $26 million after tax ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs (Sep 2005 half: $35 million; Mar 2005 half: $17 million). Tax on ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs is $13 million (Sep 2005: $18 million; Mar 2005: $8 million). ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs are excluded to better reflect the core cost base and assist analysis of the cost base following completion of the integration (refer page 11)

2.

Refer page 14 for a reconciliation to Net Profit

3.

Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believes measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations.

Profit growth

Cash profit increased 9% to $1,731 million.  Core1 revenue increased 4% with volume growth partly offset by reduced margins (-7 basis points).  Operating expense growth was contained to 2%.

Cash profit in Australia increased 6% over the September 2005 half year with strong growth in Personal (12%) and Corporate (9%).  Profit in Esanda reduced 9%.

Cash profit in New Zealand increased 31% (32% in NZD terms) with higher lending volumes, a strong performance in the Markets business in Institutional, lower provisions in Corporate Banking and increased earnings on additional equity capital.  These increases were partly offset by reduced earnings in UDC and lower earnings in non-continuing businesses from certain structured finance transactions which have been exited. Profit in Asia Pacific increased 7%, driven by volume growth in Fiji, PNG and the Indonesian cards business being partly offset by lower earnings from PT Panin Bank.

Profit in the UK and US decreased driven by reduced profit in non-continuing businesses with the sale of the London headquartered project finance business in 2005 and repatriation of capital.

9




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

 

March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year, cont’d

Profit drivers

Profit after tax increased 12% over the September 2005 half year.  Cash1 profit increased 9% over the September 2005 half.  For a discussion of the impact of non-core items and AIFRS 2005 adjustments refer pages 11 to 14.

Significant influences on profit are shown below.

Net interest ñ14% - Adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items1 ñ4%:

Net interest income was driven by growth of 6% in interest earning assets, particularly in Institutional (13%), Personal (6%) largely in Mortgages, New Zealand businesses (5%) and Asia Pacific (29%), and deposit growth in Personal (4%), Corporate (5%) and Asia Pacific (9%).  Volume growth was partly offset by a 7 basis point decline in margin.

Other income ò14% - Adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items1 ñ2%:

Other income growth was driven by volume-related growth in fees and higher profit on trading securities with a strong March half result in New Zealand.  These increases were partly offset by reduced foreign exchange income, lower equity accounted income in PT Panin and reduced income in Esanda largely from a reduction in residual values of leased vehicles.  Other income is seasonally weaker in the September half.

Operating expenses ò4% - Adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items1 ñ2%:

Operating expenses increased slightly reflecting a 2% increase in average staff numbers, largely in Personal and Institutional, offset by reduced costs in the Group Centre.

Provision for credit impairment ò24% - Adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items1 ò31%:

The reduction in Provision for credit impairment reflected the Group’s strengthening risk profile.  Individual provisions reduced $18 million with a lower number of large single name losses and low levels of default in New Zealand.  This was partly offset by the September 2005 half including several large write-backs and recoveries.  Collective provisions reduced $83 million, with a lower provision for oil price shock risk.

Income tax ñ18% - Adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items1 ñ13%:

The increase in tax expense is driven by growth in profit before tax and a 0.6% increase in the effective tax rate following the run-off of certain structured financing transactions and higher earnings in higher tax rate jurisdictions.

Exchange rates ñ1%

The depreciation of the AUD has resulted in a $5 million increase in the contribution from earnings denominated in foreign currencies, principally New Zealand (net of profit on contracts put in place to hedge USD and NZD revenues).  Whilst the average NZD exchange rate moved by only 1%, the closing rate had depreciated by 6% with a corresponding impact on the balance sheet.

 

1

Refer footnote 1 on page 8

March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

The Group recorded a profit after tax of $1,811 million for the half year ended 31 March 2006, an increase of 16% over the March 2005 half.  Cash profit increased 10% over the March 2005 half.

Basic earnings per share increased 18% (15.2 cents) to 98.4 cents.  Cash earnings per share (refer page 22) increased 10% (8.3 cents) to 94.0 cents.

Revenue increased 8%.  After adjusting for AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items, net interest increased 7% with a 14% increase in average interest earning asset volumes partly offset by a 17 basis point reduction in margin.  Other operating income increased 11% with a strong performance in Institutional.  Operating costs increased 6% driven by investment in staff principally in 2005.

After adjusting for AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items, cash profit in Australia increased 9%, driven by 16% growth in Personal and 16% growth in Corporate.  Cash profit in New Zealand increased 16% in NZD terms including 8% as a result of a lower credit impairment charge.  Profit increased by 14% in New Zealand Businesses, 8% in Institutional and higher earnings on capital offset reduced profit in UDC and non-continuing businesses.  Cash profit in the Asia Pacific geographies increased 26% with volume related growth and lower credit impairment provisioning.  Other geographies reduced 10% reflecting the sale of the London headquartered project finance business in 2005.

10




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

 

Cash profit / non-core items

In calculating cash profit, ANZ has adjusted the income statement for non-core items, as outlined below, to assist readers in understanding the core business performance by removing the volatility in reported results created by one-off significant items, ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs which will not be incurred going forward, the timing differences in the recognition of fair value gains in profit on hedging contracts and the move to the Australian equivalents of International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS) which has resulted in different recognition criteria in the March 2006 half than used in the 2005 financial year.

Non-core items in the profit and loss

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

05

 

05

 

Significant items

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Gain on sale of NBNZ Life

 

-

 

14

 

-

 

-100%

 

n/a

 

Settlement of NBNZ warranty claims

 

14

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Settlement of NHB insurance claim

 

79

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Total significant items

 

93

 

14

 

-

 

large

 

n/a

 

Fair value hedge gains/losses

 

13

 

12

 

19

 

8%

 

-32%

 

NBNZ incremental integration costs after tax

 

(26)

 

(35)

 

(17)

 

-26%

 

53%

 

Non-core items

 

80

 

(9)

 

2

 

large

 

large

 

§                     Significant items

Significant items in the profit and loss are those items that management believe do not form part of the core business by virtue of their magnitude and infrequent nature and, as such, should be removed from profit when analysing the core business performance.  The following are considered significant items:

-                     Settlement of the NHB insurance claim (March 2006 half year)

During the March 2006 half ANZ settled its $130 million claim with a number of reinsurers over the 1992 and 2002 National Housing Bank (NHB) matter.  ANZ has reported the $113 million ($79 million after tax) cost recovery as a significant item in 2006.  $1 million was received in 2005 and not treated as significant as it was immaterial.

-                     Settlement of ANZ National Bank warranty claims (March 2006 half year)

As part of the purchase of the National Bank of New Zealand on 1 December 2003, Lloyds TSB provided ANZ with certain warranties.  A claim was made under these warranties in relation to the accounting treatment in the Completion Accounts of the provision for retirement gratuities.  As a result of the mediation of this claim, ANZ National Bank received in the March 2006 half $14 million pre-tax revenue ($14 million after tax) on final settlement of the claim.

-                     Sale of NBNZ Life and Funds Management (September 2005 half year)

On 30 September 2005 ANZ National Bank sold NBNZ Life and Funds Management businesses into a joint venture with ING.  Profit after tax on sale of $14 million was recognised.

§                     ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs

Expenditure on the integration of ANZ National Bank includes both the reallocation of existing resources to integration and incremental integration costs.  Incremental costs are those costs that will not recur once integration is complete and thus do not form part of the core ongoing cost base.  During the March 2006 half year $26 million after tax (Sep 2005 half: $35 million; Mar 2005: $17 million) or $39 million before tax (Sep 2005 half: $53 million; Mar 2005 half: $25 million) of incremental integration costs were incurred.  This program is now complete.

§                     Fair Value hedging gains

As at 1 October 2005, the Group has designated certain fair value hedges and financial liabilities as fair value through profit and loss.  Any hedge ineffectiveness will result in volatility through the Income Statement.  ANZ has separately reported the impact of volatility due to hedge ineffectiveness as a non-core item as the profit reported on hedge transactions will reverse over time and as such is not part of the core operating performance.  During the March 2006 half year $13 million (Sep 2005: $12 million; Mar 2005: $19 million) after tax or $18 million (Sep 2005: $17 million; Mar 2005: $27 million) before tax profit has been reported as a non-core item.

AIFRS 2005 adjustments

The Group implemented accounting policies in accordance with AIFRS on 1 October 2004, except for those relating to financial instruments and insurance contracts, which were implemented on 1 October 2005.  The 2005 comparatives for these standards have not been restated in the statutory accounts.  To assist readers understand the core business performance on a comparable basis, ANZ has adjusted the 2005 figures to be comparable with the March 2006 half year result within the Chief Financial Officer’s and Business Performance Reviews.  The major adjustments are to the provision for credit impairment and recognition of fees as effective yield adjustments to net interest.  No adjustment has been made to retrospectively designate derivatives hedging the Group’s funding on the basis of impracticability and as there is no impact on cash.  Ineffectiveness on these hedges was trivial on the March 2006 half year.

11




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

 

Summary of major AIFRS impacts

The following table reconciles fully comparable AIFRS values with equivalents calculated under previous AGAAP.

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income (previous AGAAP)

 

3,069

 

2,945

 

2,853

 

4%

 

8%

 

Fees recognised as an adjustment to yield1

 

318

 

313

 

309

 

2%

 

3%

 

Reclassified hybrid financial instruments2

 

(33)

 

(34)

 

(32)

 

-3%

 

3%

 

Securitisation and SPVs

 

16

 

9

 

12

 

78%

 

33%

 

Amortisation of StEPS issue costs

 

(2)

 

(2)

 

(2)

 

0%

 

0%

 

Net interest income (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

3,368

 

3,231

 

3,140

 

4%

 

7%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other operating income (previous AGAAP)

 

1,872

 

1,848

 

1,704

 

1%

 

10%

 

Fees recognised as an adjustment to yield1

 

(300)

 

(326)

 

(309)

 

-8%

 

-3%

 

Derivatives and hedging3

 

18

 

17

 

27

 

6%

 

-33%

 

Notional goodwill amortisation in joint ventures and associates4

 

22

 

22

 

23

 

0%

 

-4%

 

Securitisation and SPVs

 

(11)

 

(8)

 

(11)

 

38%

 

0%

 

Accounting for INGA

 

(6)

 

6

 

-

 

large

 

n/a

 

Other operating income (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

1,595

 

1,559

 

1,434

 

2%

 

11%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income (previous AGAAP)

 

4,941

 

4,793

 

4,557

 

3%

 

8%

 

Total AIFRS income adjustments

 

22

 

(3)

 

17

 

large

 

29%

 

Operating income (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

4,963

 

4,790

 

4,574

 

4%

 

9%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses (previous AGAAP)

 

(2,233)

 

(2,315)

 

(2,200)

 

-4%

 

2%

 

Goodwill amortisation5

 

90

 

92

 

87

 

-2%

 

3%

 

Share based payments expense6

 

(38)

 

(41)

 

(39)

 

-7%

 

-3%

 

Other

 

(4)

 

(2)

 

-

 

100%

 

n/a

 

Operating expenses (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

(2,185)

 

(2,266)

 

(2,152)

 

-4%

 

2%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax (previous AGAAP)

 

2,708

 

2,478

 

2,357

 

9%

 

15%

 

Total AIFRS adjustments (net total of identified above)

 

70

 

46

 

65

 

52%

 

8%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

2,778

 

2,524

 

2,422

 

10%

 

15%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for credit impairment (previous AGAAP)

 

(334)

 

(296)

 

(284)

 

13%

 

18%

 

Movement in credit impairment provisioning7

 

110

 

(29)

 

44

 

large

 

large

 

Provision for credit impairment (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

(224)

 

(325)

 

(240)

 

-31%

 

-7%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Profit before income tax (previous AGAAP)

 

2,374

 

2,182

 

2,073

 

9%

 

15%

 

Total AIFRS profit before income tax adjustments

 

180

 

17

 

109

 

large

 

65%

 

Profit before income tax (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

2,554

 

2,199

 

2,182

 

16%

 

17%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income tax expense and minority interest (previous AGAAP)

 

(709)

 

(639)

 

(598)

 

11%

 

19%

 

Tax on AIFRS adjustments

 

(34

)

14

 

(14)

 

large

 

large

 

Income tax expense and minority interest (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

(743)

 

(625)

 

(612)

 

19%

 

21%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net profit (previous AGAAP)

 

1,665

 

1,543

 

1,475

 

8%

 

13%

 

AIFRS net profit adjustments

 

146

 

31

 

95

 

large

 

54%

 

Net profit (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

1,811

 

1,574

 

1,570

 

15%

 

15%

 

 

1.

Reclassification of fees and commissions against interest income and measured on the effective yield basis

2.

Reclassification of interest expense on reclassification of ANZ StEPS from equity to debt

3.

Measuring derivatives on a fair value basis and the reclassification of interest expense on non-hedged derivatives to other income

4.

Reversal of notional goodwill amortisation reflected in the take-up of equity accounted earnings of associates and joint ventures

5.

Reversal of goodwill amortisation, goodwill now subject to impairment testing

6.

Share based payments expense recognised for the period covering all share based remuneration, including deferred shares and options

7.

Refer page 26 - Economic loss provisioning

12




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

 

Summary of major AIFRS impacts, cont’d

The following table reconciles comparative AIFRS (statutory) numbers with equivalent figures on a fully comparable AIFRS basis, including the impact of AASB 139.

 

Half

 

Half

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

 

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

Net interest income (statutory basis)

 

2,953

 

2,865

 

Fees recognised as an adjustment to yield1

 

313

 

309

 

Reclassified hybrid financial instruments2

 

(34)

 

(32)

 

Other

 

(1)

 

(2)

 

Net interest income (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

3,231

 

3,140

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other operating income (statutory basis)

 

1,861

 

1,717

 

Fees recognised as an adjustment to yield1

 

(326)

 

(309)

 

Derivatives and hedging3

 

17

 

27

 

Other

 

7

 

(1)

 

Other operating income (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

1,559

 

1,434

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income (statutory basis)

 

4,814

 

4,582

 

Total AIFRS income adjustments

 

(24)

 

(8)

 

Operating income (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

4,790

 

4,574

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses (statutory basis)

 

(2,266)

 

(2,152)

 

Other

 

-

 

-

 

Operating expenses (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

(2,266)

 

(2,152)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax (statutory basis)

 

2,548

 

2,430

 

Total AIFRS adjustments (net total of identified above)

 

(24)

 

(8)

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

2,524

 

2,422

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for credit impairment (statutory basis)

 

(296)

 

(284)

 

Movement in credit impairment provisioning4

 

(29)

 

44

 

Provision for credit impairment (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

(325)

 

(240)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Profit before income tax (statutory basis)

 

2,252

 

2,146

 

Total AIFRS profit before income tax adjustments

 

(53)

 

36

 

Profit before income tax (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

2,199

 

2,182

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income tax expense and minority interest (statutory basis)

 

(632)

 

(591)

 

Tax on AIFRS adjustments

 

7

 

(21)

 

Income tax expense and minority interest (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

(625)

 

(612)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net profit (statutory basis)

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

AIFRS net profit adjustments

 

(46)

 

15

 

Net profit (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

1,574

 

1,570

 

 

1.

Reclassification of fees and commissions against interest income and measured on the effective yield basis

2.

Reclassification of interest expense on reclassification of ANZ StEPS from equity to debt

3.

Measuring derivatives on a fair value basis and the reclassification of interest expense on non-hedged derivatives to other income

4.

Restatement of credit loss provisions for an ELP basis under previous AGAAP

13




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Reconciliation of Net Profit to Cash Profit

The following table reconciles fully comparable AIFRS values with equivalents calculated under previous AGAAP and with fully comparable AIFRS values adjusted to exclude non core items8

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Net interest income (statutory basis)

 

3,368

 

2,953

 

2,865

 

Fees recognised as an adjustment to yield1

 

-

 

313

 

309

 

Reclassified hybrid financial instruments2

 

-

 

(34

)

(32

)

Other

 

-

 

(1

)

(2

)

Net interest income (cash basis)

 

3,368

 

3,231

 

3,140

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other operating income (statutory basis)

 

1,595

 

1,861

 

1,717

 

Fees recognised as an adjustment to yield1

 

-

 

(326

)

(309

)

Derivatives and hedging3

 

-

 

17

 

27

 

Other

 

-

 

7

 

(1

)

Other operating income (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

1,595

 

1,559

 

1,434

 

Settlement of NBNZ warranty claims4

 

(14

)

-

 

-

 

Fair value hedge gains/losses5

 

(18

)

(17

)

(27

)

Gain on sale of NBNZ Life4

 

-

 

(14

)

-

 

Other operating income (cash basis)

 

1,563

 

1,528

 

1,407

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating income (statutory basis)

 

4,963

 

4,814

 

4,582

 

Total AIFRS income adjustments

 

-

 

(24

)

(8

)

Operating income (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

4,963

 

4,790

 

4,574

 

Total significant items income adjustments

 

(32

)

(31

)

(27

)

Operating income (cash basis)

 

4,931

 

4,759

 

4,547

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses (statutory basis)

 

(2,185

)

(2,266

)

(2,152

)

NBNZ incremental integration costs6

 

39

 

53

 

25

 

Settlement of NHB insurance claim4

 

(113

)

-

 

-

 

Operating expenses (cash basis)

 

(2,259

)

(2,213

)

(2,127

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax (statutory basis)

 

2,778

 

2,548

 

2,430

 

Total AIFRS adjustments (net total identified above)

 

-

 

(24

)

(8

)

Profit before credit impairment and income tax (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

2,778

 

2,524

 

2,422

 

Total significant items adjustments (net total identified above)

 

(106

)

22

 

(2

)

Profit before credit impairment and income tax (cash basis)

 

2,672

 

2,546

 

2,420

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for credit impairment (statutory basis)

 

(224

)

(296

)

(284

)

Movement in credit impairment provisioning7

 

-

 

(29

)

44

 

Provision for credit impairment (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

(224

)

(325

)

(240

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for credit impairment (cash basis)

 

(224

)

(325

)

(240

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Profit before income tax (statutory basis)

 

2,554

 

2,252

 

2,146

 

Total AIFRS profit before income tax adjustments

 

-

 

(53

)

36

 

Profit before income tax (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

2,554

 

2,199

 

2,182

 

Total significant items before income tax adjustments

 

(106

)

22

 

(2

)

Profit before income tax (cash basis)

 

2,448

 

2,221

 

2,180

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Income tax expense and minority interest (statutory basis)

 

(743

)

(632

)

(591

)

Tax on AIFRS adjustments

 

-

 

7

 

(21

)

Income tax expense and minority interest (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

(743

)

(625

)

(612

)

Tax on significant items adjustments

 

26

 

(13

)

 

 

Income tax expense and minority interest (cash basis)

 

(717

)

(638

)

(612

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net profit (statutory basis)

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

AIFRS net profit adjustments

 

-

 

(46

)

15

 

Net profit (fully comparable AIFRS basis)

 

1,811

 

1,574

 

1,570

 

Significant items net profit adjustments

 

(80

)

9

 

(2

)

Net profit (cash basis)

 

1,731

 

1,583

 

1,568

 

 

1.

Reclassification of fees and commissions against interest income and measured on the effective yield basis

2.

Reclassification of interest expense on reclassification of ANZ StEPS from equity to debt

3.

Measuring derivatives on a fair value basis and the reclassification of interest expense on non-hedged derivatives to other income

4.

Refer page 11 - Significant items

5.

Refer page 11 - Fair value hedging gains

6.

Refer page 11 - ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs

7.

Refer page 26 - Economic loss provisioning

8.

Refer page 11 for a description of non-core items

14




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

 

Income and expenses

Net Interest

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net interest income ($M)

 

3,368

 

2,953

 

2,865

 

14%

 

18%

 

Average interest earning assets ($M)

 

294,364

 

261,414

 

244,906

 

13%

 

20%

 

Net interest margin (%)

 

2.29

 

2.26

 

2.36

 

1%

 

-3%

 

Net interest income (adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments1,3)

 

3,368

 

3,231

 

3,140

 

4%

 

7%

 

Average interest earning assets2 ($M) (adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments)

 

294,364

 

274,309

 

257,606

 

7%

 

14%

 

Net interest margin (adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments1)

 

2.29

 

2.36

 

2.46

 

-3%

 

-7%

 

 

1.

Refer footnote 1 on page 8

2.

AIFRS 2005 adjustments include the reclassification of customers liability for acceptance from non-interest earning to interest earning (Sep 2005: $13.3 billion; Mar 2005: $13.1 billion) to be consistent with the classification of commercial bill fees as interest

3.

Refer page 14 for a reconciliation of net interest income to cash net interest income

Average Interest Earning Assets

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v Sep 05

 

v Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Average Interest earning assets

 

294,364

 

261,414

 

244,906

 

13%

 

20%

 

Acceptances reclassed as interest earnings assets

 

-

 

13,344

 

13,134

 

-

 

-

 

Reclass of deferred fees on non Commercial bills

 

-

 

(449)

 

(434)

 

-

 

-

 

Average Interest earning assets (adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments)

 

294,364

 

274,309

 

257,606

 

7%

 

14%

 

 

§                      March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

Net interest income at $3,368 million was 14% ($415 million) higher than the September 2005 half.  After adjusting for non-core items and AIFRS 2005 adjustments, cash net interest was 4% ($137 million) higher than the September 2005 half.

Volume

Average interest earning assets increased 13%.

-                     Average net advances grew by $11.8 billion (5%).  Growth in net advances in Australia was attributable to Personal Banking Australia ($18.6 billion or 18% with $4.7 billion in Mortgages or 5%) and Corporate Australia ($1.3 billion or 6%).  New Zealand’s average net advances increased by $3.2 billion (5%) with exchange rate impacts (-$1.0 billion).  Average net advances grew by $0.6 billion (7%) in Overseas Markets.

-                     Other interest earning assets increased $7.6 billion (23%), driven by higher levels of liquid assets, trading securities, available-for-sale assets and interbank lending.

Average deposits and other borrowings grew $10.9 billion (6%) with growth in Treasury ($2.3 billion or 13%) to fund asset growth, Personal Banking Australia ($15.9 billion or 37%) and Corporate Australia (-$1.1 billion or -6%).  Average deposits and other borrowings increased in New Zealand ($0.8 billion or 1%) with exchange rate impacts ($0.3 billion).  Average deposits and other borrowings grew ($0.3 billion or 3%) in Overseas Markets, with exchange rate impacts $0.1 billion.

After adjusting for AIFRS 2005 adjustments, interest earning assets increased 7%

-                     Average net advances grew by $12.6 billion (5%).  Growth in net advances in Australia was attributable to Personal Banking Australia ($5.8 billion or 6% with $4.7 billion in Mortgages or 5%) and Corporate Australia ($1.4 billion or 6%).  New Zealand’s average net advances increased by $3.1 billion (5%) with exchange rate impacts (-$0.3 billion).  Average net advances grew by $0.6 billion (7%) in Overseas Markets.

-                     Other interest earning assets increased $7.6 billion (23%), driven by higher levels of liquid assets, trading securities, available-for-sale assets and interbank lending.

Average deposits and other borrowings grew $11.0 billion (6%) with growth in Treasury ($2.3 billion or 13%) to fund asset growth, Personal Banking Australia ($2.2 billion or 5%) and Corporate Australia ($1.3 billion or 7%).  Average deposits and other borrowings increased in New Zealand ($0.8 billion or 1%) with exchange rate impacts ($0.3 billion).  Average deposits and other borrowings grew ($4.5 billion or 23%) in Overseas Markets, with exchange rate impacts $0.4 billion.

15




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

 

Income and expenses, cont’d

Average Interest Earning Assets, cont’d

Margin

Net interest average margin increased by 3 basis points, however, core net interest margin adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments reduced 7 basis points from the September 2005 half year:

-                     AIFRS 2005 adjustments (+10 basis points)

Changes predominantly reflect the inclusion of certain fees as net interest income, partially offset by interest expense on Hybrid securities, reported as debt instruments under AIFRS and inclusion of acceptances in average interest earning assets.

-                     Funding mix (-4 basis points)

Changes in the funding mix reduced the net interest margin due to substitution of wholesale funding for customer deposits (2 basis points) and a decrease in net non-interest bearing items (2 basis points).

-                     Asset mix (-2 basis point)

Movements in the composition of assets in the portfolio negatively impacted the net interest margin by 2 basis points, reflecting an increase in the proportion of lower yielding non-lending liquid assets in Group Treasury and Institutional.

-                     Competition (-4 basis points)

Competitive pressures were most marked in Australian Mortgages (1 basis point), Corporate Australia and Institutional (1 basis point), plus migration of customers to lower yielding credit cards and New Zealand fixed rate mortgages (1 basis point) and high yielding deposits (1 basis point).

-                     Wholesale rates (+2 basis points)

Wholesale rate movements benefited margins from lower basis risk in variable rate mortgages and credit cards plus increased earnings on the investment of capital and rate insensitive deposits (2 basis points), with minimal changes in Treasury mismatch earnings.

-                     Other items (+1 basis point) include:

·                        a reduction in retail broker payments and higher earnings from foreign exchange revenue hedging (+1 basis point)

·                        release of a provision relating to prior year income in Institutional (+2 basis points)

·                        reduced effective yield fee income decreased margins (-1 basis point)

·                        other impacts including decreases from change in interest not recognised on impaired loans, discontinued businesses and cash flow impacts on derivatives (-1 basis point)

§      March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

Net interest increased $503 million (18%) over the March 2005 half, or $228 million (7%) after adjusting for AIFRS 2005 adjustments.

Volume

Average interest earning assets increased 20%.

-                     Average net advances grew by $24.5 billion (11%).  Growth in net advances in Australia was attributable to Personal Banking Australia ($24.8 billion or 26% with Mortgages contributing $9.9 billion or 12%), Institutional ($2.1 billion or 7%) and Corporate Australia ($1.3 billion or 6%).  New Zealand’s average net advances increased by $6.8 billion (11%) with exchange rate impacts (-$1.2 billion).  Average net advances decreased by $0.2 billion (2%) in Overseas Markets.

-                     Other interest earning assets increased $11.6 billion (40%), driven by higher levels of liquid assets, trading securities, available-for-sale assets and interbank lending.

Average deposits and other borrowings increased $17.3 billion (10%) from growth in Personal Banking Australia ($17.2 billion or 41%), Institutional ($1.9 billion or 10%) and Corporate Australia (-$0.5 billion or -3%).  Average deposits and other borrowings increased in New Zealand ($1.3 billion or 3%) with exchange rate impacts (-$1.1 billion).  Average deposits and other borrowings grew ($5.3 billion or 28%) in Overseas Markets with exchange rate impacts $0.3 billion.

After adjusting for AIFRS 2005 adjustments, interest earning assets increased 14%:

-                     Average net advances grew by $25.3 billion (11%).  Growth in net advances in Australia was attributable to Personal Banking Australia ($12.0 billion or 12% with Mortgages contributing $9.8 billion or 12%), Institutional ($3.3 billion or 11%) and Corporate Australia ($2.2 billion or 10%).  New Zealand’s average net advances increased by $6.6 billion (11%) with exchange rate impacts (-$0.5 billion).  Average net advances increased by $0.1 billion (1%) in Overseas Markets.

16




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

 

Income and expenses, cont’d

Average Interest Earning Assets, cont’d

§      March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year, cont’d

-                     Other interest earning assets increased $11.6 billion (40%), driven by higher levels of liquid assets, trading securities, available-for-sale assets and interbank lending.

Average deposits and other borrowings increased $17.3 billion (10%) from growth in Personal Banking Australia ($3.5 billion or 9%), Institutional ($1.9 billion or 10%) and Corporate Australia ($1.9 billion or 11%).  Average deposits and other borrowings increased in New Zealand ($1.3 billion or 3%) with exchange rate impacts (-$0.4 billion).  Average deposits and other borrowings grew ($5.3 billion or 28%) in Overseas Markets with exchange rate impacts $0.3 billion.

Margin

Net interest average margin reduced by 7 basis points whilst core net interest margin adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustments reduced 17 basis points from the March 2005 half:

-                     AIFRS 2005 adjustments (+10 basis points)

Changes predominantly reflect the inclusion of certain fees as net interest income, partially offset by interest expense on Hybrid securities, reported as debt instruments under AIFRS and inclusion of acceptances in average interest earning assets.

-                     Funding mix (-7 basis points)

Higher proportions of more expensive wholesale and customer liabilities (-4 basis points) within the portfolio and falling levels of net non-interest bearing interest items (-3 basis points).

-                     Asset mix (-4 basis points)

Lower proportions of higher yielding assets in Asset Finance and Corporate and Structured Financing reduced margin by 2 basis points and an increase in the proportion of lower yielding non-lending liquid assets in Group Treasury and Institutional (2 basis points)

-                     Competition (-10 basis points)

Competitive pressures reduced margins, with this impact arising mainly in Mortgages (Australian mortgages 2 basis points, New Zealand mortgages 1 basis points) and Institutional lending with slight margin reductions in Corporate Banking, Business Banking and Rural portfolios.  In addition customer migration to lower yielding credit cards and New Zealand fixed rate mortgages reduced the net interest margin (-2 basis points), together with migration into high yielding customer deposits (-2 basis points).

-                     Wholesale rates (+3 basis points)

Increased income on the investment of capital and rate insensitive deposits (+2 basis points) and less basis risk in variable rate mortgages and credit cards (+1 basis point).

-                     Other items (+1 basis point) include:

·                        Funding costs associated with unrealised trading gains increased as a result of movements in the AUD.  This decrease in interest income is reflected in the net interest margin, however it is directly offset by an equivalent increase in trading income (-3 basis points)

·                        Release of revenue relating to prior year income in Institutional (+2 basis points)

·                        Benefit from mix impacts on discontinued businesses (+2 basis points)

17




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

 

Income and expenses, cont’d

Other Operating Income

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Other operating income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total fee income

 

1,029

 

1,027

 

953

 

0%

 

8%

 

Foreign exchange earnings

 

227

 

233

 

221

 

-3%

 

3%

 

Profit on trading instruments

 

144

 

93

 

39

 

55%

 

large

 

Other

 

163

 

176

 

194

 

-7%

 

-16%

 

Core other operating income

 

1,563

 

1,529

 

1,407

 

2%

 

11%

 

AIFRS 2005 adjustments1

 

N/A

 

301

 

283

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Fair value hedging gains

 

18

 

17

 

27

 

6%

 

-33%

 

Significant items1

 

14

 

14

 

-

 

0%

 

n/a

 

Total other income

 

1,595

 

1,861

 

1,717

 

-14%

 

-7%

 

 

1.

Refer footnote 1 on page 8. Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believes measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations

 

§                      March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

Other operating income decreased $266 million (14%).  After adjusting for AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items, core other operating income increased $34 million (2%) (refer pages 11 to 14 for details).

-                     Fee income increased $2 million.

·                        Lending fee income increased $7 million (3%):

-                      Personal Banking Australia increased $5 million (7%) with a seasonal increase and higher volumes in Banking Products ($3 million or 8%) with a higher number of transaction accounts and Mortgages increasing $2 million (12%) driven by lending growth.

-                      New Zealand increased $5 million (15%).

-                      Institutional decreased $4 million (6%) with a $7 million reduction in Corporate and Structured Financing due to large deals in the Structured Debt portfolio closing in the second half of 2005 offset by a $4 million increase in Trade and Transaction Services as a result of an improved performance in Trade Finance.

·                        Non-lending fee income decreased $5 million (1%):

-                      Institutional decreased $18 million with Corporate and Structured Financing decreasing $16 million related to a reduction in advisory and syndication fees and coming off a particularly strong September 2005 half.

-                      Personal Banking Australia increased $12 million (4%) with a $7 million (12%) increase in Investment Insurance Products primarily due to increased volume in commissions from INGA as a result of strong market conditions and funds under management growth, and Banking Products increasing $2 million (4%) related to the continuing strong growth in the transaction banking account base.

-                      Foreign exchange earnings decreased $6 million (3%) entirely in Institutional where lower foreign exchange swap and spot earnings were offset by increased profit on trading instruments ($24 million, see below).  In New Zealand, there was an increase of $28 million in foreign exchange earnings driven by greater currency volatility in the first half of 2006.

-                      Profit on trading instruments increased $51 million with Institutional increasing $35 million driven by strong growth in New Zealand associated with increased activity and positioning to take advantage of interest rate and currency volatility as well as the profit offsetting the foreign exchange loss referred to above.  In addition the six months to September 2005 included the $16 million cost from the hedge of capital investment earnings in INGA which ceased in October 2005.

-                      Other operating income decreased $13 million (7%):

·                       Esanda and UDC decreased $17 million due to a $6 million impact from the fall in second-hand car prices and the inclusion of a $7 million gain in the September 2005 half year resulting from the alignment of revenue recognition on leases in the New Zealand Fleet business with Group accounting policies.

·                       Group Centre decreased $14 million mainly due to the timing of recognition of gains in ANZ’s share of INGA capital investment earnings with the move to available-for-sale classification (high level of realisation of gains in the September 2005 half).

·                       Non-continuing businesses increased $18 million as a result of a $12 million gain from settlement of the sale warranties relating to the sale of the London headquartered project finance business and a $4 million gain on sale of power assets.

-                      Movements in average exchange rates over the September 2005 half year were immaterial.

18




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Income and expenses, cont’d

Other Operating Income, cont’d

§             March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

Other operating income decreased $122 million (7%).  Core other operating income increased $156 million (11%) after excluding AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items (refer pages 11 to 14 for details).

-         Fee income increased $76 million (8%).

§         Lending fee income increased $18 million (9%).  Institutional increased $16 million of which $9 million in Corporate and Structured Financing was largely in project financing fees and $6 million was driven by Trade and Transaction Services reflecting an improvement in performance in Trade Finance.

§         Non-lending fee income increased $58 million (8%):

-         Personal Banking Australia increased $41 million (13%), of which $17 million in Consumer Finance was driven by volume growth and cross sell initiatives.  Investment & Insurance Products increased $12 million due to an increase in income generated by financial planners.  Banking Products increased $7 million driven by increased account and transaction numbers.

-         New Zealand increased $8 million (4%) driven by card fees and interchange fees from credit card purchases.

-         Asia Pacific increased $5 million (21%) primarily due to increased card fees in Indonesia.

-         Corporate Australia increased $5 million (13%), which included an increase in advisory fees and ANZ Online fee income.

-         Foreign exchange earnings increased $6 million (3%).  Trade and Transaction Services increased as a result of continued growth particularly from international payments revenue.  There was also growth in Markets in New Zealand driven by positioning for currency volatility in the first half of 2006 and a $10 million increase in the Pacific mainly due to growth in PNG assisted by major mining deals.  This was offset by a reduction in Australia where reduced foreign exchange earnings on swap and spot positions were offset in profit on trading instruments.

-         Profit on trading instruments increased $105 million:

§         Markets grew by $89 million due primarily to strong growth in New Zealand ($22 million) associated with increased activity and positioning to take advantage of interest rate and currency volatility and a $28 million increase due to revenue growth underpinned by increased frontline staff and initiatives following the restructure in the first half of 2005.  Increased profit on swap and spot foreign exchange contracts ($24 million) offset the foreign exchange reduction referred to above.  Total income in Markets increased $58 million.

§         Group Centre also increased with the March 2005 half including a $16 million cost as a result of the hedge of capital investment earnings in INGA.  Hedging of capital investment earnings ceased in October 2005.

-         Other operating income decreased $31 million (16%):

§         Group Centre decreased $18 million due mainly to lower share of INGA capital investment earnings following the capital repatriation in 2005 and the timing of profit recognition on the available-for-sale accounting basis.

§         Esanda and UDC decreased $13 million due largely to the impact of a fall in second-hand car prices.

§         Institutional reduced $10 million with the March 2005 half including a $10 million gain on sale of Sydney Futures Exchange shares.

§         Asia Pacific decreased $7 million due to reduced equity accounted earnings from PT Panin Bank as the first half of 2006 has seen increased pressure on margins from interest rates, increased costs relating to the branch expansion project and reduced bond income.

§         Non-continuing Businesses increased $11 million due to the gain from the settlement of warranties relating to the sale of the London headquartered project finance business as well as the gain on sale of power assets.  This was offset by the $4 million profit on sale of the London based headquartered project finance business in the first half of 2005.

§         Personal Banking Australia increased $6 million with Mortgages increasing $4 million as a result of increased insurance premiums driven by higher sales of LMI loans.

-         Movements in average exchange rates over the March 2005 half year were immaterial

19




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Income and expenses, cont’d

Expenses

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Operating expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personnel expenses

 

1,341

 

1,286

 

1,207

 

4%

 

11%

 

Premises expenses

 

205

 

197

 

193

 

4%

 

6%

 

Computer expenses

 

258

 

281

 

260

 

-8%

 

-1%

 

Other expenses

 

433

 

427

 

440

 

1%

 

-2%

 

Restructuring costs

 

22

 

22

 

27

 

0%

 

-19%

 

Core operating expenses

 

2,259

 

2,213

 

2,127

 

2%

 

6%

 

NBNZ incremental integration costs1

 

39

 

53

 

25

 

-26%

 

56%

 

Significant items - settlement of NHB insurance claim

 

(113)

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Total operating expenses

 

2,185

 

2,266

 

2,152

 

-4%

 

2%

 

Total employees

 

31,063

 

30,976

 

29,832

 

0%

 

4%

 

 

1.

These costs are personnel costs of $22 million (Sep 2005 half: $23 million; Mar 2005 half: $13 million), computer costs of $6 million (Sep 2005 half: $15 million; Mar 2005 half: $2 million), and other costs of $11 million (Sep 2005 half: $15 million; Mar 2005 half: $10 million).  Refer page 11 for a description of non-core items, including a discussion of why management believes measures of core performance provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations

§             March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

Operating expenses decreased $81 million (4%) over the September 2005 half year due largely to the $113 million pre-tax settlement of the NHB insurance claim.  After adjusting for non-core items, core operating expenses increased $46 million (2%) (refer page 11 for details of non-core items).

-         Personnel expenses increased $55 million (4%) as a result of annual salary increases and growth in staff numbers; especially in the September 2005 half.

-         Premises costs increased $8 million (4%) driven largely by rental expense reflecting additional space requirements.

-         Computer costs decreased $23 million (8%).  The reduction was mainly in Operations, Technology and Shared Services due to an $11 million reduction in computer contractors resulting from the completion of business systems integration in New Zealand, a $7 million reduction in depreciation principally as a result of asset write-downs in the second half of 2005 and assets fully depreciating.  Lower software licence costs also contributed to the reduction ($3 million).

-         Other expenses increased $6 million with non-lending losses increasing $14 million in Institutional and New Zealand (the latter including a NZD10 million Commerce Commission settlement impact and NZD5 million cost of operating relocated domestic systems as part of integration) offset by a $6 million reduction in indirect taxes in Esanda.

-         Movements in average exchange rates over the September 2005 half year were immaterial.

20




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Income and expenses, cont’d

Expenses, cont’d

§             March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

Operating expenses increased $33 million (2%) or $132 million (6%) adjusting for non-core items including the $113 million pre-tax settlement of the NHB insurance claim and ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs (refer page 11 for details).

-         Personnel costs were up $134 million (11%) due to annual salary increases and a 4% increase in staff numbers mainly in the following business units:

§         Personal Banking Australia increased 6%.  Retail Banking increased 5% due to frontline increases primarily as a result of new branch staffing and network initiatives.  Consumer Finance increased by 5% following the introduction of the 24 hour call centre in April 2005, increased sales staffing and the introduction of the white-labelling capability.

§         Institutional increased 8% mainly due to a 15% increase in Trade and Transaction Services reflecting business expansion particularly in the Trade Finance and Custodian Services businesses.

§         Asia Pacific increased 10% related mainly to the formation of the ANZ Royal Bank joint venture in Cambodia and the broader partnership agenda as well as business growth and the launch of initiatives in the Pacific mainly in Amerika Samoa, Solomon Islands and PNG.

-         Premises costs increased $12 million (6%) with a $7 million increase in rental expense reflecting additional space requirements and a $4 million rise in the cost of security services.

-         Computer costs decreased $2 million (1%).  A $4 million decrease due to timing of software purchases was offset by a $5 million increase in computer repairs.

-         Other expenses were $7 million (2%) lower.  This was due to a reduced charge for non-lending losses ($4 million) as the first half of 2005 included a $15 million charge for cheque conversion losses.  This was offset by a NZD10 million increase in New Zealand in the first half of 2006 as a result of the Commerce Commission settlement.  In addition, there was a $4 million reduction in professional fees due to a decrease in AIFRS and Sarbanes Oxley project costs and a $6 million decline in indirect taxes in Esanda.  These were offset by increased travel costs of $11 million.

-         Movements in exchange rates reduced cost growth by $5 million.

Income Tax Expense

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Income tax expense on profit

 

742

 

630

 

590

 

18%

 

26%

 

Effective tax rate

 

29.1%

 

28.0%

 

27.5%

 

 

 

 

 

Income tax expense on cash profit1

 

716

 

636

 

611

 

13%

 

17%

 

Effective tax rate (cash profit1)

 

29.2%

 

28.6%

 

28.0%

 

 

 

 

 

 

1.

Refer footnote 1 on page 8.  Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believes measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations

 

 

§             March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

The Group’s income tax expense increased by $112 million to $742 million resulting in an effective tax rate of 29.1%, an increase of 1.1% from the September 2005 half year.  The March 2006 half year included the settlement of an ANZ National Bank warranty claim, which was non-taxable, and the September 2005 half year included the non-taxability of profit on sale of NBNZ Life and Funds Management businesses.

Adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustment and non-core items, income tax expense increased by $80 million resulting in an effective tax rate of 29.2% an increase of 0.6% from the September 2005 half year.  This increase reflects the run-off of certain New Zealand and Australian structured financing transactions and proportionately higher earnings in higher tax rate jurisdictions, predominately New Zealand.

§             March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

The Group’s effective tax rate for the March 2006 half year increased 1.6% from the March 2005 half year.

Adjusted for AIFRS 2005 adjustment and non-core items, the effective tax rate increased 1.2% from the March 2005 half year.  This increase reflects the run-off of certain New Zealand and Australia structured financing transactions, lower equity accounted earnings from INGA and PT Panin Bank and proportionately higher earnings in higher tax rate jurisdictions, predominantly New Zealand.  The March 2005 half year included the non-taxable profit on sale of Sydney Futures Exchange shares.

21




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Earnings per share

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Earnings per share1 (cents)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

98.4

 

86.3

 

83.2

 

14%

 

18%

 

Diluted

 

96.1

 

84.3

 

80.6

 

14%

 

19%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Cash earnings per share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company ($M)

 

1,811.0

 

1,620.0

 

1,555.0

 

12%

 

16%

 

Less: non-core items included in profit after tax2 ($M)

 

(80)

 

9

 

(2)

 

large

 

large

 

AIFRS 2005 Adjustments2 ($M)

 

N/A

 

(46)

 

15

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Cash Profit ($M)4

 

1,731

 

1,583

 

1,568

 

9%

 

10%

 

Preference share adjustments3 ($M)

 

(12)

 

(12)

 

(6)

 

0%

 

100%

 

Earnings adjusted for non-core items and
AIFRS 2005 adjustments ($M)

 

1,719

 

1,571

 

1,562

 

9%

 

10%

 

Weighted average number of ordinary shares (M)

 

1,828.4

 

1,824.7

 

1,822.7

 

0%

 

0%

 

Cash earnings per share (cents)

 

94.0

 

86.1

 

85.7

 

9%

 

10%

 

 

1.

Refer Note 6 for full calculation

2.

Refer page 8

3.

The EPS calculation excludes the Euro preference shares

4.

Refer page 14 for a reconciliation to Net Profit.  Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believes measures of cash profit provides useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations

 

Earnings per share increased 14.0% (12.1 cents) to 98.4 cents on the September 2005 half.  Cash EPS for the Group increased 9.2% or 7.9 cents on the September 2005 half.  The main drivers of the increase in cash EPS on the September 2005 half are:

§             Growth in continuing business profit before provisions contributed 5.4%

§             Reduction in the continuing businesses provision charge contributed 6.5%

§             Partly offset by headwinds, including non-continuing businesses (2.5%) and the dilution by the issuance of shares (-0.2%)

Earnings per share increased 18.3% (15.2 cents) on the March 2005 half.  Cash EPS for the Group increased 9.7% or 8.3 cents on the March 2005 half.  The main drivers of the increase in cash EPS on the March 2005 half are:

§             Growth in continuing business profit before provisions contributed 10.3%

§             Reduction in the continuing businesses provision charge contributed 2.3%

§             Partly offset by headwinds, including non-continuing businesses (2.6%) and the dilution by the issuance of shares (0.3%)

22




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Dividends

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Dividend per ordinary share (cents)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interim (fully franked)

 

56

 

n/a

 

51

 

n/a

 

10%

 

Final (fully franked)

 

n/a

 

59

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ordinary share dividend payout ratio (%)

 

56.9%

 

68.4%

 

61.3%

 

 

 

 

 

Net profit after tax ($M)

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

Non-core items1 and AIFRS 2005 adjustments ($M)

 

(80

)

(37

)

13

 

large

 

large

 

Cash1 profit ($M)2

 

1,731

 

1,583

 

1,568

 

9%

 

10%

 

Dividend payout ratio of cash1 profit (%)

 

59.6%

 

68.6%

 

59.5%

 

 

 

 

 

 

1.

Refer footnote 1 on page 8

2.

Refer page 14 for a reconciliation to Net Profit.  Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believes measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations

 

The Directors propose that an interim dividend of 56 cents be paid on each ordinary share, up 5 cents (9.8%) on the 2005 interim dividend broadly in line with the growth in Cash EPS (adjusted for non-core items and AIFRS 2005 adjustments).  The proposed interim dividend will be fully franked.

The Group has a dividend reinvestment plan and a bonus option plan.  Participation in these plans is limited to 50,000 shares in each plan.  Election notices for these plans must be received by 5.00 pm (AEST) on the record date, namely, 19 May 2006.  It is proposed that the interim dividend will be payable on 3 July 2006.  Dividends payable to shareholders with a registered address in Great Britain (including the Channel Islands and the Isle of Man) and New Zealand will be converted to their local currency at ANZ’s daily forward exchange rate at the close of business on the record date for value on the payment date.

The Group expects current timing differences will generate future franking credits and therefore the Group expects it will be able to maintain full franking for the foreseeable future.

EVA Reconciliation

One measure of shareholder value is EVATM (Economic Value Added) growth relative to prior periods.  EVATM for the half year ended 31 March 2006 at $1,013 million was up $22 million on the half year ended 30 September 2005, and up $93 million on the March 2005 half.

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

EVATM

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net profit after tax

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items1

 

(80

)

(37

)

13

 

large

 

large

 

Cash Profit2

 

1,731

 

1,583

 

1,568

 

9%

 

10%

 

Credit cost adjustment

 

(74

)

22

 

(26

)

large

 

large

 

Economic profit

 

1,657

 

1,605

 

1,542

 

3%

 

7%

 

Imputation credits

 

313

 

308

 

286

 

2%

 

9%

 

Adjusted economic profit

 

1,970

 

1,913

 

1,828

 

3%

 

8%

 

Cost of ordinary capital

 

(945

)

(910

)

(902

)

4%

 

5%

 

Cost of preference share capital

 

(12

)

(12

)

(6

)

0%

 

100%

 

EVATM

 

1,013

 

991

 

920

 

2%

 

10%

 

 

1.

Refer footnote 1 on page 8

2.

Refer page 14 for a reconciliation to Net Profit.  Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believes measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial condition and results of operations

 

EVATM is a measure of risk adjusted accounting profit used for evaluating business unit performance and is a key factor in determining the variable component of remuneration packages.  It is based on operating profit after tax, adjusted for non-core items, credit costs, the cost of capital, and imputation credits (measured at 70% of Australian tax).  Of these, the major component is the cost of capital, which is calculated on the risk adjusted or economic capital at a rate of 11%.  At the Group level, total capital is used so the cost of capital reflects the full resources provided by shareholders.  The credit cost adjustment replaces the credit provision charge with economic loss provision after tax at the rate applicable in the relevant geography.

23




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

EVA Reconciliation, cont’d

At ANZ, economic capital is equity allocated according to a business unit’s inherent risk profile.  It is allocated for several risk categories including: credit risk, operating risk, interest rate risk, basis risk, mismatch risk, investment risk, trading risk deferred acquisition costs risk and other risk.  The methodology used to allocate capital to business units for risk is designed to help drive appropriate risk management and business strategies.

Management believes that EVATM provides useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial conditions and operations because it removes the impacts of non-recurring and other items that are not part of the core business and recognises the cost of investors capital and the long run expected credit losses.

24




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Credit Risk

Individual provision charge

The individual provision charge was $188 million, down $18 million over the September 2005 half.  This reduction results from lower single name provisions, especially in New Zealand as well as Esanda and UDC, partially offset by two larger single name provisions in Institutional.  This was a strong result given the September 2005 half benefited from large write-backs in non-continuing businesses, due to sales and realisations of non-performing ‘Power’ assets.

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Individual provision charge

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

86

 

87

 

60

 

-1%

 

43%

 

Institutional

 

38

 

11

 

12

 

large

 

large

 

New Zealand Businesses

 

6

 

65

 

26

 

-91%

 

-77%

 

Corporate Australia

 

20

 

18

 

23

 

11%

 

-13%

 

Esanda and UDC

 

35

 

48

 

24

 

-27%

 

46%

 

Asia Pacific

 

6

 

7

 

17

 

-14%

 

-65%

 

Non-continuing businesses

 

(3

)

(30

)

(11

)

-90%

 

-73%

 

Individual/specific provision charge

 

188

 

206

 

151

 

-9%

 

25%

 

Collective (general) provision charge

Collective (general) provision charges were $36 million, down $54 million over the September 2005 half or $83 million on a comparable basis after AIFRS 2005 adjustments.  The reduction over the half was largely driven by improved risk profiles in Institutional, Corporate and New Zealand, a benign credit environment, as well as a partial unwind across all business units of non-customer specific provisions held for oil price risk.  Partially offsetting this was some increase for growth and the strategic risk mix change in Personal Banking Australia towards lower rate cards and declining secondhand car prices in Esanda.  The increase in the September 2005 half was driven by growth and a $68 million top up for non-customer specific oil price risk, partially offset by a modest improvement in the Group’s overall profile.

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Collective (general) provision charge

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

31

 

46

 

43

 

-33%

 

-28%

 

Institutional

 

(5

)

19

 

9

 

large

 

large

 

New Zealand Businesses

 

(3

)

24

 

26

 

large

 

large

 

Corporate Australia

 

2

 

28

 

22

 

-93%

 

-91%

 

Esanda and UDC

 

14

 

19

 

18

 

-26%

 

-22%

 

Asia Pacific

 

2

 

6

 

4

 

-67%

 

-50%

 

Non-continuing businesses

 

(5

)

(23

)

(33

)

-78%

 

-85%

 

Group Centre

 

-

 

(29

)

44

 

-100%

 

-100%

 

Collective (general) provision charge

 

36

 

90

 

133

 

-60%

 

-73%

 

Collective (general) provision balance

The collective provision balance at 31 March 2006 was $1,903 million (0.83% of risk weighted assets), a decrease of $264 million from the general provision balance of $2,167 million (0.99% of risk weighted assets) at 30 September 2005.  This represents a surplus of $237 million over the APRA minimum guideline.  The reduction in balance results from the first time adoption of AIFRS on 1 October 2005.

25




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Credit Risk, cont’d

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

Provision for credit impairment charge

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

117

 

133

 

103

 

-12%

 

14%

 

Institutional

 

33

 

30

 

21

 

10%

 

57%

 

New Zealand Businesses

 

3

 

89

 

52

 

-97%

 

-94%

 

Corporate Australia

 

22

 

46

 

45

 

-52%

 

-51%

 

Esanda and UDC

 

49

 

67

 

42

 

-27%

 

17%

 

Asia Pacific

 

8

 

13

 

21

 

-38%

 

-62%

 

Non-continuing businesses

 

(8

)

(53

)

(44

)

-85%

 

-82%

 

Group Centre

 

-

 

(29

)

44

 

-100%

 

-100%

 

Provision for credit impairment charge

 

224

 

296

 

284

 

-24%

 

-21%

 

Economic loss provisions (ELP)

With effect from 1 October 2005 the Group has adopted an incurred loss approach to credit loss provisioning as required by AASB 139: ‘Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement’.  Prior to that date the Group had adopted an economic loss provisioning (ELP) methodology that recognised an expense for credit losses based on the expected long term loss ratio for each part of the loan portfolio.

Management believe that disclosure of ELP data will assist readers in determining the longer term expected loss rates on the lending portfolio as ELP removes the volatility in reported earnings created by the use of an incurred loss methodology.  ANZ will continue to use the ELP methodology internally for economic value added (EVA) reporting and as another factor when determining the dividend payout ratio.

The Group economic loss provision charge (ELP) was $334 million, an increase of $38 million (13%) over the half year to September 2005.  This increase was driven by growth and the strategically planned ‘risk mix’ shift in Consumer Finance and slightly higher expected losses in Esanda due to a decrease in the realisable value of motor vehicles in default.

 

% of

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

 

 

Group

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

 

 

Net

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

 

 

Advances

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ELP rates by segment1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

44%

 

0.22%

 

0.21%

 

0.19%

 

Institutional

 

18%

 

0.32%

 

0.30%

 

0.31%

 

New Zealand Businesses

 

22%

 

0.17%

 

0.17%

 

0.18%

 

Corporate Australia

 

9%

 

0.32%

 

0.32%

 

0.32%

 

Esanda and UDC

 

6%

 

0.49%

 

0.44%

 

0.45%

 

Asia Pacific

 

1%

 

1.58%

 

1.38%

 

1.40%

 

Non-continuing businesses

 

0%

 

0.46%

 

0.18%

 

0.26%

 

Total

 

100%

 

0.26%

 

0.25%

 

0.26%

 

ELP charge ($ million)

 

 

 

334

 

296

 

284

 

 

1.           ELP rate = Annualised economic loss provisioning divided by average net lending assets

26




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Credit Risk, cont’d

Gross impaired loans

Gross impaired loans increased to $726 million, up $84 million from $642 million as at 30 September 2005.  This increase was largely driven by two new accounts in Institutional and a small increase in Mortgages.  Offsetting this were strong realisations and a falling exchange rate in New Zealand, plus strong realisations in non-continuing businesses.

The default rate (new impaired loans/average gross lending assets) has increased 1 basis point since September 2005 half.  This increase was also largely the result of higher new impaired loans in Institutional, offset by lower new impaired loans in New Zealand.

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Gross impaired loans

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

57

 

48

 

37

 

19%

 

54%

 

Institutional

 

352

 

189

 

215

 

86%

 

64%

 

New Zealand Businesses

 

116

 

162

 

81

 

-28%

 

43%

 

Corporate Australia

 

90

 

85

 

120

 

6%

 

-25%

 

Esanda and UDC

 

82

 

79

 

78

 

4%

 

5%

 

Asia Pacific

 

21

 

35

 

36

 

-40%

 

-42%

 

Non-continuing businesses

 

8

 

44

 

73

 

-82%

 

-89%

 

Total gross impaired loans

 

726

 

642

 

640

 

13%

 

13%

 

Net impaired loans

Net impaired loans are $421 million (Sep 2005: $386 million; Mar 2005: $326 million) representing 2.2% of shareholders’ equity as at 31 March 2006 (Sep 2005: 2.0%; Mar 2005: 1.7%).  The Group has an individual provision coverage ratio of 42%.

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Net impaired loans

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

24

 

19

 

15

 

26%

 

60%

 

Institutional

 

249

 

123

 

114

 

large

 

large

 

New Zealand Businesses

 

64

 

101

 

35

 

-37%

 

83%

 

Corporate Australia

 

30

 

38

 

54

 

-21%

 

-44%

 

Esanda and UDC

 

39

 

40

 

43

 

-3%

 

-9%

 

Asia Pacific

 

8

 

21

 

14

 

-62%

 

-43%

 

Non-continuing businesses

 

7

 

45

 

52

 

-84%

 

-87%

 

Other

 

-

 

(1

)

(1

)

-100%

 

-100%

 

Total net impaired loans

 

421

 

386

 

326

 

9%

 

29%

 

Individual provision coverage

 

42%

 

40%

 

49%

 

 

 

 

 

27




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Market Risk

Below are aggregate Value at Risk (VaR) exposures at 97.5% and 99% confidence levels covering both physical and derivatives trading positions for the Bank’s principal trading centres.  Figures are converted from USD at closing exchange rates.

97.5% confidence level 1 day holding period

 

As at

 

High for

 

Low for

 

Ave for

 

As at

 

High for

 

Low for

 

Ave for

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

period

 

period

 

period

 

Sep 05

 

period

 

period

 

period

 

 

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Sep 051

 

Sep 051

 

Sep 051

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Value at risk at 97.5% confidence

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign exchange

 

1.1

 

1.9

 

0.4

 

0.9

 

0.8

 

1.7

 

0.3

 

1.0

 

Interest rate

 

1.3

 

2.3

 

0.5

 

1.2

 

1.2

 

1.8

 

0.2

 

0.9

 

Credit Spread

 

1.6

 

1.7

 

0.8

 

1.2

 

0.8

 

1.5

 

0.6

 

1.0

 

Diversification benefit

 

(2.3

)

n/a

 

n/a

 

(1.5

)

(1.2

)

n/a

 

n/a

 

(1.2

)

Total VaR

 

1.7

 

3.2

 

0.9

 

1.8

 

1.6

 

2.7

 

0.8

 

1.7

 

99% confidence level 1 day holding period

 

As at

 

High for

 

Low for

 

Ave for

 

As at

 

High for

 

Low for

 

Ave for

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

period

 

period

 

period

 

Sep 05

 

period

 

period

 

period

 

 

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Sep 051

 

Sep 051

 

Sep 051

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Value at risk at 99% confidence

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign exchange

 

1.3

 

2.2

 

0.3

 

1.1

 

0.9

 

2.1

 

0.3

 

1.1

 

Interest rate

 

1.7

 

2.6

 

0.5

 

1.4

 

1.7

 

2.7

 

0.2

 

1.3

 

Credit Spread

 

2.9

 

3.1

 

1.4

 

2.3

 

1.4

 

2.4

 

1.0

 

1.6

 

Diversification benefit

 

(3.5

)

n/a

 

n/a

 

(2.3

)

(1.8

)

n/a

 

n/a

 

(1.7

)

Total VaR

 

2.4

 

4.0

 

1.2

 

2.5

 

2.2

 

3.5

 

1.0

 

2.3

 

 

1.

Numbers are based on half year period

 

The table below shows all outstanding revenue hedges, interest income earned and fair value of these hedges.

Revenue related cash flow hedges

 

31 March 2006

 

30 September 20052

 

 

 

Notional

 

Amount

 

Unrealised

 

Notional

 

Amount

 

Unrealised

 

 

 

Principal

 

taken to

 

Gains/

 

Principal

 

taken to

 

Gains/

 

 

 

Amount

 

Income

 

(Losses)

 

Amount

 

Income

 

(Losses)

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

USD Revenue Hedges

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

8

 

-

 

NZD Revenue Hedges 1

 

3,776

 

(3

)

204

 

3,957

 

(16

)

41

 

Total

 

3,776

 

(3

)

204

 

3,957

 

(8

)

41

 

 

1.

Notional principal amount for March 2006 is $3,131 million purchased and $645 million sold contracts from partial close out of hedge.  The net open position is $2,486 million.  Revenue hedges are treated as cash flow hedges

2.

Numbers are based on half year period

 

The Group uses a variety of derivative instruments to hedge against the adverse impact on future offshore revenue streams from exchange rate movements.  As at 31 March 2006 ANZ had net $2.5 billion (Sep 2005: $4.0 billion; Mar 2005: $3.9 billion) hedge contracts in place.

Movements in average exchange rates resulted in an increase of $5 million in the Group’s profit after tax (net of profit and loss on revenue hedges).  Earnings from revenue hedges increased by $5 million (before tax) from the September half.  Hedge revenue is booked in the Group Centre as interest income.

28




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Balance Sheet

Total assets increased by $21.3 billion (7%) since 30 September 2005 to $319.4 billion.  Exchange rate movements accounted for a net reduction of $3.6 billion consisting of a reduction of $4.7 billion in New Zealand partly offset by a $1.2 billion increase in Overseas Markets.  Excluding the impact of exchange rate movements, total assets increased $17.3 billion (9%) in Australia, $8.3 billion (11%) in New Zealand, $1.2 billion (12%) in Asia Pacific and $0.2 billion (2%) in other geographies.

The explanations in the table below describe movements in the major asset classes.

 

Liquid assets ñ20%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ19%)

 

Liquid assets increased by $2.3 billion to $13.9 billion at 31 March 2006.

Australia increased $1.1 billion mainly in Group Treasury.  New Zealand increased $0.7 billion, despite the weakening NZD, with increased liquidity held by Treasury.  Overseas Markets increased $0.5 billion due to a weakening AUD (+$0.3 billion) and increased liquid assets in China and the Treasury operations in New York.

 

Due from other financial institutions ñ31%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ31%)

 

Due from other financial institutions increased by $2.0 billion to $8.3 billion at 31 March 2006 due largely to increase in volume of interbank lending, bank overdrafts, securities borrowing volumes in Institutional Australia and interbank lending in the Treasury operations in Singapore, New Zealand and the United States.

 

Derivatives ñ101%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ104%)

 

Derivative assets increased $3.8 billion to $7.5 billion at 31 March 2006 driven principally by increased volatility in exchange rates, notably the significant depreciation in the AUD and NZD during March 2006 and increased trading activity.  Derivative liabilities increased 45%, also driven by exchange rates.

 

Trading securities ñ39%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ40%)

 

Trading securities volumes increased $2.4 billion to $8.7 billion at 31 March 2006 due largely to more active trading in Institutional in Australia ($1.8 billion) and New Zealand ($0.5 billion).

 

Available-for-sale assets ñ32%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ31%, excl Exchange Rates and AIFRS 2005 Adjustment ñ18%)

 

Available-for-sale assets include assets previously classified as investment securities and loans and advances and other assets that are available-for-sale.  These assets are measured at fair value.  Available-for-sale asset volumes increased $3.2 billion to $13.3 billion at 31 March 2006 due to the reclassification of $1.1 billion assets from net loans and advances and other assets on 1 October 2005 on adoption of AIFRS and an increase in available-for-sale loans in Institutional Australia.  Increased liquidity holdings in overseas markets have offset reduced levels of available-for-sale securities in New Zealand where a greater proportion of the liquidity portfolio were reported as trading securities.

 

Net loans and advances ñ4%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ5%)

 

Net loans and advances increased $9.1 billion since September 2005 to $241.5 billion.  Excluding the impact of exchange rate movements (-$3.2 billion) and the impact of adopting AIFRS (-$1.3 billion resulting from changes in credit provisioning and the reclassification to available-for-sale), the increase was $13.6 billion (6%).

Growth in Australia was 5% ($8.6 billion).  After adjusting 2005 to a fully comparable AIFRS basis growth was $9.5 billion (6%) largely the result of increases in the following businesses:

-     Personal Banking Australia (6% or $6.5 billion), predominantly in Mortgages ($5.4 billion) as a result of growth in housing loans.  Consumer Finance increased $0.6 billion, reflecting the success of the low rate MasterCard product, and Regional Commercial and Agribusiness Products grew $0.3 billion.

-     Institutional Australia (6% or $1.5 billion) largely in Corporate and Structured Financing ($0.9 billion) due to increased project finance and structured debt activity. Debt Products Group increased $0.3 billion driven by increased demand for funding of mergers and acquisition activity, and volumes in Trade and Transaction Services increased $0.2 billion as a result of growth in overdrafts.

-     Corporate Australia (5% or $1.1 billion) largely in Business Banking ($0.6 billion) driven by continued investment in frontline staff and process simplification, the industry specialisation approach to customers and a competitive customer service proposition, and Corporate banking ($0.5 billion).

-     Esanda (3% or $0.4 billion) with solid new business writings partly offset by the natural run-off of assets.

New Zealand reduced by $0.2 billion; however, after excluding the impact of exchange rates and impact of adopting AIFRS, growth was $3.7 billion, or 6%, with increases in National Bank Retail ($1.1 billion), ANZ Retail ($1.0 billion), Rural Banking ($0.6 billion), Institutional ($0.2 billion) and Corporate Banking ($0.9 billion) partly offset by a $0.3 billion reduction in non-continuing businesses.

Overseas Markets grew by $0.6 billion (7%).  After excluding the impact of exchange rate movements and the impact of adopting AIFRS on 1 October 2005 growth was $0.4 billion (5%) in Asia Pacific ($0.2 billion) and the north west Institutional operations ($0.2 billion).

 

Customer’s liability for acceptance ñ2%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ2%)

 

Customer’s liability for acceptance increased by $0.2 billion to $13.7 billion at 31 March 2006 with growth in Institutional Australia ($0.1 billion) and Asia ($0.1 billion).

 

All other assets ò12%  (Excl Exchange Rates ò10%)

 

Other assets reduced $1.7 billion due mainly to lower trade dated asset volumes in Institutional.

 

29




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

 

Balance Sheet, cont’d

Total liabilities increased by $22.0 billion (8%) from 30 September 2005.  Exchange rate movements accounted for a net reduction of $2.6 billion consisting of a $4.1 billion reduction in New Zealand offset by a $1.5 billion reduction in Overseas Markets.

The explanations in the table below describe movements in the major liability classes.

Due to other financial institutions ñ11%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ10%)

Due to other financial institutions increased $1.3 billion to $13.3 billion at 31 March 2006.

Volumes in Australia increased $1.9 billion principally in the Markets business in Institutional with increased interbank repo activity. Excluding exchange rate movements New Zealand reduced $0.6 billion largely in Structured Finance.

Deposits and other borrowings ñ3%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ5%)

Deposits and other borrowings increased $6.5 billion to $196.9 billion at 31 March 2006.  Exchange rate movements reduced deposits and other borrowings by $2.1 billion with a $3.3 billion reduction in New Zealand partly offset by a $1.2 billion reduction in Overseas Markets.  Excluding exchange rate movements:

Australia increased $2.7 billion (2%) largely as a result of increases in the following businesses:

-     Treasury funding reduced $1.9 billion with a reduced requirement for short-term domestic funding with increased term debt issuance and higher offshore commercial paper funding.

-     Personal Banking Australia increased $2.6 billion mainly due to growth in high yielding term deposit and cash management account products.

-     Institutional increased $0.5 billion with increased funding in Markets, Corporate and Structured Financing and Debt Product group, partly offset by a slight reduction in corporate deposits in Trade and Transaction Services.

-     Corporate Australia increased $0.9 billion, with strong growth across all segments.

-     Esanda increased $0.6 billion to fund asset growth.

New Zealand increased $1.5 billion (3%), largely in Institutional ($2.7 billion), National Bank retail ($0.6 billion) ANZ Retail ($0.4 billion) and Corporate Banking ($0.6 billion) partly offset in Treasury (-$2.8 billion) with increased term funding allowing a reduction in shorter term commercial paper and certificate of deposit funding.

Overseas Markets increased by $4.9 billion largely due to increased commercial paper issuance by ANZ Delaware ($3.4 billion) and the requirement to fund balance sheet growth.

Payables and other liabilities ñ27%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ30%)

Payables and other liabilities increased $2.1 billion (27%) to $9.7 billion at 31 March 2006 with an increase in securities lending volumes in Institutional.

Derivatives ñ45%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ49%)

Derivative liabilities increased $1.9 billion to $6.1 billion at 31 March 2006.  The increase is driven by increased volatility in exchange rates, principally the significant movement in the NZD during March and increased trading activities.  The movement is consistent with the movement in Derivative assets

Bonds and Notes ñ20%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ14%)

Bonds and notes increased $7.9 billion to $46.9 billion at 31 March 2006.  Excluding exchange rate movements, bonds and notes increased by $5.5 billion in response to increased term funding requirements.

Loan Capital ñ22%  (Excl Exchange Rates ñ18%)

Loan capital increased $2.0 billion to $11.1 billion at 31 March 2006 in response to term funding requirements and the reclassification of ANZ StEPS from equity to debt on adoption of AIFRS on 1 October 2005.

 

30




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Capital Management

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Tier 1

 

6.8

%

6.9

%

7.0

%

Tier 2

 

4.0

%

3.9

%

3.6

%

Deductions

 

(0.4

%)

(0.3

%)

(0.3

%)

Total

 

10.4

%

10.5

%

10.3

%

ACE

 

5.0

%

5.1

%

5.1

%

RWA $m

 

230,653

 

219,573

 

209,524

 

ACE Ratio

The ACE ratio at 5.0% remains at the upper end of the Group’s targeted capital range.  During the period, ACE ratio declined 9 basis points principally due to:

§

net profit excluding preference share dividends of $1.8 billion (+82 basis points);

§

ordinary share dividend commitments of $1.0 billion (-47 basis points);

§

buy-back of ordinary equity of $146 million (-7 basis points) being offset by share issues of $179 million (+8 basis points) through the Bonus Option Plan, Dividend Reinvestment Plan, option conversions and issues to staff;

§

increase in risk weighted assets, excluding the impact of exchange rate movements (-30 basis points);

§

increase in investment/profit retention in funds management businesses and associates (-12 basis points); and

§

exchange rate movements and opening AIFRS adjustments had an immaterial impact.

Hybrid Capital and Tier 1 Capital

The Group raises hybrid capital to supplement the Group’s ACE capital to further strengthen the Group’s capital base and ensure compliance with APRA’s prudential capital requirements, principally its Tier 1 capital requirements.

At 31 March 2006 the Group had three Hybrid Capital instruments on issue:

Hybrid Capital details

 

ANZ StEPS

 

US Stapled Trust Security

 

Euro Hybrid

Amount (in issue currency)

 

$1,000 million

 

USD1,100 million

 

€500 million

Accounting classification

 

Debt

 

Debt

 

Equity

Regulatory (APRA) classification

 

Tier 1

 

Tier 1

 

Tier 1

March 2006 balance

 

$1,000 million

 

$1,536 million

 

$871 million

Interest rate

 

BBSW +1.00%

 

Tranche 1 Coupon: 4.48%

Tranche 2 Coupon: 5.36%

 

Euribor +0.66%

On adoption of AIFRS on 1 October 2005 the ANZ StEPS issue was reclassified from equity to debt, however, it continues to be classified as Tier 1 capital for regulatory purposes.

Buy-Back of Ordinary Equity

The Group commenced an on-market buy-back of $350 million of ordinary equity on 10 January 2005.  The buy-back was completed 14 March 2006 with the Group repurchasing 15.7 million shares at an average cost of $22.26 per share.  Shares repurchased for the current half-year was 6.1 million shares at an average cost of $24.02 per share, totalling $146 million.

Prudential Issues – APRA’s proposals on AIFRS changes and Tier 1 hybrid capital

APRA has recently released several announcements concerning the development of the prudential capital standards that will be adopted on 1 July 2006 post the adoption of AIFRS.  The final format and content of these standards are still subject to on-going discussions between APRA and the financial industry.

31




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Capital Management, cont’d

AIFRS and capital deductions

In November 2005, APRA issued draft prudential standards and guidance notes outlining the proposed prudential capital treatment of various adjustments arising from the adoption of AIFRS.  This statement was supplemented in March 2006 with the issue of a statement dealing with Capitalised Software Costs.  Based upon these statements and discussions to date with APRA, the issues that most affect ANZ are:

§     APRA introduced transition rules requiring ADIs to report their prudential capital ratios up until 1 July 2006 based upon AGAAP existing at 30 September 2005, unless otherwise agreed with APRA.  ANZ has agreed alternative arrangements with APRA and is reporting capital ratios based upon its financial statements subject to reversing the impact of recognising deferred pension liabilities, deferred fee revenue and cash flow hedge accounting of derivatives.  At 1 October 2005 the impact on ACE capital of the various AIFRS adjustments, net of the transitional rules, was a reduction of $48 million.

§      Effective 1 July 2006:

-  The transitional rules agreed with APRA will cease and a deduction for the pension liability ($91 million as at 31 March 2006) will be required to be taken; and

-  Capitalised Software Costs are classified as an intangible asset under AIFRS and APRA has indicated that they be taken as a Tier 1 deduction.  At 31 March 2006 ANZ had $384 million of capitalised software costs (before tax).

§     APRA introduced further transitional rules in their April 2006 statement on Tier 1 Capital and Securitisation, where ADIs will calculate the impact of AIFRS on their capital base at 1 July 2006, and this amount, the ‘IFRS transitional adjustment’, will be added back to an ADIs capital base between 1 July 2006 and 1 January 2008.  The ‘IFRS transitional adjustment’ will effectively defer any adverse impact from adopting AIFRS accounting until introduction of BASEL II.  ANZ is in discussion with APRA on this issue; based upon the items outlined above, ANZ would anticipate an add back to capital of approximately $500 million as an ‘IFRS transitional adjustment’.

Tier 1 Capital and Securitisation

In April 2006, APRA issued draft prudential standards and guidance notes outlining what instruments and items will qualify for Tier 1 and Tier 2 capital, including sub-categories therein for hybrid Tier 1, Lower and Upper Tier 2.  Material changes from the existing prudential standards are:

§     Introduction of a sub-category of Tier 1 capital being ‘Fundamental Tier 1’ which includes most components of shareholders equity, excluding hybrid Tier 1 instruments.  This sub-category must be at least 75% of net Tier 1, which effectively reduces the level of hybrid Tier 1 capital (‘Residual Tier 1’) to 25% of net Tier 1 – previously it was 25% of Tier 1 before deductions.

§     Splitting hybrid Tier 1 into two sub-categories, ‘Innovative’ and ‘Non-Innovative’ Tier 1, with limits of 15% and 10% of net Tier 1 respectively.  Transition rules will be available to ADI’s up until January 2010 if the ADI is above these limits when first measured on 1 January 2008 based upon hybrid Tier 1 instruments on issue at 31 August 2005 (subject to certain conditions being met).

§     The ‘Non-Innovative’ category is a new classification covering instruments that have the characteristics of ‘non-cumulative, irredeemable preference shares without innovative capital features’.

§     ANZ believes that its existing hybrid Tier 1 instruments will be classified as ‘Innovative’ and as such ANZ expects that it will be applying for the transitional relief contemplated in the draft standard.

32




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

ANZ National Bank - Integration

The integration program that began in 2004 has been completed during the half.  The key achievements in this half have been:

§    Transfer from Australia to New Zealand of the location and operation of ANZ Retail and related systems and functions to complete compliance with Reserve Bank of New Zealand (RBNZ) Conditions of Registration 13(i)

§    Completion of the successful migration to ANZ Group systems in Institutional, and Corporate Banking

§    Transition of all New Zealand processes and systems to Business-As-Usual management.

The integration objectives have been successfully achieved:

§    Business integration is complete.  This has delivered integration of organisational and management structures, processes, systems, and premises for Institutional, Corporate Banking, Rural Banking, Retail Banking support functions, head office and central support functions which has facilitated:

-   establishing a common platform for future growth initiatives and further transformation of support services

-   growing our Institutional businesses under the ANZ brand

-   maintaining separately branded Retail and Corporate Banking businesses

-   strengthening our Rural banking business primarily under National Bank brand

-   merging and rationalising head office and support functions

-   aligning, to the extent possible, ANZ National and ANZ technology systems and functions.

§    Compliance with RBNZ Conditions of Registration 13(i) relating to location and operation of “domestic” systems in New Zealand.  This delivered the transfer of ANZ Retail, HR/Payroll, and General Ledger systems to New Zealand, the augmentation of New Zealand-based IT support staff, and establishment of certain “new” New Zealand-based business functions

§    Customer satisfaction and retention targets have been achieved – revenue attrition relating to integration activities has continued to track favourably against estimates

§    Staff engagement has been achieved, and a single enterprise agreement has been established

§    Realisation of integration synergies has tracked in line with expectations.

Integration has successfully delivered a major program for ANZ National Bank:

§   30 workstreams comprising approximately 150 individual projects have progressed successfully in line with plans

§   Around 1300 system changes have been successfully implemented

§   At its peak over 600 staff were contributing to the program

§   126 property relocations were implemented

§   Project execution has been completed substantially by the ambitious target of December 2005, with the final major deliverables completed in February 2006.

The RBNZ finalised its Outsourcing Policy in January 2006.  The Policy addresses the location and management of so called core functions requiring ANZ National Bank to maintain continuity of core functions - settlement, clearance, payment and risk position management – particularly in a stress or failure situation.  Discussions continue with the RBNZ on outlining ANZ National Bank’s approach to compliance with the Policy.

As the full impact of RBNZ requirements under the Conditions of Registration were clarified, the total cost of integration increased.  The total cost of integration has been NZD239 million, in line with the estimate of NZD240 million advised in October 2005 and a modest increase on the original estimate of NZD220 million.  Of this amount, approximately 5% has been met by a restructuring charge included in the calculation of goodwill; a further 10% relates to expenditure on equipment that has been capitalised and 22% relates to the cost of existing resources.  Integration costs of NZD9 million were incurred in 2004, with the majority of integration costs of NZD139 million incurred in 2005.  Expenditure of NZD51 million was incurred in this first half of 2006.  These costs related primarily to systems and technology integration and non-branch expenses, with NZD46 million incurred in meeting RBNZ requirements, NZD19 million expenditure on integrating essential technology infrastructure and NZD174 million expenditure on the core business program of integration.

Revenue attrition relating to integration activities has continued to track favourably against expectations, with little attrition evident, and has stabilised at NZD34 million per annum.  The cost synergies and revenue benefits, net of NZD12 million cost increase impact of RBNZ requirements have increased to an estimated NZD120 million in 2007 (cost synergies NZD70 million and revenue synergies NZD50 million, with additional cost synergies identified.)

33




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

ING Australia performance

The results in the table below show the performance of INGA on a fully comparable AIFRS basis, other than the half year to March 2005 which adopts AIFRS from 1 January 2005 (i.e. commencement of INGA’s financial year).  In addition, the results have been restated to exclude net profits from the New Zealand business that INGA sold in September 2005; these are included in New Zealand Businesses.

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

 

 

Note

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Funds management income

 

 

 

208

 

191

 

177

 

9

%

18

%

Life Risk Income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

- planned margin

 

 

 

89

 

85

 

83

 

5

%

7

%

- experience variation

 

1

 

33

 

25

 

27

 

32

%

22

%

 

 

 

 

122

 

110

 

110

 

11

%

11

%

Total Income

 

 

 

330

 

301

 

287

 

10

%

15

%

Funds management expenses

 

 

 

(136

)

(125

)

(128

)

9

%

6

%

Life risk expenses

 

 

 

(64

)

(39

)

(45

)

64

%

42

%

Remediation Expenses

 

2

 

(24

)

(23

)

(15

)

4

%

60

%

Tax on operating profit

 

3

 

(18

)

(32

)

(15

)

-44

%

20

%

Operating profit after tax, before capital investment earnings

 

 

 

88

 

82

 

84

 

7

%

5

%

Capital investment earnings after tax

 

 

 

28

 

63

 

70

 

-56

%

-60

%

Profit after tax

 

 

 

116

 

145

 

154

 

-20

%

-25

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ANZ’s Share of INGA earnings @ 49%

 

 

 

57

 

71

 

76

 

-20

%

-25

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ANZ’s Share of INGA earnings @ 49%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

JV operating profit

 

 

 

43

 

40

 

41

 

8

%

5

%

JV capital investment earnings

 

 

 

14

 

31

 

35

 

-55

%

-60

%

 

 

 

 

57

 

71

 

76

 

-20

%

-25

%

ANZ capital Hedges

 

 

 

-

 

(10

)

(11

)

 

 

 

 

Net Funding

 

 

 

1

 

-

 

2

 

 

 

 

 

Net Return to ANZ

 

4

 

58

 

61

 

67

 

-5

%

-13

%

Performance measures

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Carrying value of investment ($M)

 

5

 

1,407

 

1,392

 

1,404

 

 

 

 

 

ANZ return on investment

 

5

 

8.1

%

10.2

%

10.8

%

 

 

 

 

Available for Sale reserve (ANZ share) ($M)

 

 

 

14

 

8

 

12

 

 

 

 

 

Value of new business

 

6

 

34

 

33

 

29

 

 

 

 

 

Cost to Income

 

7

 

60

%

58

%

59

%

 

 

 

 

Funds management

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Retail & mezzanine funds under management (c/bal $M)

 

 

 

33,731

 

31,696

 

29,390

 

6

%

15

%

Net retail & mezzanine flows ($M)

 

 

 

415

 

216

 

259

 

92

%

60

%

Life risk

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total in-force ($M)

 

 

 

536

 

496

 

482

 

8

%

11

%

New premiums ($M)

 

 

 

65

 

62

 

53

 

5

%

23

%

 

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

In-

 

Out-

 

Other

 

Sep 05

 

Funds management growth (Retail & mezzanine)

 

8

 

$M

 

flows

 

flows

 

Flows

 

$M

 

OneAnswer

 

 

 

12,861

 

1,890

 

(1,080

)

597

 

11,454

 

Other Personal Investment

 

 

 

9,381

 

247

 

(837

)

482

 

9,489

 

Mezzanine

 

 

 

2,466

 

249

 

(316

)

108

 

2,426

 

Employer Super

 

 

 

9,023

 

837

 

(574

)

433

 

8,327

 

Total

 

 

 

33,731

 

3,223

 

(2,807

)

1,620

 

31,696

 

 

1.

Experience gains or losses arise where actual outcomes differ from valuation methods and assumptions

2.

Remediation expenses represent costs incurred in rectifying historical unit pricing errors and fully compensating customers

3.

Transitional tax relief for life insurance companies discontinued with effect from 1 July 2005

4.

On 30 September 2005 ING Australia sold its New Zealand based businesses to a joint venture between ING Group and ANZ National Bank (further details are contained on page 11). As a result, prior period profits relating to the sold operations (Sep 2005: $4 million; Mar 2005: $4 million) are now reflected in the ING NZ joint venture

5.

ANZ adopts the equity method of accounting for its 49% interest in INGA. The carrying value of the investment in INGA has been tested for impairment by comparing the carrying value with the recoverable amount of INGA. The Group engaged Ernst & Young ABC Limited (EY ABC) to provide an independent valuation of INGA for 31 March 2006 assessment purposes (the recoverable amount). The independent economic valuation was based on a discounted cash flow approach, with allowance for the cost of capital. Based on the results of this valuation, no change is required to the carrying value of the investment in INGA

6.

Value of new business represents the present value of future profits arising from the new business written over the periods less the present value of the cost of capital applying to that new business. Consistent value factors are applied across all reporting periods

7.

Cost to Income ratio is management expenses (excluding Remediation Expenses) / Total Income

8.

Other Flows includes investment income net of taxes, fees and charges

34




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

ING Australia performance, cont’d

March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

Highlights of the March 2006 half year included the launch of INGA’s new retail risk product, “OneCare” and a marked improvement in net inflows of retail and mezzanine funds management products, up 92%.  The increase was driven by strong inflows into INGA’s flagship platform product, OneAnswer, and lower outflows across INGA’s wealth management products.  INGA also acquired majority ownership of Oasis Asset Management, a rapidly growing provider of badged platform products to non-aligned advisers.

Considerable progress was made in remediation of products and systems.  This work is now separated from INGA’s core business and is scheduled for completion by 31 December 2006.

INGA has maintained its market share rankings over the period.  In Funds Management the improvement in net flows over the year has lifted INGA’s ranking to 6th position as reported by Plan For Life.  INGA maintained its 3rd place ranking in the employer super mastertrust segment as measured by DEXX&R.  INGA’s rankings in the life risk market for both new business (3rd) and Inforce premiums (4th) as measured by Plan for Life remained unchanged.

A core component of INGA’s strategy is to grow the number of aligned advisers.  Following the acquisition of the Synergy dealer group in December 2005 the total number of INGA ‘aligned advisers’ grew to 1,093.  According to the latest Money Management Survey, INGA would rank 4th in terms of number of advisers, up from 7th position in the previous half.

Profit after tax decreased by 20% on the September 2005 half year.  Operating profit after tax was 7% higher, but more than offset by lower capital investment earnings.  Significant factors affecting the result were:

§     Funds management income increased by 9% based on higher average funds under management underpinned by strong investment markets, and improved net flows in both personal investments and employer super businesses.  The increased fee revenue driven by these factors was partly offset by reduced margins arising from higher commission payments.

§     Risk income increased by 11%.  Operating margins relating to INGA’s life risk business increased by 6% following better client retention and improved claims experience.

§     Funds management expenses increased by 9% due to higher spend on customer service.  Life risk expenses increased due to costs incurred in developing the new OneCare product and other non-recurring items.  Remediation expenses are at similar levels to the September 2005 half and should be completed by the end of the calendar year.

§     Tax on operating profit decreased 44% due to favourable prior period tax adjustments in the current half, partially offset by the loss of transitional tax relief for life companies from 1 July 2005.

§     Capital investment earnings after tax declined 56% from the strong September 2005 half due to lower average capital employed in the business together with lower average yields.  In 2005, ANZ partially hedged against volatility in this income stream and, as a result, gains in capital investment earnings were partially offset by hedge losses.  ANZ ceased hedging capital investment earnings from 1 October 2005.

Adviser Numbers

(by Dealer Group)

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 05

 

Mvmt

 

ANZ Financial Planners

 

348

 

305

 

14%

 

Retire Invest

 

214

 

214

 

0%

 

Tandem

 

84

 

79

 

6%

 

Millenium 3

 

446

 

350

 

27%

 

ING Financial Planners

 

21

 

2

 

large

 

Other

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total

 

1,113

 

950

 

17%

 

Sales by Channel

(12 months )

 

Retail Funds
Management

 

Life Insurance

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 05

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ANZ Bank

 

47%

 

50%

 

12%

 

10%

 

IFAs aligned to ING

 

17%

 

18%

 

8%

 

9%

 

Direct

 

7%

 

7%

 

49%

 

41%

 

Other

 

29%

 

25%

 

31%

 

39%

 

Total

 

100%

 

100%

 

100%

 

100%

 

March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

Profit after tax decreased by 25% compared to the same period last year. Operating profit after tax was 5% higher, but more than offset by lower capital investment earnings.  Significant factors impacting the result were:

§     Funds management income increased by 18% based on higher average funds under management underpinned by strong investment markets, and improved net flows.

§     Risk income increased by 11% due to ongoing favourable claims experience in the March 2006 half, supported by continued strong sales of life insurance products through the ANZ network and direct marketing initiatives.

§     Expenses increased due to higher spend on customer service in funds management together with additional costs associated with the new OneCare product and other non-recurring items in the life risk business.  Remediation expenses increased by 60% as activity increased.

§     Tax on operating profit increased by 20% due to the loss of transitional tax relief for life companies from 1 July 2005, and was partially offset by lower favourable prior period tax adjustments booked in the current half.

35




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

ING New Zealand joint venture

In September 2005 ANZ National Bank Limited entered into a joint venture with ING Insurance International Limited (INGII).  The joint venture, ING (NZ) Holdings Ltd (INGNZ), is 49% owned by ANZ National Bank Limited and 51% owned by INGII.

The Group adopts the equity method of accounting for its 49% interest in INGNZ.  As at 31 March 2006, the equity accounted value was NZD156 million (Sep 2005: NZD145 million).  The change since September 2005 reflects the equity accounted profit for the half year.

The carrying value is subject to a recoverable amount test to ensure that this does not exceed its recoverable amount at the reporting date.  The Group obtained an independent valuation at 31 March 2006 to ensure the carrying value did not exceed the recoverable amount.  The valuation supported the carrying value and accordingly no write-down was made.

In the March 2006 half INGNZ contributed NZD12 million in equity accounted earnings.  This was a NZD3.1 million reduction on the September 2005 half in which a total of NZD15.2 million (Mar 2005: NZD14.1 million) was reported between INGA (Sep 2005: NZD4 million; Mar 2005: NZD 4 million) and the New Zealand Businesses (Sep 2005: NZD11 million; Mar 2005: NZD10 million), prior to the establishment of the joint venture.

Deferred acquisition costs and deferred income

The Group recognises assets that represent deferred acquisition costs relating to the acquisition of interest earning assets, and liabilities that represent deferred income relating to income received in advance of services performed.

Deferred acquisition costs - at 31 March 2006 the Group’s assets included $549 million (Sep 2005: $524 million; Mar 2005: $492 million) in relation to costs incurred in acquiring interest earning assets.  During the half year, amortisation of $138 million (Sep 2005 half: $135 million; Mar 2005 half: $123 million) was recognised as an adjustment to the yield earned on interest earning assets.

Deferred income - at 31 March 2006, the Group’s liabilities included $426 million (Sep 2005: $92 million; Mar 2005: $130 million) in relation to income received in advance.  At March 2006, this includes $5 million (Sep 2005: $3 million; Mar 2005 $4 million) deferred service type fees.  These fees are deferred and will be amortised over the period of service under the AIFRS standard AASB 118: ‘Revenue’.

At March 2006, fee income of $364 million that is integral to the yield of an originated financial instrument, net of any direct incremental costs, has been capitalised.  This income is deferred and recognised against net loans and advances over the expected life of the financial instrument under the AIFRS standard AASB 139: ‘Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement’.

The balances of deferred acquisition costs and deferred income at period end were:

 

Deferred Acquisition Costs1

 

Deferred Income

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

155

 

153

 

151

 

90

 

32

 

24

 

Esanda

 

294

 

284

 

260

 

52

 

-

 

-

 

New Zealand Businesses

 

67

 

61

 

49

 

39

 

15

 

26

 

Institutional

 

5

 

6

 

10

 

162

 

27

 

30

 

Other2

 

28

 

20

 

22

 

83

 

18

 

50

 

Total

 

549

 

524

 

492

 

426

 

92

 

130

 

 

1.

Deferred acquisition costs largely include the amounts of brokerage capitalised and amortised in the three Business segments: Personal Banking Australia, Esanda and the New Zealand businesses.  Deferred acquisition costs also include capitalised debt raising expenses

2.

Includes Group Centre, Corporate Australia, INGA and Asia Pacific

 

Deferred acquisition costs analysis:

 

 

March 2006

 

September 2005 half

 

 

 

Amortisation

 

Capitalised

 

Amortisation

 

Capitalised

 

 

 

Costs

 

Costs1

 

Costs

 

Costs1

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

34

 

36

 

31

 

33

 

Esanda

 

87

 

97

 

86

 

110

 

New Zealand Businesses

 

13

 

24

 

13

 

23

 

Institutional

 

1

 

-

 

2

 

(2

)

Other2

 

3

 

11

 

3

 

3

 

Total

 

138

 

168

 

135

 

167

 

 

 

1.

Costs capitalised during the half exclude brokerage trailer commissions paid, relating to the acquisition of mortgage assets

2.

Includes Group Centre, Corporate Australia, INGA and Asia Pacific

 

36




CHIEF FINANCIAL OFFICER’S REVIEW (continued)

Software capitalisation

At March 2006, the Group’s intangibles included $384 million (Sep 2005: $381 million; Mar 2005: $401 million) in relation to costs incurred in acquiring and developing software.  During the March 2006 half year, amortisation expense of $56 million (Sep 2005 half: $64 million; Mar 2005 half: $57 million) was recognised.

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Balance at start of period

 

381

 

401

 

430

 

-5%

 

-11%

 

Software capitalised during the period

 

60

 

51

 

45

 

18%

 

33%

 

Amortisation during the period

 

(56

)

(64

)

(57

)

-13%

 

-2%

 

Software written-off

 

(1

)

(8

)

(16

)

-88%

 

-94%

 

Other

 

-

 

1

 

(1

)

-100%

 

-100%

 

Total software capitalisation

 

384

 

381

 

401

 

1%

 

-4%

 

 

37




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW

Profit and Loss (including effect of movements in foreign currencies)

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net profit after income tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

542

 

485

 

468

 

12%

 

16%

 

Institutional

 

486

 

461

 

450

 

5%

 

8%

 

New Zealand Businesses

 

335

 

265

 

295

 

26%

 

14%

 

Corporate Australia

 

212

 

194

 

182

 

9%

 

16%

 

Esanda and UDC

 

53

 

55

 

66

 

-4%

 

-20%

 

Asia Pacific

 

46

 

44

 

39

 

5%

 

18%

 

Non-continuing businesses

 

30

 

63

 

63

 

-52%

 

-52%

 

Group Centre

 

27

 

16

 

5

 

69%

 

large

 

Cash1 profit3

 

1,731

 

1,583

 

1,568

 

9%

 

10%

 

AIFRS 2005 adjustments and non-core items1

 

80

 

37

 

(13

)

large

 

large

 

Net profit

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

 

Refer to page 6 for a table of Net profit after income tax prepared on a statutory basis

Profit and Loss (prior period figures adjusted to remove the impact of exchange rate movements2)

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net profit after income tax

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

542

 

485

 

468

 

12%

 

16%

 

Institutional

 

486

 

461

 

450

 

5%

 

8%

 

New Zealand Businesses

 

335

 

263

 

293

 

27%

 

14%

 

Corporate Australia

 

212

 

194

 

182

 

9%

 

16%

 

Esanda and UDC

 

53

 

55

 

65

 

-4%

 

-18%

 

Asia Pacific

 

46

 

45

 

40

 

2%

 

15%

 

Non-continuing businesses

 

30

 

62

 

64

 

-52%

 

-53%

 

Group Centre

 

27

 

23

 

9

 

17%

 

large

 

Net profit (adjusted for non-core items1,2,3)

 

1,731

 

1,588

 

1,571

 

9%

 

11%

 

AIFRS 2005 adjustments1 and non-core items2

 

80

 

37

 

(13

)

large

 

large

 

Net profit3

 

1,811

 

1,625

 

1,558

 

12%

 

17%

 

FX impact on reported net profit2

 

-

 

(5

)

(3

)

-100%

 

-100%

 

Reported net profit

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

 

1.

ANZ has reduced the September 2005 profit after tax by $46 million (Mar 2005: $15 million increase) to bring the result for that period to an AIFRS basis that is fully comparable with March 2006 figures (refer pages 11 to 14), allowing readers to see the impact on 2005 results of accounting standards that have only been applied from 1 October 2005.  No adjustment has been made to retrospectively designate derivatives hedging the Group’s funding on the basis of impracticability.  In the March 2006 half ANZ has classified the $113 million ($79 million after tax) settlement of the NHB insurance matter and the $14 million after tax settlement of warranty claims on Lloyds TSB plc (tax on warranty settlement: $nil) as significant items.  In the September 2005 half ANZ classified $14 million after tax profit on the sale of NBNZ life and funds management businesses as a significant item (tax on gain on sale of NBNZ life and funds management businesses: $nil).  ANZ excludes significant items to eliminate the distorting effect of one-off transactions on the results of its core business (refer page 11).  In the March 2006 half ANZ has classified $13 million after tax profit (Sep 2005: $12 million; Mar 2005 $19 million) on derivatives entered into to manage interest rate and foreign exchange risk on funding instruments, not designated as accounting hedges, ineffective portions of cash flow hedges, profit or loss on disposal of investment securities, and fair value movement in bonds and notes designated at fair value as a non-core item.  ANZ excludes volatility associated with fair value movements on these transactions to provide a better indication of the core business performance (tax on hedge gains/losses $5 million (Sep 2005: $5 million; Mar 2005: $8 million)).  In the March 2006 half ANZ has incurred $26 million after tax ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs (Sep 2005 half: $35 million; Mar 2005 half: $17 million).  Tax on ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs is $13 million (Sep 2005: $18 million; Mar 2005: $8 million).  ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs are excluded to better reflect the core cost base and assist analysis of the cost base following completion of the integration (refer page 11)

2.

ANZ has removed the impact of exchange rate movements to provide readers with a better indication of the business unit performance in local currency terms.  Retranslation is net of revenue hedge earnings

3.

Refer pages 13 and 14 of enclosed report for a detailed reconciliation of GAAP figures to non GAAP cash figures.  Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believes measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZ financial condition and results of operations

 

The Group from time to time modifies the organisation of its businesses to enhance the focus on delivery of specialised products or services to customers.  Prior period numbers are adjusted for such organisational changes to allow comparability.  The significant changes since 30 September 2005 have been:

§     Non-Continuing Business - The Non-Continuing Business comprising the London headquartered project finance and certain structured finance transactions that ANZ has exited as part of its de-risking strategy has been removed from Institutional and reported as a separate business unit.

§     Personal Banking – Within Personal banking Wealth Management has been renamed Investment Insurance Products.

§     There were also a number of minor restatements as a result of customer segmentation, changes to internal transfer pricing methodologies and the realignment of support functions.

§     ANZ has netted inter-business unit expenses and inter-business unit income and reported as an expense for business unit profitability purposes.

38




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW (continued)

 

Personal Banking Australia

Brian Hartzer

 

 

 

     Rural Commercial and

    Consumer Finance

 

Agribusiness Products

    Investment Insurance Products

 

     Banking Products

    Other 1

 

     Mortgages

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income

 

1,177

 

1,122

 

1,061

 

5%

 

11%

 

Other external operating income

 

509

 

483

 

452

 

5%

 

13%

 

Operating income

 

1,686

 

1,605

 

1,513

 

5%

 

11%

 

External operating expenses

 

(726

)

(705

)

(677

)

3%

 

7%

 

Net inter business unit expenses

 

(88

)

(90

)

(82

)

-2%

 

7%

 

Operating expenses

 

(814

)

(795

)

(759

)

2%

 

7%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

872

 

810

 

754

 

8%

 

16%

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

(117

)

(133

)

(103

)

-12%

 

14%

 

Profit before income tax

 

755

 

677

 

651

 

12%

 

16%

 

Income tax expense and minority interest

 

(213

)

(192

)

(183

)

11%

 

16%

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

542

 

485

 

468

 

12%

 

16%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consisting of:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Rural Commercial and Agribusiness Products

 

55

 

48

 

49

 

15%

 

12%

 

Banking Products

 

138

 

130

 

123

 

6%

 

12%

 

Mortgages

 

177

 

156

 

146

 

13%

 

21%

 

Consumer Finance

 

115

 

101

 

103

 

14%

 

12%

 

Investment and Insurance Products

 

60

 

52

 

51

 

15%

 

18%

 

Other2

 

(3

)

(2

)

(4

)

50%

 

-25%

 

 

 

542

 

485

 

468

 

12%

 

16%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance Sheet

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loans & advances including acceptances

 

112,212

 

105,681

 

99,681

 

6%

 

13%

 

Other external assets

 

2,196

 

1,840

 

1,979

 

19%

 

11%

 

External assets

 

114,408

 

107,521

 

101,660

 

6%

 

13%

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

46,261

 

43,773

 

41,750

 

6%

 

11%

 

Other external liabilities

 

2,500

 

2,268

 

2,058

 

10%

 

21%

 

External liabilities

 

48,761

 

46,041

 

43,808

 

6%

 

11%

 

Risk Weighted Assets

 

62,184

 

58,489

 

54,897

 

6%

 

13%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ratios

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest margin

 

2.16%

 

2.16%

 

2.19%

 

 

 

 

 

Return on assets

 

0.98%

 

0.92%

 

0.95%

 

 

 

 

 

Return on risk weighted assets

 

1.81%

 

1.69%

 

1.77%

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses to operating income

 

48.3%

 

49.5%

 

50.2%

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses to average assets

 

1.47%

 

1.52%

 

1.54%

 

 

 

 

 

Individual provision charge

 

(86)

 

(87)

 

(60)

 

 

 

 

 

Individual provision charge as a % of average net advances

 

0.16%

 

0.17%

 

0.12%

 

 

 

 

 

Net impaired loans

 

24

 

19

 

15

 

26%

 

60%

 

Net impaired loans as a % of net advances

 

0.02%

 

0.02%

 

0.02%

 

 

 

 

 

Total employees

 

9,799

 

9,616

 

9,254

 

2%

 

6%

 

 

1.

2005 figures include allocations to make them comparable with March 2006

2.

Other includes the branch network, whose costs are fully recovered from product business units, Private Banking and marketing and support costs

Core business performance excludes significant items and AIFRS adjustments

 

39




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW (continued)

 

Personal Banking Australia

Brian Hartzer

March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

Profit after tax increased 12%, underpinned by strong loan and deposit growth (balances increased 6% in both categories) while maintaining a disciplined approach to pricing.  Overall returns on risk adjusted assets increased, with margin growth in higher risk products offsetting the expected rise in bad debt costs.

Balance sheet growth drove the double digit earnings growth in Mortgages and Consumer Finance, while Rural Commercial and Agribusiness benefited from an improved credit environment.  Banking Products continued to grow the deposit book above system levels.  Investment & Insurance Products experienced strong growth from financial planner sales and other ‘direct’ investment businesses and benefited from a 7% increase in INGA income.

Significant aspects to the result were:

§             Overall net interest income increased 5%.  Mortgages and Rural Commercial and Agribusiness Products net interest income grew 6% in line with balance sheet growth as margins were held.  Consumer Finance net interest income increased 6% with strong balance sheet growth of 10% partly offset by margin decline driven by strong growth in the lower rate MasterCard product.  Banking Products net interest income increased by 3% with good deposit growth of 6% being partly offset by ongoing migration into lower margin products within the portfolio.

§             Other operating income increased 5%.  Mortgages grew other income 28%, while Consumer Finance was relatively flat.  Banking Products grew other income by 5% from higher numbers of transaction accounts.  Financial planning income was up 11% from higher sales volumes.  The contribution from the INGA increased following strong funds management and life risk performances.  The underlying momentum in this business remains sound as market conditions are favourable and the life business continues to experience low levels of claims.

§             Operating costs increased 2% as the footprint expanded with 11 new branches and 134 more ATMs.  This contributed to a 5% increase in premises costs and a 5% increase in personnel costs, with the latter also affected by annual salary rises.  Computer costs fell as the previous half included charges for branch software now amortised fully.

§             Credit costs reduced 12% overall as there was a $16 million beneficial adjustment in collective provisions due to a revision to oil price risk.  Despite strong balance sheet growth individual provisions were flat reflecting seasonally lower March half year charges.

March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

Profit after tax increased 16% with double digit profit growth recorded by all Personal businesses driven by a strong income performance.

Operating income increased 11% driven by strong volume growth across all businesses partly offset by margin contraction as higher growth was experienced in lower margin business.  Double digit income growth was achieved by Mortgages (14%), Consumer Finance (13%) and Investment & Insurance Products.  Sound revenue growth was achieved in Banking Products revenues (8%) and Rural Commercial and Agribusiness (7%).  All businesses benefited from the investment in staff through the continued expansion of the footprint.

Operating expenses increased 7%, resulting from higher numbers of front line staff to service increased business volumes and ongoing investment in the branch network.

Credit impairment rose largely due to increases in overall lending volumes and the planned higher relative growth of Consumer Finance businesses, partly offset by a lower level of collective provisioning due to a revision to oil price risk.

40




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW (continued)

 

Institutional

Steve Targett

 

 

 

     Client Relationship Group

     Corporate and Structured Financing

 

     Trade and Transaction Services

     Debt Product Group

 

     Markets

 

 

     Other 1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net interest income

 

568

 

509

 

544

 

12%

 

4%

 

Other external operating income

 

590

 

577

 

493

 

2%

 

20%

 

Operating income

 

1,158

 

1,086

 

1,037

 

7%

 

12%

 

External operating expenses

 

(339

)

(324

)

(310

)

5%

 

9%

 

Net inter business unit expenses

 

(90

)

(78

)

(72

)

15%

 

25%

 

Operating expenses

 

(429

)

(402

)

(382

)

7%

 

12%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

729

 

684

 

655

 

7%

 

11%

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

(33

)

(30

)

(21

)

10%

 

57%

 

Profit before income tax

 

696

 

654

 

634

 

6%

 

10%

 

Income tax expense and minority interest

 

(210

)

(193

)

(184

)

9%

 

14%

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

486

 

461

 

450

 

5%

 

8%

 

Consisting of:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Trade & Transaction Services

 

115

 

104

 

101

 

11%

 

14%

 

Markets

 

144

 

128

 

117

 

13%

 

23%

 

Corporate and Structured Financing

 

79

 

66

 

65

 

20%

 

22%

 

Debt Product Group

 

199

 

213

 

218

 

-7%

 

-9%

 

Other1

 

(51

)

(50

)

(51

)

2%

 

-

 

 

 

486

 

461

 

450

 

5%

 

8%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance Sheet

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loans & advances including acceptances

 

46,344

 

43,404

 

40,168

 

7%

 

15%

 

Other external assets

 

35,658

 

26,439

 

23,672

 

35%

 

51%

 

External assets

 

82,002

 

69,843

 

63,840

 

17%

 

28%

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

36,205

 

32,403

 

31,886

 

12%

 

14%

 

Other external liabilities

 

31,389

 

22,712

 

20,660

 

38%

 

52%

 

External liabilities

 

67,594

 

55,115

 

52,546

 

23%

 

29%

 

Risk Weighted Assets

 

78,691

 

72,429

 

68,797

 

9%

 

14%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ratios

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest margin

 

1.66%

 

1.70%

 

2.02%

 

 

 

 

 

Return on assets

 

1.28%

 

1.33%

 

1.50%

 

 

 

 

 

Return on risk weighted assets

 

1.28%

 

1.33%

 

1.39%

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses to operating income

 

37.0%

 

37.0%

 

36.8%

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses to average assets

 

1.13%

 

1.16%

 

1.27%

 

 

 

 

 

Individual provision charge

 

(38)

 

(11)

 

(12)

 

large

 

large

 

Individual provision charge as a % of average net advances

 

0.17%

 

0.05%

 

0.06%

 

 

 

 

 

Net impaired loans

 

249

 

123

 

114

 

large

 

large

 

Net impaired loans as a % of net advances

 

0.54%

 

0.28%

 

0.28%

 

 

 

 

 

Total employees

 

3,092

 

3,047

 

2,864

 

1%

 

8%

 

 

1.

Other includes Executive, Infrastructure and Client Relationship Group costs, not all of which are allocated to the Institutional businesses

Core business performance excludes significant items and AIFRS adjustments

 

41




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW (continued)

 

Institutional

Steve Targett

March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

Profit after tax increased by $25 million (5%), as growth momentum established in the last half continued to strengthen.  Strategic initiatives, aimed at tightening client focus and increasing solution driven sales, began to deliver improved results across the Institutional businesses this half.

Non-lending revenue increased reflecting the success of continuing efforts to move the mix of business from the debt product with disciplined use of capital and strong risk management.  The Client Relationship Group actively leads the delivery of our client solutions.

Profit from Markets increased by 13% driven by a strong performance in New Zealand where currency and interest rate moves created favourable trading conditions, compared to the less volatile environment and softer corporate demand in the Australian market.  Trade and Transaction Services increased 11% with high growth in the International Payments and Clearing Services business, strong offshore Trade Finance growth and the release of revenue that related to prior years.  Corporate and Structured Financing profit increased 20% with a lower credit impairment charge resulting from the write-back of individual provisions during the half.  Asset growth in the Debt Products Group was offset by competitive pressures and tighter credit spreads resulting in reduced margins and a 7% decrease in earnings.  Credit quality remains sound.

Significant factors affecting the result were:

§             Net interest income grew by $59 million (12%).  Trade and Transaction Services increased $29 million including increased deposit volumes and the release of revenue that related to prior years, partly offset by reduced lending volumes in International Trade Finance.  Markets increased $11 million, Debt Products Group increased by $7 million, with lending growth of 2% offset by tighter spreads and competition causing margin erosion and Corporate and Structured Financing increased $12 million.

§             Overall loan volumes increased 7%, while deposit volumes increased 12%.  Net interest margin decreased by 4 basis points.

§             Other operating income increased $13 million (2%).  Markets increased $27 million (9%) on the back of a strong New Zealand result and Trade and Transaction Services increased $5 million.  Corporate and Structured Financing other operating income reduced $13 million (14%), with strong contributions from structured finance and private equity offset by reduced advisory fees following the particularly strong September 2005 half.  Other operating income reduced by $5 million in Debt Products Group, driven by competitive pricing pressure.

§             Operating expenses have increased by 7%, reflecting the investment being made in new growth initiatives and higher non-lending losses.  Salary expenses increased 4%, and staff numbers increased by 1%.  Institutional is building its staff capabilities to facilitate greater penetration of new business opportunities.

§             Provision for credit impairment increased by $3 million.  The individual provision charge was $27 million higher, with two large new provisions in the half in Australia and New Zealand offset by recoveries.  The collective provision charge reduced by $24 million with a reduction in the provision held for oil price risk, the impact of the increase in individual provisions resulting from the down-grade of two large exposures to non-accrual and a stable risk profile on our lending assets.  Net impaired loans have increased by $126 million due largely to two corporate accounts in Australia and New Zealand.

March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

Profit after tax increased by $36 million (8%).

Operating income increased by 12%.  Revenue in Trade and Transaction Services increased $54 million on the back of stronger trade flows through Asia and the UK, increased International Payments foreign exchange revenue and the prior year income booked in the March 2006 half.  Markets revenue increased $58 million with stronger client and trading activities in Australia, New Zealand, the Pacific and Asia.  Debt Products Group increased 1% with higher revenue and lending volume growth offset by margin contraction.

Operating expenses increased 12%.  Staff costs were higher, due to investment in people, new capabilities and systems.

Provision for credit impairment increased $12 million.  Individual provisions increased reflecting the down-grade of two large accounts during the current half.  Collective provision reduced reflecting the factors mentioned above.

42




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW (continued)

 

New Zealand Businesses

Graham Hodges

 

 

 

     ANZ Retail

    Corporate Banking

 

     National Bank Retail

    Central Support (including Treasury)

 

     Rural Banking

    Excludes Institutional, UDC,

 

 

integration and central funding

 

 

 

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

NZD M

 

NZD M

 

NZD M

 

%

 

%

 

Net interest income

 

811

 

780

 

774

 

4%

 

5%

 

Other external operating income

 

268

 

270

 

253

 

-1%

 

6%

 

Operating income

 

1,079

 

1,050

 

1,027

 

3%

 

5%

 

External operating expenses

 

(538

)

(533

)

(496

)

1%

 

8%

 

Net inter business unit expenses

 

3

 

2

 

(4

)

50%

 

large

 

Operating expenses

 

(535

)

(531

)

(500

)

1%

 

7%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

544

 

519

 

527

 

5%

 

3%

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

(3

)

(97

)

(56

)

-97%

 

-95%

 

Profit before income tax

 

541

 

422

 

471

 

28%

 

15%

 

Income tax expense and minority interest

 

(175

)

(134

)

(151

)

31%

 

16%

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company (NZD)

 

366

 

288

 

320

 

27%

 

14%

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company (AUD)

 

335

 

265

 

295

 

26%

 

14%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consisting of:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ANZ Retail

 

98

 

92

 

99

 

7%

 

-1%

 

NBNZ Retail

 

128

 

109

 

110

 

17%

 

16%

 

Rural Banking

 

44

 

43

 

42

 

2%

 

5%

 

Corporate Banking

 

79

 

32

 

53

 

large

 

49%

 

Central Support

 

17

 

12

 

16

 

42%

 

6%

 

 

 

366

 

288

 

320

 

27%

 

14%

 

Balance Sheet

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loans & advances including acceptances

 

64,866

 

60,656

 

56,777

 

7%

 

14%

 

Other external assets

 

6,120

 

5,290

 

4,156

 

16%

 

47%

 

External assets

 

70,986

 

65,946

 

60,933

 

8%

 

16%

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

49,288

 

50,676

 

50,648

 

-3%

 

-3%

 

Other external liabilities

 

10,265

 

8,083

 

5,308

 

27%

 

93%

 

External liabilities

 

59,553

 

58,759

 

55,956

 

1%

 

6%

 

Risk Weighted Assets

 

52,015

 

48,098

 

45,381

 

8%

 

15%

 

Ratios

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest margin

 

2.42%

 

2.49%

 

2.68%

 

 

 

 

 

Return on assets

 

1.07%

 

0.91%

 

1.09%

 

 

 

 

 

Return on risk weighted assets

 

1.47%

 

1.27%

 

1.46%

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses to operating income

 

49.6%

 

50.6%

 

48.7%

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses to average assets

 

1.57%

 

1.67%

 

1.71%

 

 

 

 

 

Individual provision charge

 

(7)

 

(70)

 

(28)

 

-90%

 

-75%

 

Individual provision charge as a % of average net advances

 

0.02%

 

0.24%

 

0.10%

 

 

 

 

 

Net impaired loans

 

75

 

111

 

38

 

-32%

 

97%

 

Net impaired loans as a % of net advances

 

0.12%

 

0.18%

 

0.07%

 

 

 

 

 

Total employees

 

8,466

 

8,580

 

8,437

 

-1%

 

0%

 

 

Core business performance excludes significant items and AIFRS adjustments

 

43




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW (continued)

 

New Zealand businesses

Graham Hodges

March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

Profit after tax for the New Zealand Businesses increased NZD78 million (27%) over the September 2005 half, assisted by a NZD63 million after tax reduction in the Provision for credit impairment.  Profit before provisions increased 5%.

ANZ Retail, National Bank Retail and Corporate Banking posted strong profit growth with increases of 7%, 17% and 147% respectively.  Solid asset growth in these businesses was partly offset by lower net interest margins due to price competition, increased wholesale funding, and continued unfavourable product mix with switching from variable rate to fixed rate mortgages.  Profit before provisions grew by 5% in National Bank Retail and 4% in Corporate Banking.  Profit before provisions in ANZ Retail and Rural Banking was flat, reflecting the competitor-driven net interest margin reduction and a seasonally stronger second half in Rural Banking.  The results of the Retail Banks also include the liability for costs and compensation to customers relating to a Commerce Commission action on disclosure of optional issuer fees (NZD10 million) and the cost of the operation of domestic systems relocated to New Zealand under the integration program (NZD5 million).

Key influences on the result include the following:

§             Net interest income increased 4% (NZD31 million).  Lending volumes increased 7% in NZD terms with growth in National Bank Retail (5%), ANZ Retail (8%), Corporate Banking (11%) and Rural (6%).  NZD deposit volumes increased 5% in customer businesses with solid deposit growth in Corporate Banking (14%) and ANZ Retail (4%), where the On-line Call product was particularly successful.  Deposits and other borrowings in Treasury reduced with other sources of wholesale funding increased to fund asset growth across the New Zealand businesses.

Net interest margins have reduced 7 basis points impacted by competition and customer migration from variable rate to fixed rate mortgages, increased requirement for wholesale funding, changes in deposit mix with growth in lower margin call (including ANZ On-line Call ) and term deposit products.  Lending margins in Rural decreased slightly reflecting competition.  These factors were partially offset by slightly stronger deposit margins.

§             Other operating income reduced marginally.  Other income in National Bank Retail increased 12% relating to transactional and credit card accounts.  Other income in Corporate Banking reduced, mainly in fees, with these being ‘lumpy’ and seasonal in nature.  Fees in Rural Banking were flat as were fees in ANZ Retail.  Treasury other income reduced $2 million but was offset by an increase in net interest income.

§             Operating expenses increased 1%.  Salary increases, a small increase in numbers of front-line staff, and the cost of the Commerce Commission settlement (NZD10 million) were largely offset by a 6% reduction in the number of support staff and control of discretionary spend.

§             Provision for credit impairment reduced by NZD94 million.  The collective provision reduced by NZD31 million, with increased lending volumes being offset by a lower provision for oil price risk, and an improved credit risk profile (an increased proportion of low risk residential and rural lending).  The individual provision charge reduced by NZD63 million largely as a result of provisioning for two isolated corporate accounts and exposures to the apple and pear export industry in the preceding September half.  Net impaired loans reduced NZD36 million as a result of the generally benign credit conditions.

March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

Profit after tax increased 14%, with growth in National Bank Retail (16%), Rural Banking (5%), and Corporate Banking (49%).  Profit in ANZ Retail was flat.  Profit before provisions grew by 3% overall with growth in National Bank Retail (6%), Corporate Banking (8%) and Rural Banking (5%), partly offset by a reduction in ANZ Retail (-5%).

§             Net interest income increased 5%.  Lending volumes increased 14% in NZD terms, with growth in all businesses, whilst deposits grew 8% in National Bank Retail and ANZ Retail.  Interest margin has declined by 26 basis points reflecting the impact of competition, in particular the ‘mortgage price war’ in the March 2005 half, product switching from variable rate to fixed rate mortgages, and a change in funding mix to higher rate deposit and wholesale products.

§             Other operating income increased 6%.  Other income in National Bank Retail increased 20%, relating to transactional and credit card accounts.  Other income in Corporate Banking reduced, mainly in fees, with these being ‘lumpy’ in nature.  Fees in Rural Banking and ANZ Retail also reduced slightly.

§             Operating expenses increased 7% with salary increases and a small increase in staff numbers reflecting an increased investment in frontline staff, and the NZD10 million cost associated with the Commerce Commission settlement and NZD5 million domestic system costs as discussed above.

§             Provision for credit impairment reduced NZD53 million.  The individual provision charge reduced as a result of the provisioning for a number of isolated corporate accounts in the March 2005 half, and recoveries of previously provisioned corporate accounts in the current half.  The collective provision charge reduced as a result of a lower provision for oil price risk, and an improved credit risk profile with lending growth mainly in low risk residential mortgages.

44




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW (continued)

 

Corporate Australia

Mark Paton

 

 

     Corporate Banking Australia

 

     Business Banking Australia

 

     Small Business Banking

 

 

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net interest income

 

461

 

447

 

432

 

3%

 

7%

 

Other external operating income

 

83

 

80

 

76

 

4%

 

9%

 

Operating income

 

544

 

527

 

508

 

3%

 

7%

 

External operating expenses

 

(137

)

(123

)

(124

)

11%

 

10%

 

Net inter business unit expenses

 

(82

)

(80

)

(79

)

3%

 

4%

 

Operating expenses

 

(219

)

(203

)

(203

)

8%

 

8%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

325

 

324

 

305

 

0%

 

7%

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

(22

)

(46

)

(45

)

-52%

 

-51%

 

Profit before income tax

 

303

 

278

 

260

 

9%

 

17%

 

Income tax expense and minority interest

 

(91

)

(84

)

(78

)

8%

 

17%

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

212

 

194

 

182

 

9%

 

16%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Consisting of:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Business Banking Australia

 

103

 

92

 

89

 

12%

 

16%

 

Corporate Banking Australia

 

86

 

80

 

72

 

8%

 

19%

 

Small Business Banking

 

23

 

22

 

21

 

5%

 

10%

 

 

 

212

 

194

 

182

 

9%

 

16%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance Sheet

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net loans & advances including acceptances

 

23,941

 

22,793

 

21,655

 

5%

 

11%

 

Other external assets

 

130

 

109

 

113

 

19%

 

15%

 

External assets

 

24,071

 

22,902

 

21,768

 

5%

 

11%

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

18,987

 

18,091

 

17,070

 

5%

 

11%

 

Other external liabilities

 

6,822

 

6,822

 

6,511

 

0%

 

5%

 

External liabilities

 

25,809

 

24,913

 

23,581

 

4%

 

9%

 

Risk Weighted Assets

 

23,450

 

22,301

 

21,007

 

5%

 

12%

 

Ratios

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest margin

 

3.60%

 

3.66%

 

3.69%

 

 

 

 

 

Return on assets

 

1.66%

 

1.60%

 

1.56%

 

 

 

 

 

Return on risk weighted assets

 

1.82%

 

1.78%

 

1.75%

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses to operating income

 

40.3%

 

38.5%

 

40.0%

 

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses to average assets

 

1.72%

 

1.67%

 

1.74%

 

 

 

 

 

Individual provision charge

 

(20)

 

(18)

 

(23)

 

11%

 

-13%

 

Net individual provision as a % of average net advances

 

0.17%

 

0.16%

 

0.22%

 

 

 

 

 

Net impaired loans

 

30

 

38

 

54

 

-21%

 

-44%

 

Net impaired loans as a % of net advances

 

0.12%

 

0.17%

 

0.25%

 

 

 

 

 

Total employees

 

2,025

 

1,987

 

1,924

 

2%

 

5%

 

 

Core business performance excludes significant items and AIFRS adjustments

45




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW (continued)

 

Corporate Australia

Mark Paton

March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

Profit after tax increased by 9%, driven by strong balance sheet growth and continued improvement in the credit quality of the lending portfolio, partially offset by the impact of competitive pressures on margins and fees.  The business franchise remains strong with leading levels of customer satisfaction and low propensity to switch, as well as very high levels of employee engagement.  The business model has been further enhanced by the ongoing expansion of the Wall Street to Main Street (WSTMS) proposition for the Corporate market, the newly created Small Business segment and our industry specialisation models.  ANZ received the CFO Magazine Business Bank of the Year award for 2005.

Significant influences on the result were:

§             Net interest income increased 3% driven by growth in both average lending (6%) and average deposits (7%).

The solid growth in average lending (Corporate Banking 7%, Business Banking 6% and Small Business Banking 16%) and average deposit volumes (Corporate Banking 7%, Business Banking 7% and Small Business Banking 10%) was the result of a continued focus on new customer acquisition as well as growth from existing customers.  Key factors in achieving growth were ANZ’s leading customer service proposition, continued investment in people and process simplification, as well as the industry and local market specialisation approach to customers.

The net interest margin declined by 6 basis points, largely driven by ongoing competitive pressures in the lending book, as well as some moderate compression of margins on the deposit portfolio.

§             Other external operating income increased 4%, largely from continued growth in the WSTMS proposition, including private equity exit profits, with marginal growth in other fees.  The WSTMS proposition continues to grow our portfolio and future earnings potential, with 13 deals closing this half, bringing the total Corporate Private Equity portfolio value to over $200 million.

§             Operating expenses increased 8% including:

-         the impact of an expense refund relating to prior periods in the September 2005 half year;

-         continued investment in front line staff (particularly in Small Business) and the WSTMS proposition and the creation of new Corporate Banking regions; and

-         higher branch costs as a result of our increased branch footprint.

After adjusting for these factors Operating expenses, including the impact of annual salary rises and on-going commitment to the Graduate program, were well managed at 2%.

§             The benefits of our on-going productivity agenda are reflected in the increase in revenue per average FTE.  Productivity gains in back and middle office operations and shared service areas have been used to partially fund the on-going investment program.  The cost to income ratio remains low at 40% in line with last half, allowing for the impact of the expense refund in September 2005.

§             Credit quality remains sound and the overall quality of our credit portfolio has improved over the period.  This reflects the strong focus on risk management and compliance in both the Business Banking and Corporate Banking segments and the impact of the continued de-risking of our portfolio, as well as the strength of the economy and business confidence.  Provision for credit impairment decreased by 52% and impaired loans as a percentage of net loans and advances decreased to 0.12% over the period.

March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

Profit after tax increased 16%, with solid growth in all businesses.  Net interest income increased 7% due to growth of 10% in average lending and 11% growth in average deposit volumes.  Net interest margins declined 9 basis points due principally to competitive pressures.  Other external operating income increased by 9% due to an increase in advisory and ANZ Online fee income.  Operating costs increased by 8% mainly due to continued investment in frontline staff and salary increases.  Provision for credit impairment decreased by 51% and net impaired loans as a percentage of net advances reduced by 52% reflecting the improvement in the quality of the credit portfolio.

46




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW (continued)

 

Esanda and UDC

David Hisco

 

 

 

 

A leading provider of vehicle and equipment finance, rental services and

 

 

 

fixed and at call investments. Operates in Australia as Esanda and Esanda

 

 

 

FleetPartners and in New Zealand as UDC and Esanda FleetPartners

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net interest income

 

202

 

207

 

202

 

-2%

 

-

 

Other external operating income

 

25

 

42

 

37

 

-40%

 

-32%

 

Operating income

 

227

 

249

 

239

 

-9%

 

-5%

 

External operating expenses

 

(84

)

(82

)

(82

)

2%

 

2%

 

Net inter business unit expenses

 

(18

)

(18

)

(20

)

0%

 

-10%

 

Operating expenses

 

(102

)

(100

)

(102

)

2%

 

-

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

125

 

149

 

137

 

-16%

 

-9%

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

(49

)

(67

)

(42

)

-27%

 

17%

 

Profit before income tax

 

76

 

82

 

95

 

-7%

 

-20%

 

Income tax expense and minority interest

 

(23

)

(27

)

(29

)

-15%

 

-21%

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

53

 

55

 

66

 

-4%

 

-20%

 

Net interest margin

 

2.65

%

2.79

%

2.82

%

 

 

 

 

Operating expenses to operating income

 

44.9

%

40.2

%

42.7

%

 

 

 

 

Individual provision charge

 

(35

)

(48

)

(24

)

-27%

 

46%

 

Net impaired loans

 

39

 

40

 

43

 

-3%

 

-9%

 

Total employees

 

1,335

 

1,352

 

1,349

 

-1%

 

-1%

 

Core business performance excludes significant items and AIFRS adjustments

March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

Profit after tax decreased by 4%.  Profit growth in Australia of 9% was offset by a 31% profit reduction in New Zealand which was impacted by structural changes made last year and competitive pressure.  Overall the Australian business continues to provide opportunities for future profit growth.  A number of actions are underway in the New Zealand businesses to return to profitable growth.

Significant influences on the result were:

§             Net interest income declined 2%, with a 3% increase in lending volumes in Australia from solid new business writings offset by an 11% reduction in volumes in New Zealand.  A 14 basis point decline in margins resulted from the run-off of higher yielding loans during the half which were replaced by lower margin new business.  Pricing initiatives have been put in place to stabilise margins and grow revenue, the impact of which will flow through in the March 2007 half.

§             Other operating income decreased 40%, due to a $6 million impact from a fall in second-hand car prices as well as the inclusion of a $7 million gain in the September 2005 half year resulting from the alignment of revenue recognition on leases in the New Zealand Fleet business with Group accounting policies.

§             Operating expenses increased by 2% due to annual salary increases.  These increases were partly offset by a $6 million reduction in indirect taxes.

§             Provision for credit impairment decreased by 27% despite a 1% increase in lending volumes.  Individual provision charge was lower compared to the 2005 half, largely associated with improvement in the commercial loan portfolio and the exited aircraft lease business ($9 million) in 2005.

March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

Profit after tax decreased by 20%.  Net interest income was flat with a 5% increase in lending volumes offset by a 17 basis point margin reduction.  Other operating income decreased 32% due to a $10 million impact from the fall in second-hand car prices.  Operating expenses were flat with an increase in personnel costs due to annual salary increases offset by a $6 million reduction in indirect taxes.  Provision for credit impairment increased 17% and individual provision charge increased $11 million with an individual loss of $5 million in the March 2006 half.

47




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW (continued)

 

Asia Pacific

Bob Edgar

Provision of retail and corporate banking services in the Pacific region and

 

 

 

Asia, including ANZ’s share of PT Panin Bank in Indonesia; this business

 

 

 

excludes Institutional businesses, which are a ‘matrix’ responsibility and

 

 

 

included in Institutional business unit results. Geographic results are

 

 

 

included on page 51

 

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net interest income

 

96

 

89

 

80

 

8%

 

20%

 

Other external operating income

 

71

 

71

 

70

 

0%

 

1%

 

Operating income

 

167

 

160

 

150

 

4%

 

11%

 

External operating expenses

 

(103

)

(93

)

(83

)

11%

 

24%

 

Net inter business unit expenses

 

1

 

1

 

-

 

0%

 

n/a

 

Operating expenses

 

(102

)

(92

)

(83

)

11%

 

23%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

65

 

68

 

67

 

-4%

 

-3%

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

(8

)

(13

)

(21

)

-38%

 

-62%

 

Profit before income tax

 

57

 

55

 

46

 

4%

 

24%

 

Income tax expense and minority interest

 

(11

)

(11

)

(7

)

0%

 

57%

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

46

 

44

 

39

 

5%

 

18%

 

Operating expenses to operating income

 

61.1

%

57.5

%

55.3

%

 

 

 

 

Individual provision charge

 

(6

)

(7

)

(17

)

-14%

 

-65%

 

Net impaired loans

 

8

 

21

 

14

 

-62%

 

-43%

 

Total employees

 

2,248

 

2,196

 

2,040

 

2%

 

10%

 

Core business performance excludes significant items and AIFRS adjustments

March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

Profit after tax increased by 5%.  Excluding the impact of exchange rate movements profit increased 1%.  A strong result in the Pacific (up 23%) was partly offset by lower equity accounted earnings for PT Panin Bank.

Excluding exchange rate movements the main drivers of the results were:

§             Net interest income increased 7% driven by a 12% growth in lending volumes.  Growth in lending was particularly strong in Fiji, Samoa and PNG.

§             Other external operating income reduced 4%.  Fee growth of 7% largely in the Cards business in Indonesia was offset by lower equity accounting earnings for PT Panin Bank ($4 million) and a reduction in foreign exchange income ($2 million) from the particularly strong September 2005 half.

§             Operating expenses increased 9% as a result of costs associated with building partner relationships in China and Vietnam, the first full half of operating costs in Cambodia, and additional customer facing staff in the Pacific.

§             Provision for credit impairment reduced by $4 million.  The individual provision charge reduced largely as a result of the write-back of provisioning in Fiji.

§             Income tax expense was flat.

March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

Profit after tax increased 18%.  Net interest increased 20% driven by 28% growth in lending volumes and 14% growth in deposit volumes.  Other operating income increased slightly with strong card and other fee growth and increased foreign exchange revenue being partly offset by reduced equity accounted income from PT Panin.  Operating expenses increased 23% largely as a result of advancing the partnership business agenda in Asia and additional customer facing staff in the Pacific.  The impact of exchange rate movements was less than 3%.

48




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW (continued)

 

Non-continuing businesses

Steve Targett

Comprises the London headquartered project finance business, the run-off of New Zealand conduit transactions and certain structured finance transactions that ANZ has exited as part of its de-risking strategy

 

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net interest income

 

11

 

36

 

26

 

-69%

 

-58%

 

Other external operating income

 

18

 

-

 

7

 

n/a

 

large

 

Operating income

 

29

 

36

 

33

 

-19%

 

-12%

 

External operating expenses

 

-

 

-

 

(6

)

n/a

 

-100%

 

Net inter business unit expenses

 

(1

)

(8

)

(10

)

-88%

 

-90%

 

Operating expenses

 

(1

)

(8

)

(16

)

-88%

 

-94%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

28

 

28

 

17

 

0%

 

65%

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

8

 

53

 

44

 

-85%

 

-82%

 

Profit before income tax

 

36

 

81

 

61

 

-56%

 

-41%

 

Income tax expense and minority interest

 

(6

)

(18

)

2

 

-67%

 

large

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

30

 

63

 

63

 

-52%

 

-52%

 

Operating expenses to operating income

 

3.4

%

22.2

%

48.5

%

 

 

 

 

Individual provision (charge) credit

 

3

 

30

 

11

 

-90%

 

-73%

 

Net impaired loans

 

7

 

45

 

52

 

-84%

 

-87%

 

Total employees

 

-

 

5

 

9

 

-100%

 

-100%

 

 

March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

Profit after tax reduced by $33 million (52%).  Significant factors affecting the result were:

§        Net interest income reduced by $25 million reflecting a 48% ($0.8 billion) reduction in lending volumes from the September 2005 half.

§        Other operating income of $18 million largely represents a $12 million release of provisions created on the sale of the London headquartered project finance business following the expiry of certain warranties provided to Standard Chartered Bank and a $4 million gain on sale of power assets.

§        Operating expenses reduced by $7 million, with the remaining expenses being legal and restructuring costs associated with the legacy balances in the London headquartered project finance business.

§        Provision for credit impairment credit decreased by $45 million.  The individual provision credit in the September 2005 half reflected the net recovery of $30 million on legacy project finance assets.  The remainder of the credit impairment credit, $23 million credit in the collective provisions resulted from the significant reduction in risk as the legacy assets matured or were sold.

March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

Profit after tax reduced by $33 million (52%).  Operating income reduced by $4 million, with reduced net interest income resulting from a $2.3 billion reduction in lending volumes partly offset by an $11 million increase in other operating income.  The $18 million other operating income in the current half was largely from the release of provisions created on the sale of the London headquartered project finance business, whilst the March 2005 half included $4 million profit on the sale of those businesses.

Operating expenses reduced by $15 million with the London headquartered project finance business being sold part way through the March 2005 half.  Provision for credit impairment reduced by $36 million.  The March 2005 half included a net recovery of $11 million in individual provisions and a $33 million credit in the collective provision charge resulting from the significant reduction in risk as legacy assets matured or were sold through that half.

49




BUSINESS PERFORMANCE REVIEW (continued)

 

Group Centre

¨   Group People Capital

¨   Group Strategic Development

¨   Group Risk Management

¨   Group Financial Management

¨   Treasury

¨   Operations, Technology and

 

Shared Services

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net interest income

 

110

 

104

 

81

 

6%

 

36%

 

Other external operating income

 

22

 

26

 

39

 

-15%

 

-44%

 

Operating income

 

132

 

130

 

120

 

2%

 

10%

 

External operating expenses

 

(377

)

(395

)

(387

)

-5%

 

-3%

 

Net inter business unit expenses

 

275

 

271

 

266

 

1%

 

3%

 

Operating expenses

 

(102

)

(124

)

(121

)

-18%

 

-16%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

30

 

6

 

(1

)

large

 

large

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Profit before income tax

 

30

 

6

 

(1

)

large

 

large

 

Income tax expense and minority interest

 

(3

)

10

 

6

 

large

 

large

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

27

 

16

 

5

 

69%

 

large

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Including:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Treasury

 

10

 

10

 

9

 

0%

 

11%

 

Total employees

 

4,098

 

4,023

 

3,875

 

2%

 

6%

 

March 2006 half year compared to September 2005 half year

The result for the Group Centre was $27 million profit compared with $16 million in the September 2005 half.  Significant influences on the result were:

§        Movements in the average NZD exchange rate resulted in a $9 million after tax increase in income on contracts put in place to hedge NZD denominated earnings.  These gains were partly offset in New Zealand Businesses, and the New Zealand component of the Institutional and Esanda (UDC) businesses.  The gains on the NZD contracts were partly offset by the maturity of contracts put in place to hedge USD revenues, which resulted in a decline of $6 million after tax.

§        Other operating income decreased $4 million with lower capital investment earnings (net of hedge costs) from INGA.  Capital investment hedges were terminated in October 2005.

§        Operating expenses reduced $22 million with lower non-incremental New Zealand businesses System Integration costs and other project costs.

§        Income tax expense increase reflects a tax benefit booked in the prior half in respect of issue costs for the 2 for 11 rights issue, and lower INGA non-taxable Capital investment earnings.

March 2006 half year compared to March 2005 half year

The half year profit of $27 million was $22 million higher than the March 2005 half.  Revenue increased $12 million with higher net interest offset by lower capital investment earnings (net of hedge earnings) in INGA following the payment of dividends.  External operating expenses reduced 3% with the inclusion of provisioning for cheque conversion fraud in the March 2005 half.

50




GEOGRAPHIC SEGMENT PERFORMANCE

Geographic performance

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the company

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

1,196

 

1,105

 

1,043

 

8%

 

15%

 

New Zealand

 

422

 

340

 

355

 

24%

 

19%

 

Asia Pacific

 

110

 

101

 

84

 

9%

 

31%

 

Other

 

83

 

74

 

73

 

12%

 

14%

 

 

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

 

51




FOUR YEAR SUMMARY BY HALF YEAR

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Previous AGAAP1

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Sep 04

 

Mar 04

 

Sep 03

 

Mar 03

 

Sep 02

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Income Statement

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income

 

3,368

 

2,953

 

2,865

 

2,745

 

2,507

 

2,171

 

2,140

 

2,053

 

Other operating income

 

1,595

 

1,861

 

1,717

 

1,694

 

1,681

 

1,456

 

1,352

 

1,561

 

Operating expense

 

(2,185

)

(2,266

)

(2,152

)

(2,103

)

(1,902

)

(1,626

)

(1,602

)

(1,575

)

Provision for credit impairment

 

(224

)

(296

)

(284

)

(319

)

(313

)

(311

)

(303

)

(309

)

Profit before income tax

 

2,554

 

2,252

 

2,146

 

2,017

 

1,973

 

1,690

 

1,587

 

1,730

 

Income tax expense

 

(742

)

(630

)

(590

)

(597

)

(574

)

(482

)

(444

)

(457

)

Minority interest

 

(1

)

(2

)

(1

)

(1

)

(3

)

(1

)

(2

)

(1

)

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

1,419

 

1,396

 

1,207

 

1,141

 

1,272

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Previous AGAAP1

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Sep 04

 

Mar 04

 

Sep 03

 

Mar 03

 

Sep 02

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Income Statement

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net interest income

 

3,368

 

3,231

 

3,140

 

2,745

 

2,507

 

2,171

 

2,140

 

2,053

 

Other operating income

 

1,563

 

1,528

 

1,407

 

1,694

 

1,573

 

1,456

 

1,352

 

1,387

 

Operating expense

 

(2,259

)

(2,213

)

(2,127

)

(2,103

)

(1,902

)

(1,626

)

(1,602

)

(1,575

)

Provision for credit impairment

 

(224

)

(325

)

(240

)

(319

)

(313

)

(311

)

(303

)

(309

)

Profit before income tax

 

2,448

 

2,221

 

2,180

 

2,017

 

1,865

 

1,690

 

1,587

 

1,556

 

Income tax expense

 

(716

)

(636

)

(611

)

(597

)

(550

)

(482

)

(444

)

(453

)

Minority interest

 

(1

)

(2

)

(1

)

(1

)

(3

)

(1

)

(2

)

(1

)

Cash profit2,7

 

1,731

 

1,583

 

1,568

 

1,419

 

1,312

 

1,207

 

1,141

 

1,102

 

Non-core items2

 

80

 

37

 

(13

)

-

 

84

 

-

 

-

 

170

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

1,419

 

1,396

 

1,207

 

1,141

 

1,272

 

Balance Sheet

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Assets

 

319,363

 

298,104

 

282,784

 

259,345

 

247,288

 

195,591

 

190,518

 

183,105

 

Net assets

 

18,796

 

19,538

 

18,927

 

17,925

 

16,748

 

13,787

 

12,485

 

11,465

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ratios

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Return on average ordinary equity3

 

20.9

%

18.3

%

18.3

%

17.3

%

19.1

%

20.9

%

20.3

%

24.8

%

Return on average assets

 

1.2

%

1.1

%

1.1

%

1.1

%

1.2

%

1.2

%

1.2

%

1.4

%

Tier 1 capital ratio

 

6.8

%

6.9

%

7.0

%

6.9

%

7.0

%

7.7

%

7.7

%

7.9

%

Operating expenses4 to operating income

 

44.0

%

47.1

%

47.0

%

45.8

%

43.9

%

44.6

%

45.6

%

43.3

%

Core operating expenses4 to operating incom

 

45.8

%

46.5

%

46.8

%

45.5

%

45.1

%

44.6

%

45.6

%

45.5

%

Shareholder value - ordinary shares

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total return to shareholders

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(share price movement plus dividends)

 

13.2

%

19.2

%

11.3

%

3.0

%

13.6

%

2.5

%

4.1

%

1.4

%

Market capitalisation

 

48,461

 

43,834

 

37,584

 

34,586

 

34,284

 

27,314

 

27,135

 

26,544

 

Dividend

 

56 cents

 

59 cents

 

51 cents

 

54 cents

 

47 cents

 

51 cents

 

44 cents

 

46 cents

 

Franked portion

 

100

%

100

%

100

%

100

%

100

%

100

%

100

%

100

%

Share price5

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

- high

 

$26.70

 

$24.45

 

$22.02

 

$19.44

 

$19.40

 

$18.45

 

$18.19

 

$19.70

 

- low

 

$22.70

 

$20.53

 

$19.02

 

$17.45

 

$15.94

 

$16.66

 

$15.01

 

$16.18

 

- closing

 

$26.50

 

$24.00

 

$20.62

 

$19.02

 

$18.96

 

$17.17

 

$17.15

 

$16.88

 

Share information (per fully paid ordinary share)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Earnings per share - basic5

 

98.4

 

86.3

 

83.2

 

76.4c

 

76.8c

 

73.3c

 

69.1c

 

77.7c

 

Dividend payout ratio

 

56.9

%

68.4

%

61.3

%

71.0

%

63.8

%

67.0

%

61.3

%

57.0

%

Net tangible assets

 

$8.00

 

$7.77

 

$7.38

 

$7.51

 

$6.94

 

$7.49

 

$7.32

 

$6.58

 

Number of fully paid ordinary shares on issue (millions)

 

1,828.7

 

1,826.4

 

1,822.7

 

1,818.4

 

1,808.2

 

1,521.7

 

1,513.4

 

1,503.9

 

Other information

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Permanent employees (FTE)

 

29,617

 

29,471

 

28,388

 

27,383

 

26,585

 

21,586

 

21,218

 

21,380

 

Temporary employees (FTE)

 

1,446

 

1,505

 

1,444

 

1,372

 

1,386

 

1,551

 

1,265

 

1,102

 

Total employees

 

31,063

 

30,976

 

29,832

 

28,755

 

27,971

 

23,137

 

22,483

 

22,482

 

Number of shareholders6

 

273,503

 

263,467

 

255,655

 

252,072

 

245,173

 

223,545

 

210,512

 

198,716

 

 

52




FOUR YEAR SUMMARY BY HALF YEAR (continued)

 

1.

An explanation of the differences between accounting under current AGAAP (AIFRS) as opposed to “previous AGAAP” is set out on pages 11 to 14

2.

ANZ has reduced the September 2005 profit after tax by $46 million (Mar 2005: $15 million increase) to bring the result for that period to an AIFRS basis that is fully comparable with March 2006 figures (refer page 3), allowing readers to see the impact on 2005 results of accounting standards that have only been applied from 1 October 2005. No adjustment has been made to retrospectively designate derivatives hedging the Group’s funding on the basis of impracticability. In the March 2006 half ANZ has classified the $113 million ($79 million after tax) settlement of the NHB insurance matter and the $14 million after tax settlement of warranty claims on Lloyds TSB plc (tax on warranty settlement: $nil) as significant items. In the September 2005 half ANZ classified $14 million after tax profit on the sale of NBNZ life and funds management businesses as a significant item (tax on gain on sale of NBNZ life and funds management businesses: $nil). ANZ excludes significant items to eliminate the distorting effect of one-off transactions on the results of its core business (refer page 11). In the March 2006 half ANZ has classified $13 million after tax profit (Sep 2005: $12 million; Mar 2005 $19 million) on derivatives entered into to manage interest rate and foreign exchange risk on funding instruments, not designated as accounting hedges, ineffective portions of cash flow hedges, profit or loss on disposal of investment securities, and fair value movement in bonds and notes designated at fair value as a non-core item. ANZ excludes volatility associated with fair value movements on these transactions to provide a better indication of the core business performance (tax on hedge gains/losses $5 million (Sep 2005: $4 million; Mar 2005: $8 million)). In the March 2006 half ANZ has incurred $26 million after tax ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs (Sep 2005 half: $35 million; Mar 2005 half: $17 million). Tax on ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs is $13 million (Sep 2005: $18 million; Mar 2005: $8 million). ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs are excluded to better reflect the core cost base and assist analysis of the cost base following completion of the integration (refer page 11)

3.

Average ordinary shareholders’ equity excludes minority interest

4.

Operating expenses excludes goodwill amortisation of $nil (Sep 2005: $nil; Mar 2005: $nil; Sep 2004: $83 million; Mar 2004: $63 million; Sep 2003: $9 million; Mar 2003: $9 million; Sep 2002: $10 million). Under AIFRS goodwill is not amortised and therefore was not recognised from the March 2005 period onwards

5.

September 2003 and prior periods adjusted for the bonus element of the rights issue

6.

Excludes employees whose only ANZ shares are held in trust under ANZ employee share schemes

7.

Refer page 14 for a reconciliation of Net Profit to Cash Profit. Refer page 11 for a discussion of why management believes measures of cash profit provide useful information to investors regarding ANZs financial conditions and results of operations

 

53




Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited

 

CONSOLIDATED CONDENSED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS AND OTHER DISCLOSURES

(prepared in Australian Dollars ($))

 

Half year ended
31 March 2006

54




CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS – TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

CONTENTS

 

PAGE

Consolidated Condensed Income Statement

57

Consolidated Condensed Balance Sheet

58

Consolidated Condensed Statement of Recognised Income and Expense

59

Consolidated Condensed Cash flow statement

60

Notes to Financial Statements

61

1.

Significant Accounting policies

61

2.

Income

67

3.

Operating expenses

68

4.

Income tax expense

69

5.

Dividends

70

6.

Earnings per share

71

7.

Derivative financial instruments

72

8.

Net loans and advances

74

9.

Impaired financial assets

75

10.

Provision for credit impairment

78

11.

Loan capital

79

12.

Share Capital

79

13.

Shareholders’ Equity

80

14.

Capital Management

82

15.

Average balance sheet and related interest - statutory basis

84

16.

Interest spreads and net interest average margins — statutory basis

87

17.

Segment analysis

88

18.

Contingent liabilities and contingent assets

89

19.

Note to the Cash Flow Statement

91

20.

Changes in composition of the Group

92

21.

Associates, joint venture entities and investments

92

22.

Exchange rates

93

23.

Significant events since balance date

93

24.

Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS)

94

25.

US GAAP Reconciliation

109

Definitions

124

Alphabetical Index

126

 

55




This page has been left blank intentionally

 

56




CONSOLIDATED CONDENSED INCOME STATEMENT

 

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

Note

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Total income

 

2

 

12,372

 

11,160

 

10,137

 

11%

 

22%

 

Interest income

 

 

 

10,777

 

9,299

 

8,420

 

16%

 

28%

 

Interest expense

 

 

 

(7,409

)

(6,346

)

(5,555

)

17%

 

33%

 

Net interest income

 

2

 

3,368

 

2,953

 

2,865

 

14%

 

18%

 

Other operating income

 

2

 

1,595

 

1,861

 

1,717

 

-14%

 

-7%

 

Operating income

 

 

 

4,963

 

4,814

 

4,582

 

3%

 

8%

 

Operating expenses

 

3

 

(2,185

)

(2,266

)

(2,152

)

-4%

 

2%

 

Profit before credit impairment and income tax

 

 

 

2,778

 

2,548

 

2,430

 

9%

 

14%

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

10

 

(224

)

(296

)

(284

)

-24%

 

-21%

 

Profit before income tax

 

 

 

2,554

 

2,252

 

2,146

 

13%

 

19%

 

Income tax expense

 

4

 

(742

)

(630

)

(590

)

18%

 

26%

 

Profit for the period

 

 

 

1,812

 

1,622

 

1,556

 

12%

 

16%

 

Net profit attributable to minority interest

 

 

 

(1

)

(2

)

(1

)

-50%

 

0%

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

 

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Earnings per ordinary share (cents)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

6

 

98.4

 

86.3

 

83.2

 

14%

 

18%

 

Diluted

 

6

 

96.1

 

84.3

 

80.6

 

14%

 

19%

 

Dividend per ordinary share (cents)

 

5

 

56

 

59

 

51

 

-5%

 

10%

 

Net tangible assets per ordinary share ($)

 

 

 

8.00

 

7.77

 

7.38

 

3%

 

8%

 

 

The notes appearing on pages 61 to 122 form an integral part of these financial statements

57




CONSOLIDATED CONDENSED BALANCE SHEET

 

 

 

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Note

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liquid assets

 

 

 

13,870

 

11,601

 

8,856

 

20%

 

57%

 

Due from other financial institutions

 

 

 

8,336

 

6,348

 

6,428

 

31%

 

30%

 

Trading securities1

 

 

 

8,721

 

6,285

 

6,108

 

39%

 

43%

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

7

 

7,485

 

3,730

 

4,002

 

large

 

87%

 

Available for sale assets2

 

 

 

13,287

 

10,042

 

9,586

 

32%

 

39%

 

Net loans and advances

 

8

 

241,546

 

232,490

 

220,394

 

4%

 

10%

 

Customers’ liability for acceptances

 

 

 

13,692

 

13,449

 

12,922

 

2%

 

6%

 

Regulatory deposits

 

 

 

214

 

159

 

143

 

35%

 

50%

 

Interests in associates and joint venture entities

 

 

 

1,912

 

1,926

 

1,796

 

-1%

 

6%

 

Deferred tax assets

 

 

 

1,460

 

1,389

 

1,283

 

5%

 

14%

 

Goodwill and other intangible assets3

 

 

 

3,269

 

3,454

 

3,608

 

-5%

 

-9%

 

Other assets4,5

 

 

 

4,510

 

6,177

 

6,583

 

-27%

 

-31%

 

Premises and equipment

 

 

 

1,061

 

1,054

 

1,075

 

1%

 

-1%

 

Total assets

 

 

 

319,363

 

298,104

 

282,784

 

7%

 

13%

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due to other financial institutions

 

 

 

13,345

 

12,027

 

10,056

 

11%

 

33%

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

 

 

196,850

 

190,322

 

185,177

 

3%

 

6%

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

7

 

6,134

 

4,225

 

4,987

 

45%

 

23%

 

Liability for acceptances

 

 

 

13,692

 

13,449

 

12,922

 

2%

 

6%

 

Income tax liabilities

 

 

 

1,897

 

1,801

 

1,705

 

5%

 

11%

 

Payables and other liabilities5

 

 

 

9,697

 

7,618

 

7,703

 

27%

 

26%

 

Provisions

 

 

 

908

 

914

 

865

 

-1%

 

5%

 

Bonds and notes

 

 

 

46,923

 

39,073

 

32,321

 

20%

 

45%

 

Loan capital6

 

11

 

11,121

 

9,137

 

8,121

 

22%

 

37%

 

Total liabilities

 

 

 

300,567

 

278,566

 

263,857

 

8%

 

14%

 

Net assets

 

 

 

18,796

 

19,538

 

18,927

 

-4%

 

-1%

 

Shareholders’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ordinary share capital

 

12,13

 

8,068

 

8,053

 

7,982

 

0%

 

1%

 

Preference share capital

 

12,13

 

871

 

1,858

 

1,858

 

-53%

 

-53%

 

Reserves

 

13

 

(156

)

(46

)

102

 

large

 

large

 

Retained profits

 

 

 

9,979

 

9,646

 

8,967

 

3%

 

11%

 

Share capital and reserves attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

 

 

18,762

 

19,511

 

18,909

 

-4%

 

-1%

 

Minority interest

 

 

 

34

 

27

 

18

 

26%

 

89%

 

Total shareholders’ equity

 

 

 

18,796

 

19,538

 

18,927

 

-4%

 

-1%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Contingent liabilities and contingent assets

 

18

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1.

Includes bills held in portfolio $1,167 million (Sep 2005: $1,182 million; Mar 2005: $1,395 million)

2.

In 2005 available for sale assets were reported as investment securities

3.

Excludes notional goodwill in equity accounted entities

4.

Includes interest revenue receivable $1,468 million (Sep 2005: $1,443 million; Mar 2005: $1,522 million)

5.

Other assets includes life insurance assets of $nil (Sep 2005: $nil; Mar 2005: $50 million). Payables and other liabilities includes policy holder liabilities of $nil (Sep 2005: $nil; Mar 2005: $31 million)

6.

Includes $1,536 million (Sep 2005: $1,443 million; Mar 2005: $1,425 million) hybrid loan capital that qualifies for Tier 1 capital as defined by the Australian Prudential Regulation Authority

The notes appearing on pages 61 to 122 form an integral part of these financial statements

58




 
CONSOLIDATED CONDENSED STATEMENT OF RECOGNISED INCOME AND EXPENSE

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Items recognised directly in equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Revaluation of investments in controlled entities

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Currency translation adjustments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Exchange differences taken to equity

 

(305

)

(159

)

(284

)

92%

 

7%

 

Transferred to income statement on sale

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Available-for-sale assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Valuation gain (loss) taken to equity

 

22

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Cumulative gain (loss) transferred to the income statement on sale

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Cash flow hedges

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Valuation gain (loss) taken to equity

 

31

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Transferred to income statement for the period

 

(14

)

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Actuarial gain (loss) on defined benefit plans

 

34

 

27

 

8

 

26%

 

large

 

Income tax recognised directly in equity

 

(16

)

(9

)

(1

)

78%

 

large

 

Net loss recognised directly in equity

 

(248

)

(141

)

(277

)

76%

 

-10%

 

Profit for the period

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12%

 

16%

 

Total recognised income and expense for the period

 

1,563

 

1,479

 

1,278

 

6%

 

22%

 

Total recognised income and expense attributable to minority interest

 

1

 

2

 

1

 

-50%

 

0%

 

Total recognised income and expense attributable to shareholders of the company

 

1,564

 

1,481

 

1,279

 

6%

 

22%

 

 

The notes appearing on pages 61 to 122 form an integral part of these financial statements

59




 
Consolidated Condensed Cash flow statement

 

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

 

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

 

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

 

 

 

 

Inflows

 

Inflows

 

Inflows

 

 

 

Note

 

(Outflows)

 

(Outflows)

 

(Outflows)

 

 

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Cash flows from operating activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest received

 

 

 

11,179

 

9,169

 

8,699

 

Dividends received

 

 

 

49

 

106

 

38

 

Fee income received

 

 

 

1,016

 

1,360

 

943

 

Other income received

 

 

 

581

 

861

 

152

 

Interest paid

 

 

 

(7,299

)

(6,003

)

(5,411

)

Personnel expenses paid

 

 

 

(1,383

)

(1,285

)

(1,213

)

Premises expenses paid

 

 

 

(188

)

(186

)

(181

)

Other operating expenses paid

 

 

 

(1,244

)

(1,094

)

(1,050

)

Recovery from NHB litigation

 

 

 

87

 

-

 

-

 

Income taxes paid

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

 

 

(539

)

(294

)

(278

)

Overseas

 

 

 

(82

)

(305

)

(195

)

Net Goods and Services Tax received (paid)

 

 

 

(5

)

24

 

(6

)

(Increase) decrease in operating assets:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liquid assets - greater than three months

 

 

 

(1,798

)

(358

)

(370

)

Due from other financial institutions

 

 

 

806

 

(358

)

(13

)

Trading securities

 

 

 

881

 

(183

)

(638

)

Regulatory deposits

 

 

 

(47

)

(19

)

24

 

Loans and advances

 

 

 

(16,502

)

(13,365

)

(15,423

)

Increase (decrease) in operating liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

 

 

8,729

 

5,802

 

14,054

 

Due to other financial institutions

 

 

 

1,159

 

2,080

 

2,892

 

Payables and other liabilities

 

 

 

119

 

(652

)

(687

)

Net cash provided by operating activities

 

19

 

(4,481

)

(4,700

)

1,337

 

Cash flows from investing activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net decrease (increase):

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Shares in controlled entities and associates

 

 

 

(62

)

(86

)

243

 

Available for sale assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases

 

 

 

(7,657

)

(7,603

)

(9,585

)

Proceeds from sale or maturity

 

 

 

8,217

 

7,394

 

10,462

 

Controlled entities and associates

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchased (net of cash acquired)

 

 

 

-

 

(149

)

-

 

Proceeds from sale (net of cash disposed)

 

 

 

-

 

144

 

-

 

Premises and equipment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Purchases

 

 

 

(153

)

(170

)

(155

)

Proceeds from sale

 

 

 

2

 

81

 

5

 

Other

 

 

 

86

 

255

 

(1,975

)

Net cash (used in) investing activities

 

 

 

433

 

(134

)

(1,005

)

Cash flows from financing activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net (decrease) increase

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Bonds and notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Issue proceeds

 

 

 

9,924

 

9,649

 

8,319

 

Redemptions

 

 

 

(4,139

)

(2,396

)

(2,629

)

Loan capital

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Issue proceeds

 

 

 

609

 

1,225

 

-

 

Redemptions

 

 

 

-

 

(93

)

-

 

Decrease in minority interests

 

 

 

2

 

8

 

-

 

Dividends paid

 

 

 

(989

)

(884

)

(924

)

Share capital issues

 

 

 

75

 

58

 

62

 

Share capital buyback

 

 

 

(146

)

(87

)

(117

)

Euro Hybrid preference share issue

 

 

 

-

 

-

 

875

 

Euro Hybrid issues costs

 

 

 

-

 

-

 

(4

)

Net cash provided by financing activities

 

 

 

5,336

 

7,480

 

5,582

 

Net cash (used in) provided by operating activities

 

 

 

(4,481

)

(4,700

)

1,337

 

Net cash (used in) investing activities

 

 

 

433

 

(134

)

(1,005

)

Net cash provided by financing activities

 

 

 

5,336

 

7,480

 

5,582

 

Net (decrease)increase in cash and cash equivalents

 

 

 

1,288

 

2,646

 

5,914

 

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of period

 

 

 

13,702

 

11,696

 

7,854

 

Foreign currency translation on opening balances

 

 

 

1,855

 

(640

)

(2,072

)

Cash and cash equivalents at end of period

 

19

 

16,845

 

13,702

 

11,696

 

 

The notes appearing on pages 61 to 122 form an integral part of these financial statements

60




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

1.                  Significant Accounting policies

(i)                               Basis of preparation

These consolidated financial statements comprise a general purpose financial report and:

                    should be read in conjunction with the ANZ Financial Report and the ANZ Concise Annual Report for the year ended 30 September 2005 and any public announcements made by the Parent entity and its controlled entities (the Group) for the half year ended 31 March 2006 in accordance with the continuous disclosure obligations under the Corporations Act 2001 (as amended) and the ASX Listing Rules

                    are presented in Australian dollars in accordance with class order 98/100 dated 10 July 1998 (millions, except where stated otherwise)

                    comply with the accounts provisions of the Banking Act 1959, applicable Australian Accounting Standards, the Corporations Act 2001 (as amended), the Corporations Regulations 2001 and other authoritative pronouncements of the Australian Accounting Standards Board (AASB)

                    are condensed financial statements as defined in AASB 134: ‘Interim Financial Reporting’. Compliance with AASB 134 ensures compliance with International Financial Reporting Standard IAS 34: ‘Interim Financial Reporting’.  This report does not include all notes of the type normally included in the annual financial report

                    have been prepared in accordance with the historical cost convention except that the following assets and liabilities are stated at their fair value: derivative financial instruments including the fair value of any applicable underlying exposure, assets treated as available-for-sale, financial instruments held for trading, term funding instruments including specific bonds and notes, and defined benefit plans assets and liabilities.

The preparation of the financial report requires the use of management judgement, estimates and assumptions that affect reported amounts and the application of policies.  The estimates and associated assumptions are based on historical experience and various other factors that are believed to be reasonable.  Actual results may differ from these estimates.  Such estimates may require review in future periods.

International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) form the basis of Australian Accounting Standards issued by the AASB, being Australian equivalents to IFRS (AIFRS).  The Group revised its accounting policies on 1 October 2005 to enable the preparation of financial statements that comply with AIFRS.  This is the Group’s first financial report prepared in accordance with AIFRS and AASB 1: ‘First-time Adoption of Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards’ has been applied.  An explanation of how the transition from superseded policies to AIFRS has impacted the Group’s reported financial position, financial performance and cash flow, is set out in Note 24.

The accounting policies have been consistently applied by all consolidated entities and to all periods presented in the consolidated financial report and the opening AIFRS balance sheet as at 1 October 2004, except for those policies relating to Standards for which comparatives are not restated, as permitted under the first time adoption transitional provisions.  The Standards are AASB 132: ‘Financial Instruments: Presentation and Disclosure’, AASB 139: ‘Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement’, and AASB 4: ‘Insurance Contracts’.

The Group’s key accounting policies that have been amended by the adoption of AIFRS follow.

(ii)                           Consolidation

The financial statements consolidate the financial statements of Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited (the Company) and all its subsidiaries where it is determined that there is a capacity to control.  Control means the power to govern the financial and operating policies of an entity so as to obtain benefits from its activities.

On adoption of AIFRS certain special purpose entities in which the Group holds less than a majority of voting rights, were deemed to be controlled entities where:

                    in substance, the majority of the risks and rewards from their activities accrue to the Group; or

                    in substance, the Group controls their decision making powers so as to obtain the majority of the risks and rewards from their activities.

(iii)                       Interest income and interest expense

Interest income and interest expense are recognised in the income statement as they accrue using the effective interest method.

Fee income and directly related transaction costs relating to loan origination, financing or restructurings are now deferred and amortised to interest income over the expected life of the loan using the effective interest method.

Loan commitment fees, together with related direct costs, are deferred and recognised as an adjustment to the interest yield on the loan once drawn or immediately to the income statement for expired commitments.

Fees and commissions payable to brokers in respect of originating lending business, where these are incremental costs directly related to the issue of a financial instrument, are included in interest income as part of the effective interest rate.

  

 

61




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

1.                  Significant Accounting policies, cont’d

(iv)                          Fee and commission income

Unless included in the effective interest calculation (refer 1(iii)), fees and commissions are brought to account on an accrual basis.

Fees and commissions that relate to the execution of a significant act (for example, advisory services, placement fees and underwriting fees) are recognised when the significant act has been completed.

Fees charged for providing ongoing services that represent the recoupment of the costs of providing service (for example, maintaining and administering existing facilities) are recognised as income over the period the service is provided.

(v)                              Offsetting of income and expenses

Income and expenses are not offset unless required or permitted by an accounting standard.  At the Group level, this generally arises in the following circumstances:

                    where transaction costs, which are an integral part of the effective interest rate of a financial instrument measured at amortised cost, are offset against the interest income generated by the financial instrument

                    where gains and losses relating to fair value hedges are assessed as being effective

                    where gains and losses from a group of similar transactions are reported on a net basis, such as foreign exchange gains and losses, or

                    where amounts are collected on behalf of third parties, where the Group is acting as an agent.

(vi)                          Cash receipts on impaired loans

Cash receipts on impaired loans are applied as a reduction to principal.

(vii)                      Derivative financial instruments

Derivative financial instruments are contracts whose value is derived from one or more underlying financial instruments or indices.

Derivative financial instruments including swaps, forward rate agreements, futures, options and combinations of these instruments are entered into by the Group for trading purposes, including customer-related reasons, or for hedging purposes where the derivative instruments are used to hedge the Group’s exposures to interest rate risk, currency risk, price risk, credit risk and other exposures relating to non-trading positions.

Derivative financial instruments are recognised initially at fair value with gains or losses from subsequent remeasurement at fair value being recognised in the income statement.  Where the derivative is designated and effective as a hedging instrument, the timing of the recognition of any resultant gain or loss in the income statement is dependent on the hedging designation.  These hedging designations and associated accounting treatments are as follows:

                    Fair value hedge

Where the Group hedges the fair value of a recognised asset or liability or firm commitment, changes in the fair value of derivatives designated as a fair value hedge are recognised in the income statement.  Changes in the fair value of the hedged item attributable to the hedged risk are reflected as adjustments to the carrying value of the hedged items, which are also recognised in the income statement.

Hedge accounting is discontinued when the hedge instrument expires or is sold, terminated, exercised or no longer qualifies for hedge accounting.  The resulting adjustment to the carrying amount of the hedged item arising from the hedged risk is amortised to the income statement over the period to maturity.

If the hedged item is sold or repaid, the unamortised fair value adjustment is recognised immediately in the income statement.

                    Cash flow hedge

The Group designates derivatives as cash flow hedges where the instrument hedges the variability in cash flows of a recognised asset or liability, a foreign exchange component of a firm commitment or a highly probable forecast transaction.  The effective portion of changes in the fair value of derivatives qualifying and designated as cash flow hedges is deferred to the cash flow hedging reserve which forms part of shareholders’ equity.  Any ineffective portion is recognised immediately in the income statement.  Amounts deferred in equity are recognised in the income statement in the period during which the hedged forecast transactions take place.

When the hedge expires, is sold, terminated, exercised, or no longer qualifies for hedge accounting, the cumulative amount deferred in equity remains in the cash flow hedging reserve, and is subsequently transferred to the income statement when the hedged item is recognised in the income statement.

When a forecast transaction is no longer expected to occur, the amount deferred in equity is recognised immediately in the income statement.

  

 

62




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

1.                  Significant Accounting policies, cont’d

(vii)                      Derivative financial instruments, cont’d

                    Net investment hedge

Hedges of net investments in foreign operations are accounted for similarly to cash flow hedges.  The gain or loss from remeasuring the fair value of the hedging instrument relating to the effective portion of the hedge is deferred in equity and the ineffective portion is recognised immediately in the income statement.  Amounts deferred in the foreign currency translation reserve are recognised in the income statement when the foreign operation is disposed of.

All gains and losses from changes in the fair value of derivatives, that are not designated in a hedging relationship but are entered into to manage the interest rate and foreign exchange risk of funding instruments, are recognised in the income statement.  The component of the fair value change in the derivative and which relates to current period realised and unrealised interest, is included in net interest income.  The remainder of the fair value movement is included in other income.

Embedded derivatives - Derivatives embedded in financial instruments or other host contracts are treated as separate derivatives when their economic characteristics and risks are not closely related to those of the host contracts, and the host contracts are not measured at fair value.  The embedded derivative is reported at fair value with changes in fair value immediately recognised in the income statement.

(viii)                  Trading Securities and other financial assets at fair value through profit or loss

Trading securities and other financial instruments acquired principally for the purpose of selling in the short-term or which are part of a portfolio which is managed for short-term gains are recognised in the balance sheet at their fair value.  Additionally, this valuation basis is used as an alternative to hedge accounting for certain financial instruments.  It is not used for illiquid instruments or those for which the demonstrated variability in the range of fair value estimates is other than low.

Changes in the fair value (gains or losses) of financial instruments are recognised in the income statement in the period in which they occur.

(ix)                         Available-for-sale assets

Available-for-sale assets comprise non-derivative financial assets which the Group designates as available-for-sale but which are not deemed to be held principally for trading purposes, and include equity investments, certain loans and advances and fixed term securities.  They are initially recorded at fair value plus transaction costs.  Subsequent gains or losses arising from changes in fair value are included as a separate component of equity, the ‘available-for-sale revaluation reserve’.  When an available-for-sale asset is sold, the cumulative gain or loss relating to the asset is transferred from equity to the income statement.

Where there is objective evidence of impairment to an available-for-sale asset, the cumulative loss related to that asset is removed from equity and recognised in the income statement.  If, in a subsequent period, the amount of an impairment loss relating to an available-for-sale debt instrument decreases and the decrease can be linked objectively to an event occurring after the impairment event, the loss is reversed through the income statement.

Premiums and discounts are included within the calculation of the fair value of the security.  Interest and dividend income is accrued.

Financial assets previously disclosed as investment securities are now predominantly treated as available-for-sale securities.

(x)                             Impairment of loans and advances

Loans and advances are regularly reviewed for impairment loss.

Credit impairment provisions are raised for exposures that are known to be impaired.  Loans are impaired and impairment losses incurred if there is objective evidence of impairment as a result of one or more loss events that occurred after the initial recognition of the loan and that loss event or events has had a reliably estimable impact on the estimated future cash flows of the individual loan or the collective portfolio of loans.

Impairment is assessed firstly for assets that are individually significant (or on a portfolio basis for small value loans), and then on a collective basis for those exposures not individually known to be impaired.

For those exposures that are assessed collectively, these are placed in pools of similar assets with similar risk characteristics.  The required provision is estimated on the basis of historical loss experience for assets with credit risk characteristics similar to those in the collective pool.  The historical loss experience is adjusted based on current observable data.

  

 

63




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

1.                  Significant Accounting policies, cont’d

(x)                             Impairment of loans and advances, cont’d

The estimated impairment loss is measured as the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the estimated future cash flows discounted to their present value.  As this discount unwinds during the period between recognition of impairment and recovery of the written down amount, it is recognised in net interest income.  The process of estimating the amount and timing of cash flows involves considerable management judgement.  These judgements are reviewed regularly to reduce any differences between loss estimates and actual loss experience.

The provision for impairment loss (individual and collective), referred to as “Provision for credit impairment”, is deducted from loans and advances in the balance sheet and the movement in the provision for the reporting period is reflected in the income statement.  When a loan is uncollectible, it is written-off against the related provision for loan impairment.  Subsequent recoveries of amounts previously written off are taken to the income statement.

Where impairment losses recognised in previous periods are subsequently decreased or no longer exist, such impairments are reversed in the income statement.

(xi)                         Goodwill and other intangible assets

                    Goodwill

Goodwill, representing the excess of the purchase consideration over the fair value of the identifiable net assets of a controlled entity at the date of gaining control, is recognised as an asset and not amortised, but tested for impairment annually and when the goodwill is impaired the difference is charged to the income statement.

Any impairment of goodwill cannot be subsequently reversed.

                    Other intangible assets

Other intangible assets comprise costs incurred in acquiring and building software and computer systems (“software”).

Software is amortised using the straight-line method over its expected useful life to the Group.  The period of amortisation is between 3 and 5 years except for branch front-end applications where 7 years is used.

At each reporting date, software assets are reviewed for impairment.  If any such indication exists, the recoverable amount of the assets are estimated and compared against the existing carrying value.  Where the existing carrying value exceeds the recoverable amount, the difference is charged to the income statement.

Costs incurred in planning or evaluating software proposals, or in maintaining systems after implementation, are not capitalised.

(xii)                     Premises and equipment impairment assessment

At each reporting date, the carrying amounts of premises and equipment are reviewed for impairment.  If any such indication exists, the recoverable amount of the assets are estimated and compared against the existing carrying value.  Where the existing carrying value exceeds the recoverable amount, the difference is charged to the income statement.  If it is not possible to estimate the recoverable amount of an individual asset, the Group estimates the recoverable amount of the cash generating unit to which the asset belongs.

A previously recognised impairment loss is reversed if there has been a change in the estimates used to determine the recoverable amount.

(xiii)                 Employee benefits

The directors have elected under s334(5) of the Corporations Act 2001 to early adopt the December 2004 revision of Australian Accounting Standard AASB 119: ‘Employee Benefits’.

                    Defined benefit superannuation schemes

The Group operates a number of defined benefit schemes.  The liability and expense related to providing benefits to employees under each defined benefit scheme are calculated by independent actuaries.  Initially, a defined benefit liability is recognised to the extent that the present value of the defined benefit obligation of each scheme, calculated using the Projected Unit Credit Method, is greater than the fair value of each scheme’s assets.  Where this calculation results in a benefit to the Group, a defined benefit asset is recognised.  In each subsequent reporting period, ongoing movements in the defined benefit liability or asset carrying value are treated as follows:

-                    net movement relating to the current period’s service cost, interest cost, expected return on scheme assets, past service costs and other costs (such as the effects of any curtailments and settlements), is recognised as an employee expense in the income statement

-                    movements relating to actuarial gains and losses are recognised directly in retained earnings

-                    contributions incurred are recognised directly against the net defined benefit position.

  

 

64




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

1.                  Significant Accounting policies, cont’d

(xiii)                 Employee benefits, cont’d

                    Share-based compensation

The Group has various equity settled share-based compensation plans.  These are described in Note 49 of the 2005 annual financial report and largely comprise the Employee Share Acquisition Plan and the ANZ Share Option Plan.

ANZ ordinary shares

The fair value of ANZ ordinary shares granted under the Employee Share Acquisition Plan is measured at grant date, using the one-day volume weighted average market price of ANZ shares.  The fair value is expensed immediately when shares vest immediately or on a straight-line basis where shares vest over the relevant vesting period.  This is recognised as an employee compensation expense with a corresponding increase in equity.

Share options

The fair value of share options is measured at grant date, using an option pricing model.  The fair value is expensed on a straight-line basis over the relevant vesting period.  This is recognised as an employee compensation expense with a corresponding increase in the share options reserve.  The option pricing model takes into account the exercise price of the option, the risk free interest rate, the expected volatility of ANZ ordinary share price and other factors.  Market vesting conditions are taken into account in estimating the fair value.

Performance rights

From October 2005, ANZ has granted performance Rights to certain employees.  A Performance Right is a right to acquire a share at nil cost to the employee, subject to satisfactorily meeting time and performance hurdles.  Upon exercise, each Performance Right entitles the holder to one ordinary share in ANZ.  The fair value of Performance Rights is determined at grant date using an option pricing model, taking into account market conditions.  The fair value is expensed over the relevant vesting period.  This is recognised as an employee expense with a corresponding increase in equity.

Other adjustments

The amount of expense recognised during the vesting period is adjusted for the number of shares, options or performance rights expected to vest.  Non-market vesting conditions (eg service conditions) are taken into account, so that ultimately the expense recognised in the income statement reflects the number of shares or share options that actually vest.

(xiv)                    Offsetting of assets and liabilities

Assets and liabilities are offset and the net amount reported in the balance sheet only where:

§                   there is a current enforceable legal right to offset the asset and liability, and

§                   there is an intention to settle on a net basis, or to realise the asset and settle the liability simultaneously.

(xv)                        Income tax

                    Income tax expense

Income tax on earnings for the period comprises current and deferred tax and is based on the applicable tax law in each jurisdiction.  It is recognised in the income statement as tax expense, except when it relates to items credited directly to equity, in which case it is recorded in equity, or where it arises from the initial accounting for a business combination, in which case it is included in the determination of goodwill.

                    Current tax

Current tax is the expected tax payable on taxable income for the period, based on tax rates (and tax laws) which are enacted or substantively enacted by the reporting date, including any adjustment for tax payable in previous periods.  Current tax for current and prior periods is recognised as a liability (or asset) to the extent that it is unpaid (or refundable).

                    Deferred tax

Deferred tax is accounted for using the comprehensive tax balance sheet liability method.  It is generated by temporary differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes, and the amounts used for taxation purposes.

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured at the tax rates that are expected to apply to the period(s) when the asset and liability giving rise to them are realised or settled, based on tax rates (and tax laws) that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the reporting date.  The measurement reflects the tax consequences that would follow from the manner in which the Group, at the reporting date, recovers or settles the carrying amount of its assets and liabilities.

  

 

65




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

1.                  Significant Accounting policies, cont’d

(xv)                        Income tax, cont’d

Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for all taxable temporary differences, other than those in relation to taxable temporary differences arising from goodwill.  Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for taxable temporary differences arising on investments in controlled entities, branches, associates and joint ventures, except where the Group is able to control the reversal of the temporary differences and it is probable that temporary differences will not reverse in the foreseeable future.  Deferred tax assets associated with these interests are recognised only to the extent that it is probable that the temporary difference will reverse in the foreseeable future and there will be sufficient taxable profits against which to utilise the benefits of the temporary difference.

Deferred tax assets, including those related to the tax effects of income tax losses and credits available to be carried forward, are recognised only to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profits will be available against which the deductible temporary differences or unused tax losses and credits can be utilised.

                    Offsetting

Current and deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset only to the extent that they relate to income taxes imposed by the same taxation authority and there is a legal right and intention to settle on a net basis and it is allowed under the tax law of the relevant jurisdiction.

(xvi)                    Change in accounting policy

In the current reporting period the Group has adopted AASB 132: ‘Financial Instruments: Presentation and Disclosure’, AASB 139: ‘Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement’ and AASB 4: ‘Insurance Contracts’.  This change in accounting policy has been adopted in accordance with the transitional rules contained in AASB 1, which does not require the restatement of comparative information for financial instruments within the scope of AASB 132, AASB 139 and AASB 4.  The impact of this change in accounting policy in the current reporting period is detailed in Note 24.

 

 

66




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

2.   Income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Net interest income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest income

 

10,777

 

9,299

 

8,420

 

16

%

28

%

Interest expense

 

(7,409

)

(6,346

)

(5,555

)

17

%

33

%

Net interest income

 

3,368

 

2,953

 

2,865

 

14

%

18

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

i) Fee and commission income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Lending fees1

 

215

 

535

 

508

 

-60

%

-58

%

Non-lending fees and commissions

 

939

 

931

 

869

 

1

%

8

%

Total fee and commission income

 

1,154

 

1,466

 

1,377

 

-21

%

-16

%

Fee and commission expense2

 

(125

)

(115

)

(117

)

9

%

7

%

Net fee and commission income

 

1,029

 

1,351

 

1,260

 

-24

%

-18

%

ii) Other income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Foreign exchange earnings

 

227

 

233

 

222

 

-3

%

2

%

Net gains/(losses) from trading securities

 

17

 

40

 

(7

)

-58

%

large

 

Net gains/(losses) from trading derivatives

 

127

 

54

 

47

 

large

 

large

 

Other financial instruments3

 

18

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Settlement of NBNZ warranty claims

 

14

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Net profit before tax from the sale of NBNZ Life

 

-

 

14

 

-

 

-100

%

n/a

 

Share of joint venture profit from ING Australia

 

57

 

69

 

80

 

-17

%

-29

%

Share of joint venture profit from ING (NZ)4

 

11

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Share of associates profit (net of write-offs)

 

18

 

20

 

27

 

-10

%

-33

%

Private Equity and Infrastructure earnings5

 

10

 

5

 

17

 

100

%

-41

%

Other

 

67

 

75

 

71

 

-11

%

-6

%

Total other income

 

566

 

510

 

457

 

11

%

24

%

Total other operating income

 

1,595

 

1,861

 

1,717

 

-14

%

-7

%

Total income

 

12,372

 

11,160

 

10,137

 

11

%

22

%

Profit before income tax as a % of total income

 

20.64

%

20.18

%

21.17

%

 

 

 

 

 

1.

 

Lending fees in 2006 excludes fees included as part of the effective yield calculation

2.

 

Comprises interchange fees paid

3.

 

Includes any fair value movements (excluding realised and unrealised interest) on derivatives entered into to manage interest rate and foreign exchange risk on funding instruments, not designated as accounting hedges, ineffective portions of cash flow hedges, profit or loss on disposal of investment securities, and fair value movement in bonds and notes designated at fair value

4.

 

A joint venture entity from 30 September 2005

5.

 

Includes earnings from private equity and infrastructure portfolios. Includes share of associates’ profit $4 million (Sep 2005 half: $4 million; Mar 2005 half: $1 million) not included in share of associates’ profit above

67




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

3.   Operating expenses

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Personnel

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Employee entitlements and taxes

 

106

 

103

 

87

 

3

%

22

%

Salaries and wages

 

872

 

832

 

793

 

5

%

10

%

Superannuation costs - defined benefit plans

 

4

 

9

 

7

 

-56

%

-43

%

Superannuation costs - defined contribution plans

 

80

 

72

 

71

 

11

%

13

%

Equity-settled share -based payments

 

38

 

39

 

41

 

-3

%

-7

%

Temporary staff

 

64

 

62

 

49

 

3

%

31

%

Other

 

199

 

192

 

171

 

4

%

16

%

Total personnel expenses

 

1,363

 

1,309

 

1,219

 

4

%

12

%

Premises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Depreciation and amortisation

 

16

 

14

 

13

 

14

%

23

%

Rent

 

113

 

108

 

105

 

5

%

8

%

Utilities and other outgoings

 

64

 

62

 

60

 

3

%

7

%

Other

 

13

 

16

 

16

 

-19

%

-19

%

Total premises expenses

 

206

 

200

 

194

 

3

%

6

%

Computer

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Computer contractors

 

24

 

34

 

19

 

-29

%

26

%

Data communications

 

28

 

29

 

31

 

-3

%

-10

%

Depreciation and amortisation

 

104

 

120

 

115

 

-13

%

-10

%

Rentals and repairs

 

35

 

35

 

23

 

0

%

52

%

Software purchased

 

53

 

58

 

57

 

-9

%

-7

%

Other

 

20

 

19

 

18

 

5

%

11

%

Total computer expenses

 

264

 

295

 

263

 

-11

%

0

%

Other

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Advertising and public relations

 

80

 

82

 

79

 

-2

%

1

%

Audit fees

 

3

 

4

 

3

 

-25

%

0

%

Depreciation of furniture and equipment

 

23

 

20

 

23

 

15

%

0

%

Freight and cartage

 

23

 

23

 

22

 

0

%

5

%

Non-lending losses, frauds and forgeries

 

36

 

22

 

40

 

64

%

-10

%

Settlement of NHB insurance claim

 

(113

)

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Postage and stationery

 

57

 

57

 

56

 

0

%

2

%

Professional fees

 

61

 

62

 

61

 

-2

%

0

%

Telephone

 

28

 

25

 

30

 

12

%

-7

%

Travel

 

65

 

69

 

55

 

-6

%

18

%

Other

 

61

 

76

 

77

 

-20

%

-21

%

Total other expenses

 

324

 

440

 

446

 

-26

%

-27

%

Restructuring

 

28

 

22

 

30

 

27

%

-7

%

Operating expenses1

 

2,185

 

2,266

 

2,152

 

-4

%

2

%

 

1.

 

Includes ANZ National Bank incremental integration costs $39 million (Sep 2005 half: $53 million; Mar 2005 half: $25 million) refer page 11

68




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

4.   Income tax expense

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

(a) Reconciliation of the prima facie income tax expense on pre-tax profit with the income tax expense charged in the Income Statement

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating profit before income tax

 

2,554

 

2,252

 

2,146

 

13

%

19

%

Prima facie income tax expense at 30%

 

766

 

676

 

644

 

13

%

19

%

Tax effect of permanent differences:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Overseas tax rate differential

 

16

 

10

 

12

 

60

%

33

%

Rebateable and non-assessable dividends

 

(3

)

(9

)

(14

)

-67

%

-79

%

Other non-assessable income

 

(5

)

(17

)

(15

)

-71

%

-67

%

Profit from associated and joint venture entities

 

(26

)

(27

)

(32

)

-4

%

-19

%

Life insurance accounting

 

-

 

(2

)

(3

)

-100

%

-100

%

Other

 

(6

)

(1

)

-

 

large

 

n/a

 

 

 

742

 

630

 

592

 

18

%

25

%

Income tax under/ (over) provided in previous years

 

-

 

-

 

(2

)

n/a

 

-100

%

Total income tax expense on operating profit

 

742

 

630

 

590

 

18

%

26

%

Australia

 

474

 

422

 

381

 

12

%

24

%

Overseas

 

268

 

208

 

209

 

29

%

28

%

 

 

742

 

630

 

590

 

18

%

26

%

Effective Tax Rate - Group

 

29.1

%

28.0

%

27.5

%

 

 

 

 

Tax expense comprises:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Current tax expense

 

846

 

591

 

453

 

43

%

87

%

Deferred tax expense

 

(104

)

39

 

137

 

large

 

large

 

 

 

742

 

630

 

590

 

18

%

26

%

 

69




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

5.   Dividends

Ordinary Shares

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Dividend per ordinary share1 (cents)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interim (fully franked)

 

56

 

n/a

 

51

 

n/a

 

10

%

Final (fully franked)

 

n/a

 

59

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ordinary share dividend1,2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interim dividend paid

 

-

 

930

 

-

 

-100

%

n/a

 

Final dividend paid

 

1,078

 

-

 

983

 

n/a

 

10

%

Bonus option plan adjustment3

 

(18

)

(17

)

(19

)

6

%

-5

%

Total

 

1,060

 

913

 

964

 

16

%

10

%

Ordinary share dividend payout ratio4 (%)

 

56.9

%

68.4

%

61.3

%

 

 

 

 

 

1.

 

Excludes preference share dividend

2.

 

Dividends recorded when determined

3.

 

This relates to prior period dividend payments

4.

 

Dividend payout ratio calculated using proposed interim dividend of $1,024 million not included in the above table. Dividend payout ratio for the September 2005 half year calculated using $1,078 million dividends paid in the March 2006 half. Dividend payout ratio for March 2005 half year calculated using $930 million dividends paid in the September 2005 half

 

 

 

Preference Shares

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Preference share dividend

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ANZ StEPS1

 

-

 

34

 

32

 

-100

%

-100

%

Euro Hybrid

 

12

 

12

 

6

 

0

%

100

%

 

 

12

 

46

 

38

 

-74

%

-68

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dividend per preference share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ANZ StEPS (AUD)2

 

-

 

$3.40

 

$3.18

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Euro Hybrid (EUR)

 

€14.86

 

€14.22

 

€7.23

 

5

%

large

 

 

1.

 

Under AIFRS, the ANZ StEPS issue is treated as debt, with distributions being reported as an interest expense in the half year ended 31 March 2006

2.

 

Represents the equivalent dividend per share on distributions made

70




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

6.   Earnings per share

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Number of fully paid ordinary shares on issue (M)

 

1,828.7

 

1,826.4

 

1,822.7

 

0

%

0

%

Basic

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company ($M)

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12

%

16

%

Less Preference share dividends ($M)

 

12

 

46

 

38

 

-74

%

-68

%

Net profit excluding preference share dividends ($M)

 

1,799

 

1,574

 

1,517

 

14

%

19

%

Weighted average number of ordinary shares (M)

 

1,828.4

 

1,824.7

 

1,822.7

 

0

%

0

%

Basic earnings per share (cents)

 

98.4

 

86.3

 

83.2

 

14

%

18

%

Diluted

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net profit excluding preference share dividends ($M)

 

1,799

 

1,574

 

1,517

 

14

%

19

%

Interest on US Trust securities1 ($M)

 

29

 

25

 

23

 

16

%

26

%

Interest on ANZ StEPS2 ($M)

 

33

 

34

 

32

 

-3

%

3

%

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company excluding

 

1,861

 

1,633

 

1,572

 

14

%

18

%

interest on US Trust securities and ANZ StEPS ($M)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Adjusted weighted average number of shares on issue (M)

 

1,828.4

 

1,824.7

 

1,822.7

 

0

%

0

%

Weighted average number of convertible options (M)

 

11.9

 

9.3

 

7.7

 

28

%

55

%

Weighted average number of convertible US Trust securities at current market price1 (M)

 

58.0

 

60.1

 

69.1

 

-3

%

-16

%

Weighted average number of convertible ANZ StEPS securities

 

38.7

 

42.7

 

49.7

 

-9

%

-22

%

Adjusted weighted average number of shares - diluted (M)

 

1,937.0

 

1,936.8

 

1,949.2

 

0

%

-1

%

Diluted earnings per share (cents)

 

96.1

 

84.3

 

80.6

 

14

%

19

%

 

1.

 

The US Stapled Trust securities issued on 27 November 2003 mandatorily convert to ordinary shares in 2053 unless redeemed or bought back prior to that date. The US Stapled Trust Security issue can be de-stapled and the investor left with coupon paying preference shares at ANZ’s discretion at any time, or at the investor’s discretion under certain circumstances. AASB 133 requires that potential ordinary shares for which conversion to ordinary share capital is mandatory must be included in the calculation of diluted EPS. The inclusion of this issue in EPS increased the diluted number of shares by 58.0 million

 

 

 

2.

 

ANZ StEPS (issued on 23 September 2003) converts to either $100 for each ANZ StEPS share or a number of ordinary shares calculated at the market price of ANZ ordinary shares less 2.5%. ANZ StEPS has been included for the first time in dilutive EPS in 2005 due to the adoption of AIFRS. The inclusion of this issue in EPS increased the dilutive number of shares by 38.7 million

 

71




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)


7.    Derivative financial instruments

Derivatives

Derivative instruments are contracts whose value is derived from one or more underlying financial instruments or indices.  They include swaps, forward rate contracts, futures, options and combinations of these instruments.  The use of derivatives and their sale to customers as risk management products is an integral part of the Group’s trading activities.  Derivatives are also used to manage the Group’s own exposure to fluctuations in exchange and interest rates as part of its asset and liability management activities.  Derivatives are subject to the same types of credit and market risk as other financial instruments, and the Group manages these risks in a consistent manner.

The following table provides an overview of the Group’s exchange rate, interest rate, commodity and credit derivatives.  It includes all contracts, both trading and hedging.

Notional principal amount is the face value of the contract and represents the volume of outstanding transactions.  Credit equivalent amount is calculated in accordance with the APRA capital adequacy guidelines and combines the aggregate value of all contracts in a positive market position plus an allowance for the potential increase in value over the remaining term of the transaction.  Fair value is the net position of contracts with positive market values and negative market values.

 

As at 31 March 2006

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Fair Value

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Notional

 

Credit

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Principal

 

equivalent

 

Trading6

 

Hedging

 

Total fair value of derivatives

 

 

 

amount

 

amount

 

Assets

 

Liabilities

 

Assets

 

Liabilities

 

Assets

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Foreign exchange and commodities contracts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Spot and forward contracts

 

239,291

 

5,406

 

3,405

 

(2,743

)

216

 

(10

)

3,621

 

(2,753

)

Swap agreements4

 

100,384

 

5,938

 

2,375

 

(156

)

177

 

(270

)

2,552

 

(426

)

Futures contracts1

 

466

 

n/a

 

18

 

(28

)

-

 

-

 

18

 

(28

)

Options purchased

 

11,635

 

373

 

229

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

229

 

-

 

Options sold2

 

15,671

 

n/a

 

-

 

(198

)

-

 

-

 

-

 

(198

)

Other contracts

 

7,723

 

1,283

 

926

 

(823

)

-

 

-

 

926

 

(823

)

Collateral5

 

-

 

-

 

(1,942

)

543

 

-

 

-

 

(1,942

)

543

 

 

 

375,170

 

13,000

 

5,011

 

(3,405

)

393

 

(280

)

5,404

 

(3,685

)

Interest rate contracts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Forward rate agreements

 

71,743

 

8

 

3

 

(4

)

-

 

-

 

3

 

(4

)

Swap agreements4

 

481,229

 

4,394

 

1,601

 

(1,687

)

105

 

(433

)

1,706

 

(2,120

)

Futures contracts1

 

78,404

 

n/a

 

168

 

(165

)

2

 

-

 

170

 

(165

)

Options purchased

 

21,021

 

106

 

78

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

78

 

-

 

Options sold2

 

44,136

 

n/a

 

-

 

(33

)

-

 

-

 

-

 

(33

)

 

 

696,533

 

4,508

 

1,850

 

(1,889

)

107

 

(433

)

1,957

 

(2,322

)

Credit Contracts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Credit default swaps3

 

19,873

 

2,845

 

121

 

(124

)

3

 

(3

)

124

 

(127

)

Total

 

1,091,576

 

20,353

 

6,982

 

(5,418

)

503

 

(716

)

7,485

 

(6,134

)

 

1.

 

Credit equivalent amounts have not been included as there is minimal credit risk associated with exchange traded futures where the clearing house is the counterparty

2.

 

Options sold have no credit exposures as they represent obligations rather than assets

3.

 

Credit default swaps include structured transactions that expose the Group to the performance of certain assets. The total investment of the Group in these transactions is USD 250 million (Sep 2005:USD 500 million)

4.

 

The fair value of swap agreements includes internal allocations between Trading and Hedging

5.

 

Collateral relates predominantly to Foreign Exchange contracts

6.

 

Includes derivatives entered into to manage interest rate and foreign exchange risk on funding instruments, not designated as accounting hedges

72




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

7.    Derivative financial instruments, cont’d

The following table excludes the impact of AASB 132 and AASB 139.  As such the data in the table is not on a comparable basis to 31 March 2006 data.  This data has been adjusted to reflect the impact of derivatives in securitisation vehicles that were consolidated from 1 October 2004 on adoption of AIFRS.

 

As at 30 September 2005

 

 

 

Notional

 

Credit

 

Fair value

 

 

 

Principal

 

equivalent

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

amount

 

amount

 

Assets

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Foreign exchange and
commodities contracts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Spot and forward contracts

 

184,958

 

3,082

 

1,416

 

(1,829

)

Swap agreements4

 

69,212

 

3,820

 

864

 

(1,610

)

Futures contracts1

 

256

 

n/a

 

18

 

(14

)

Options purchased

 

9,340

 

315

 

186

 

-

 

Options sold2

 

14,925

 

n/a

 

-

 

(174

)

Other contracts

 

4,963

 

573

 

377

 

(379

)

Collateral5

 

-

 

-

 

(499

)

1,085

 

 

 

283,654

 

7,790

 

2,362

 

(2,921

)

Interest rate contracts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Forward rate agreements

 

47,734

 

8

 

5

 

(4

)

Swap agreements

 

405,152

 

3,443

 

1,624

 

(1,193

)

Futures contracts1

 

35,111

 

n/a

 

152

 

(144

)

Options purchased

 

12,810

 

96

 

62

 

-

 

Options sold2

 

16,715

 

n/a

 

-

 

(42

)

 

 

517,522

 

3,547

 

1,843

 

(1,383

)

Credit Contracts

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Credit default swaps3

 

15,437

 

2,929

 

117

 

(118

)

Total

 

816,613

 

14,266

 

4,322

 

(4,422

)

 

1-5.                 Refer footnotes on page 72

73




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

8.    Net loans and advances

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Australia

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Overdrafts

 

5,780

 

5,276

 

5,101

 

10

%

13

%

Credit card outstandings

 

5,904

 

5,434

 

4,853

 

9

%

22

%

Term loans - housing

 

96,846

 

91,196

 

86,421

 

6

%

12

%

Term loans - non-housing

 

50,873

 

48,893

 

46,299

 

4

%

10

%

Lease finance

 

2,774

 

2,854

 

2,737

 

-3

%

1

%

Other

 

9,795

 

9,636

 

9,118

 

2

%

7

%

 

 

171,972

 

163,289

 

154,529

 

5

%

11

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

New Zealand

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Overdrafts

 

1,677

 

1,647

 

1,683

 

2

%

0

%

Credit card outstandings

 

1,033

 

1,026

 

1,043

 

1

%

-1

%

Term loans - housing

 

34,961

 

34,859

 

33,123

 

0

%

6

%

Term loans - non-housing

 

25,103

 

25,012

 

23,549

 

0

%

7

%

Lease finance

 

361

 

639

 

508

 

-44

%

-29

%

Other

 

901

 

1,207

 

1,150

 

-25

%

-22

%

 

 

64,036

 

64,390

 

61,056

 

-1

%

5

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Overseas markets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Overdrafts

 

434

 

303

 

339

 

43

%

28

%

Credit card outstandings

 

184

 

134

 

126

 

37

%

46

%

Term loans - housing

 

693

 

592

 

519

 

17

%

34

%

Term loans - non-housing

 

8,051

 

7,510

 

7,219

 

7

%

12

%

Lease finance

 

217

 

217

 

201

 

0

%

8

%

Other

 

156

 

69

 

303

 

large

 

-49

%

 

 

9,735

 

8,825

 

8,707

 

10

%

12

%

Total gross loans and advances

 

245,743

 

236,504

 

224,292

 

4

%

10

%

Less provisions for credit impairment (refer note 10)2

 

(2,219

)

(2,440

)

(2,401

)

-9

%

-8

%

Less Income yet to mature1

 

(1,978

)

(1,574

)

(1,497

)

26

%

32

%

 

 

(4,197

)

(4,014

)

(3,898

)

5

%

8

%

Total net loans and advances1

 

241,546

 

232,490

 

220,394

 

4

%

10

%

 

1.

 

Includes fees and expenses capitalised and amortised using the effective interest method of $364 million (Sep 2005: $nil; Mar 2005: $nil)

2.

 

The provisions for credit impairment were recalculated under AIFRS for 31 March 2006. Refer to Note 24 for discussion of change

The following table shows gross loans and advances for New Zealand in NZD terms.

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

NZD M

 

NZD M

 

NZD M

 

%

 

%

 

New Zealand

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Overdrafts

 

1,962

 

1,811

 

1,834

 

8

%

7

%

Credit card outstandings

 

1,209

 

1,128

 

1,137

 

7

%

6

%

Term loans - housing

 

40,904

 

38,339

 

36,101

 

7

%

13

%

Term loans - non-housing

 

29,371

 

27,509

 

25,666

 

7

%

14

%

Lease finance

 

422

 

703

 

554

 

-40

%

-24

%

Other

 

1,054

 

1,326

 

1,253

 

-21

%

-16

%

 

 

74,922

 

70,816

 

66,545

 

6

%

13

%

 

74




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

9.     Impaired financial assets

Impaired loan data in 2005 in the following table includes loans that were classified as non-accrual loans.

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Summary of impaired financial assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Impaired loans

 

726

 

642

 

640

 

13

%

13

%

Restructured loans

 

-

 

28

 

30

 

-100

%

-100

%

Unproductive facilities

 

76

 

43

 

77

 

77

%

-1

%

Gross impaired financial assets

 

802

 

713

 

747

 

12

%

7

%

Less individual provisions:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Impaired loans

 

(305

)

(256

)

(314

)

19

%

-3

%

Unproductive facilities

 

(11

)

(17

)

(7

)

-35

%

57

%

Net impaired financial assets

 

486

 

440

 

426

 

10

%

14

%

Impaired loans

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Impaired loans

 

726

 

642

 

640

 

13

%

13

%

Individual provisions

 

(305

)

(256

)

(314

)

19

%

-3

%

Total net impaired loans

 

421

 

386

 

326

 

9

%

29

%

Before individual provisions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

516

 

355

 

408

 

45

%

26

%

New Zealand

 

177

 

194

 

105

 

-9

%

69

%

Overseas markets

 

33

 

93

 

127

 

-65

%

-74

%

Total impaired loans

 

726

 

642

 

640

 

13

%

13

%

After individual provisions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

304

 

202

 

220

 

50

%

38

%

New Zealand

 

102

 

111

 

42

 

-8

%

large

 

Overseas markets

 

15

 

73

 

64

 

-79

%

-77

%

Total net impaired loans

 

421

 

386

 

326

 

9

%

29

%

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

New and increased impaired loans

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

513

 

303

 

282

 

69

%

82

%

New Zealand

 

102

 

204

 

78

 

-50

%

31

%

Overseas markets

 

15

 

69

 

27

 

-78

%

-44

%

Total new impaired loans

 

630

 

576

 

387

 

9

%

63

%

 

75




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

9.             Impaired financial assets, cont’d

 

Further analysis on impaired loans at 31 March 2006 and interest and/or other income recognised during the period is as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

Interest

 

 

 

Gross

 

 

 

and / or

 

 

 

balance

 

Individual

 

other income

 

 

 

outstanding

 

Provision

 

recognised

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Impaired loans

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Without provisions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

31

 

 

1

 

New Zealand

 

7

 

 

 

Overseas markets

 

4

 

 

 

 

 

42

 

 

1

 

With provisions and no, or partial, performance1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

369

 

178

 

7

 

New Zealand

 

60

 

40

 

 

Overseas markets

 

28

 

17

 

 

 

 

457

 

235

 

7

 

With provisions and full performance1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

116

 

34

 

2

 

New Zealand

 

110

 

35

 

3

 

Overseas markets

 

1

 

1

 

 

 

 

227

 

70

 

5

 

Total impaired loans

 

726

 

305

 

13

 

Unproductive facilities

 

76

 

11

 

 

Total

 

802

 

316

 

13

 

 

1.                     A loan’s performance is assessed against its contractual repayment schedule

 

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Unproductive facilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

63

 

29

 

66

 

large

 

-5

%

New Zealand

 

6

 

7

 

 

-14

%

n/a

 

Overseas markets

 

7

 

7

 

11

 

0

%

-36

%

Gross unproductive facilities

 

76

 

43

 

77

 

77

%

-1

%

Individual provision

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

9

 

7

 

3

 

29

%

large

 

New Zealand

 

 

7

 

 

-100

%

n/a

 

Overseas markets

 

2

 

3

 

4

 

-33

%

-50

%

Individual provision

 

11

 

17

 

7

 

-35

%

57

%

Net unproductive facilities

 

65

 

26

 

70

 

large

 

-7

%

 

The following amounts are not classified as individually impaired financial assets and therefore are not included within the summary on page 75.

 

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Accruing loans past due 90 days or more

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

339

 

282

 

262

 

20

%

29

%

New Zealand

 

74

 

66

 

90

 

12

%

-18

%

Overseas markets

 

15

 

33

 

32

 

-55

%

-53

%

 

 

428

 

381

 

384

 

12

%

11

%

 

76




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

9.             Impaired financial assets, cont’d

 

Interest and other income not recognised on impaired financial assets

 

The following table shows the estimated amount of interest and other income not recognised, net of interest recoveries and unwind of discount, on average impaired financial assets during the period.

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross interest and other income receivable on impaired loans, restructured loans and unproductive facilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

14

 

14

 

12

 

0

%

17

%

New Zealand

 

9

 

5

 

4

 

80

%

large

 

Overseas markets

 

4

 

8

 

8

 

-50

%

-50

%

Total gross interest and other income receivable on impaired financial assets

 

27

 

27

 

24

 

0

%

13

%

Interest recognised1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

(10

)

(7

)

(3

)

43

%

large

 

New Zealand

 

(3

)

(3

)

(2

)

0

%

50

%

Overseas markets

 

 

(7

)

(3)

 

-100

%

-100

%

Total interest recognised

 

(13

)

(17

)

(8

)

-24

%

63

%

Net interest and other income not recognised

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

4

 

7

 

9

 

-43

%

-56

%

New Zealand

 

6

 

2

 

2

 

large

 

large

 

Overseas markets

 

4

 

1

 

5

 

large

 

-20

%

Total net interest and other income not recognised

 

14

 

10

 

16

 

40

%

-13

%

 

1.                     Under AIFRS, from 1 October 2005 the impairment loss on an impaired loan is calculated as the difference between the asset’s carrying amount and the estimated future cash flows discounted to their present value.  As this discount unwinds during the period it is recognised as interest.  The comparatives do not reflect this change and represent interest and other income received (refer Note 1 (vi))

 


In the event of customer default, any loan security is held as mortgagee in possession and therefore the Group does not hold any other real estate owned assets.

77




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

10.          Provision for credit impairment

 

 

 

 

 

Previous AGAAP1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v. Sep 05

 

v. Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Collective provision

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at start of period

 

2,167

 

2,080

 

1,992

 

4

%

9

%

Adjustment due to adoption of accounting standard AASB 1392

 

(288

)

 

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Provisions acquired (disposed)

 

 

 

(13

)

n/a

 

-100

%

Adjustment for exchange rate fluctuations

 

(12

)

(3

)

(32

)

large

 

-63

%

Charge to income statement

 

36

 

296

 

284

 

-88

%

-87

%

Transfer to individual provision3

 

 

(266

)

(205

)

-100

%

-100

%

Recoveries3

 

 

60

 

54

 

-100

%

-100

%

Total collective provision

 

1,903

 

2,167

 

2,080

 

-12

%

-9

%

Individual provision

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at start of period

 

273

 

321

 

384

 

-15

%

-29

%

Adjustment due to adoption of accounting standard AASB 1392

 

(1

)

 

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Charge to income statement

 

188

 

 

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Adjustment for exchange rate fluctuations

 

(3

)

(4

)

(7

)

-25

%

-57

%

Discount unwind

 

(13

)

 

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Bad debts written off

 

(182

)

(310

)

(261

)

-41

%

-30

%

Recoveries of amounts previously written off

 

54

 

 

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Transfer from collective provision3

 

 

266

 

205

 

-100

%

-100

%

Total individual provision

 

316

 

273

 

321

 

16

%

-2

%

Total provision for credit impairment

 

2,219

 

2,440

 

2,401

 

-9

%

-8

%

 

 

 

 

 

Previous AGAAP

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Provision movement analysis

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

New and increased provisions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

255

 

216

 

162

 

18

%

57

%

New Zealand

 

40

 

99

 

47

 

-60

%

-15

%

Overseas markets

 

12

 

37

 

43

 

-68

%

-72

%

 

 

307

 

352

 

252

 

-13

%

22

%

Provision releases

 

(65

)

(86

)

(47

)

-24

%

38

%

 

 

242

 

266

 

205

 

-9

%

18

%

Recoveries of amounts previously written off

 

(54

)

(60

)

(54

)

-10

%

0

%

Individual provision charge

 

188

 

206

 

151

 

-9

%

25

%

Net credit to collective provision

 

36

 

90

 

133

 

-60

%

-73

%

Charge to Income Statement

 

224

 

296

 

284

 

-24

%

-21

%

 

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Individual provision balance

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

221

 

160

 

191

 

38

%

16

%

New Zealand

 

75

 

90

 

63

 

-17

%

19

%

Domestic markets

 

296

 

250

 

254

 

18

%

17

%

Overseas markets

 

20

 

23

 

67

 

-13

%

-70

%

Total individual provision

 

316

 

273

 

321

 

16

%

-2

%

 

1.             2005 figures represent general provision and specific provision

2.             Refer Note 24

3.             Under AIFRS, the impairment calculation results in a nil amount for this line from 1 October 2005

78




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 
11.          Loan capital

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Hybrid loan capital

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

US stapled trust security issue1

 

1,536

 

1,443

 

1,425

 

6

%

8

%

ANZ Stapled Exchangeable Preferred Securities (ANZ StEPS)

 

1,000

 

 

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Perpetual subordinated notes

 

419

 

394

 

389

 

6

%

8

%

Subordinated notes

 

8,166

 

7,300

 

6,307

 

12

%

29

%

Total Loan Capital

 

11,121

 

9,137

 

8,121

 

22

%

37

%

 

1.             Loan capital of USD1.1 billion is subordinated in right of payment to the claims of depositors and all other creditors of the parent entity and its controlled entities which have issued the notes.  Hybrid loan capital constitutes Tier 1 capital as defined by the Australian Prudential Regulation Authority for capital adequacy purposes

2.             ANZ StEPS securities are classified as Loan Capital instead of share capital under AIFRS financial reporting

 
12.          Share Capital

 

Issued and quoted securities

 

 

Number

 

Issue price

 

Amount paid

 

 

 

quoted

 

per share

 

up per share

 

Ordinary shares

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As at 31 March 2006

 

1,828,674,133

 

 

 

 

 

Issued during the half year

 

8,316,739

 

 

 

 

 

Bought back during half year

 

6,092,086

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Preference shares

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

As at 31 March 2006

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Euro Hybrid1

 

500,000

 

1,000

 

1,000

 

 

1.             On 13 December 2004 the Group issued €500 million hybrid capital into the European market.  The instruments consist of a coupon paying note issued by ANZ Jackson Funding PLC stapled to a fully paid up €1,000 preference share issued by Australia and New Zealand Banking Group Limited

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Net profit as a % of shareholders’ equity including preference shares at end of period

 

19.3

%

16.6

%

16.4

%

 

 

 

79




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

13. Shareholders’ Equity

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

v . Sep 05

 

v . Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Share capital

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at start of period

 

9,911

 

9,840

 

8,992

 

1

%

10

%

Adjustment due to adoption of AIFRS

 

(987

)

-

 

(62

)

n/a

 

large

 

Ordinary share capital

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Rights issue

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Dividend reinvestment plan

 

85

 

75

 

78

 

13

%

9

%

Group employee share acquisition scheme

 

37

 

27

 

30

 

37

%

23

%

Group share option scheme

 

39

 

56

 

48

 

-30

%

-19

%

Group Share Buyback

 

(146

)

(87

)

(117

)

68

%

25

%

Preference share capital

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

New preference share issues

 

-

 

-

 

871

 

n/a

 

-100

%

Total share capital

 

8,939

 

9,911

 

9,840

 

-10

%

-9

%

Asset revaluation reserve

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at start of period

 

-

 

-

 

31

 

n/a

 

-100

%

Adjustment due to adoption of AIFRS1

 

-

 

-

 

(31

)

n/a

 

-100

%

Total asset revaluation reserve

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Foreign currency translation reserve

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at start of period

 

(443

)

(284

)

218

 

56

%

large

 

Adjustment due to adoption of AIFRS2

 

-

 

-

 

(218

)

n /a

 

-100

%

Restated balance at beginning of period

 

(443

)

(284

)

-

 

56

%

n/a

 

Currency translation adjustments net of hedges after tax

 

(305

)

(159

)

(284

)

92

%

7

%

Transfer from general reserve

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Total foreign currency translation reserve

 

(748

)

(443

)

(284

)

69

%

large

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Share option reserve3

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at start of period

 

67

 

56

 

-

 

20

%

n/a

 

Adjustment on adoption of AIFRS

 

-

 

-

 

44

 

n/a

 

-100

%

Restated balance at beginning of period

 

67

 

56

 

44

 

20

%

52

%

Share-based payments

 

11

 

11

 

12

 

0

%

-8

%

Transfer to share capital

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Total share option reserve

 

78

 

67

 

56

 

16

%

39

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Available-for-sale revaluation reserve4

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at start of period

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Adjustments on adoption of accounting policies specified

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

by AASB 132 & AASB 1395

 

(10

)

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Restated balance at beginning of period

 

(10

)

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Valuation gain (loss) recognised after tax

 

18

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Cumulative (gain) loss transferred to the income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

statement on sale of financial assets

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Cumulative (gain) loss transferred to the income

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

statement on impairment of financial assets

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n /a

 

n/a

 

Total available-for-sale revaluation reserve

 

8

 

-

 

-

 

n /a

 

n/a

 

 

1.               Includes a $20 million increase in the opening asset revaluation reserve balance relating to reclassification of legacy balances.  The asset revaluation reserve has been transferred to retained earnings on adoption of AIFRS, refer Note 24 (vi)

2.               Includes a $19 million increase in the opening foreign currency translation reserve balance relating to reclassification of legacy balances.  The foreign currency translation reserve has been transferred to retained earnings on adoption of AIFRS, refer Note 24 (v)

3.               The share option reserve arises on the grant of share options to selected employees under the ANZ share option plan.  Amounts are transferred out of the reserve and into share capital when the options are exercised.  Further information about share based payments to employees is disclosed in Note 24 (iii) to the financial statements

4.               The available-for-sale revaluation reserve arises on the revaluation of available-for-sale financial assets.  Where a revalued financial asset is sold, that portion of the reserve which relates to that financial asset, is realised and recognised in the profit or loss (refer Note 1 (ix)).  Where a revalued financial asset is impaired, that portion of the reserve which relates to that financial asset is recognised in the profit or loss (refer Note 1 (ix))

5.               ANZ has taken the election, pursuant to accounting standard AASB 1 (36A), to not comply with accounting standards AASB 132 and AASB 139 in the comparative information in its first AIFRS financial report.  Therefore the 2005 year is nil for this line item

 

80




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

13. Shareholders’ Equity, cont’d

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05 

 

v .Sep 05 

 

v .Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

%

 

Hedging reserve6

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at start of period

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Adjustments on adoption of accounting policies

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

specified by AASB 132 & AASB 1395

 

162

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Restated balance at beginning of period

 

162

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Gain (loss) recognised after tax

 

28

 

 

 

 

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Transferred to income statement

 

(14

)

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Total hedging reserve

 

176

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

General reserve

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at start of period

 

181

 

181

 

181

 

0

%

0

%

Transfer (to) from retained profits/FCTR

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Total general reserve

 

181

 

181

 

181

 

0

%

0

%

Capital reserve

 

149

 

149

 

149

 

0

%

0

%

Total reserves

 

(156

)

(46

)

102

 

large

 

large

 

Retained profits

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Balance at start of period

 

9,646

 

8,967

 

8,336

 

8

%

16

%

Adjustment on adoption of AIFRS7

 

(431

)

-

 

71

 

n/a

 

large

 

Restated balance at beginning of period

 

9,215

 

8,967

 

8,407

 

3

%

10

%

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12

%

16

%

Total available for appropriation

 

11,026

 

10,587

 

9,962

 

4

%

11

%

Transfers from (to) reserves

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Actuarial gain (loss) on defined benefit plans after tax8

 

25

 

18

 

7

 

39

%

large

 

Ordinary share dividends paid

 

(1,060

)

(913

)

(964

)

16

%

10

%

Preference share dividends paid

 

(12

)

(46

)

(38

)

-74

%

-68

%

Retained profits at end of period

 

9,979

 

9,646

 

8,967

 

3

%

11

%

Share capital and reserves attributable to
to shareholders’ of the Company

 

18,762

 

19,511

 

18,909

 

-4

%

-1

%

Minority interest

 

34

 

27

 

18

 

26

%

89

%

Total shareholders’ equity

 

18,796

 

19,538

 

18,927

 

-4

%

-1

%

6.               The hedging reserve represents hedging gains and losses recognised on the effective portion of cash flow hedges.  The cumulative deferred gain or loss on the hedge is recognised in the profit or loss when the hedged transaction impacts profit or loss, consistent with the applicable accounting policy as detailed in Note 1 (vii)

7.               Comprises

-                     Remeasurement of the carrying value of the Group’s investment in INGA as at 1 October 2005

-                     Adjustment in respect of hedging derivative financial instruments as at 1 October 2005

-                     Recognition of the fair value of derivatives relating to securitisation and structured finance transactions as at 1 October 2005

-                     Deferral of previously recognised fees now treated as an adjustment to yield on 1 October 2005

-                     Recalculation of the loan impairment provision on 1 October 2005 resulting from the change to use of the incurred loss approach from the Economic Loss Provisioning approach

8.               ANZ has taken the option available under AASB 119 to recognise actuarial gains/losses on defined benefit superannuation plans directly in retained profits (refer Note 1 (xiii) and Note 24 (ii))

 

81




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

14. Capital Management

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

Movt

 

Movt

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 051

 

Mar 051

 

Mar 06

 

Mar 06

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

v. Sep

 

v. Mar

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

05

 

05

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

%

 

%

 

Qualifying capital

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tier 1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total shareholders’ equity and outside equity interests

 

18,796

 

19,538

 

18,927

 

-4

%

-1

%

Adjustments following adoption of AIFRS2

 

 

 

(50

)

81

 

-100

%

-100

%

APRA transitional reporting adjustments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deferred fee revenue and expenses

 

258

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Pension fund deficiency charge

 

91

 

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Cash flow hedging reserve

 

(176

)

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Other adjustments

 

(5

)

-

 

-

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Adjusted Total Shareholders’ equity and outside equity interests

 

18,964

 

19,488

 

19,008

 

-3

%

0

%

Loan capital (StEPS)3

 

1,000

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Hybrid loan capital4

 

1,536

 

1,443

 

1,425

 

6

%

8

%

Less:   Asset revaluation reserve

 

-

 

(31

)

(31

)

-100

%

-100

%

Dividend5

 

(1,024

)

(1,077

)

(930

)

-5

%

10

%

Accumulated retained profits and reserves of insurance,
funds management and securitisation entities

 

(161

)

(213

)

(266

)

-24

%

-39

%

Intangibles

 

(3,943

)

(3,902

)

(4,007

)

1

%

-2

%

Capitalised expenses6

 

(534

)

(524

)

(492

)

2

%

9

%

Investment in ANZ Lenders Mortgage Insurance

 

(27

)

(27

)

(27

)

0

%

0

%

Tier 1 capital

 

15,811

 

15,157

 

14,680

 

4

%

8

%

Tier 2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Asset revaluation reserve

 

-

 

31

 

31

 

-100

%

-100

%

Perpetual subordinated notes

 

419

 

394

 

389

 

6

%

8

%

General reserve for impairment of financial assets7

 

1,318

 

1,448

 

1,390

 

-9

%

-5

%

 

 

1,737

 

1,873

 

1,810

 

-7

%

-4

%

Subordinated notes8

 

7,416

 

6,701

 

5,769

 

11

%

29

%

Tier 2 capital

 

9,153

 

8,574

 

7,579

 

7

%

21

%

Deductions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Investment in funds management and securitisation entities

 

86

 

84

 

106

 

2

%

-19

%

Investment in joint ventures with ING9

 

525

 

528

 

478

 

-1

%

10

%

Other

 

334

 

172

 

183

 

94

%

83

%

Total deductions

 

945

 

784

 

767

 

21

%

23

%

Total qualifying capital

 

24,019

 

22,947

 

21,492

 

5

%

12

%

Adjusted common equity (ACE)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tier 1 capital

 

15,811

 

15,157

 

14,680

 

4

%

8

%

Less:    Preference share capital

 

3,385

 

3,233

 

3,263

 

5

%

4

%

Deductions

 

945

 

784

 

767

 

21

%

23

%

Adjusted common equity10 (ACE)

 

11,481

 

11,140

 

10,650

 

3

%

8

%

Ratios (%)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Tier 1

 

6.8

%

6.9

%

7.0

%

 

 

 

 

Tier 2

 

4.0

%

3.9

%

3.6

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

10.8

%

10.8

%

10.6

%

 

 

 

 

Less:  Deductions

 

(0.4

%)

(0.3

%)

(0.3

%)

 

 

 

 

Total

 

10.4

%

10.5

%

10.3

%

 

 

 

 

Adjusted common equity

 

5.0

%

5.1

%

5.1

%

 

 

 

 

Risk weighted assets

 

230,653

 

219,573

 

209,524

 

 

 

 

 

1.             2005 figures are calculated based on the Australian Prudential Regulatory Authority requirements.  These have not been retrospectively adjusted

2.             Refer Note 24

3.             Treated as preference share capital under AGAAP.  Associated costs are deducted from capital

4.             Represents the US Stapled Trust Security Issue approved by APRA as qualifying for Tier 1 status.  Refer Note 11

5.             Relates to dividend not provided for

6.             Comprises loan and lease origination fees, capitalised securitisation establishment costs and costs associated with debt raisings

7.             Net of attributable future income tax benefit

8.             For capital adequacy calculation purposes, subordinated note issues are reduced by 20% of the original amount over the last four years to maturity

9.             Joint ventures with ING in Australia and New Zealand

10.         Tier 1 capital, less preference share capital (converted at 31 March 2006 rates), less deductions

 

82




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

14. Capital management, cont’d

 

Assets

 

Risk Weighted

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Assets

 

 

 

Mar

 

Sep

 

Mar

 

Sep

 

 

 

2006

 

2005

 

2006

 

2005

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Balance Sheet

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Zero risk weighted assets1

 

31,779

 

23,160

 

-

 

-

 

Claims on approved banks and local governments

 

19,759

 

16,054

 

3,952

 

3,211

 

Advances secured by mortgages eligible for 50% risk weighting

 

123,998

 

118,895

 

61,999

 

59,448

 

Other assets - credit risk

 

133,529

 

127,204

 

133,529

 

127,204

 

Total statement of financial position assets - credit risk

 

309,065

 

285,313

 

199,480

 

189,863

 

Trading assets - market risk

 

10,298

 

7,872

 

n/a

 

n/a

 

Impact of adoption of AIFRS2

 

-

 

4,919

 

-

 

-

 

Total balance sheet

 

319,363

 

298,104

 

199,480

 

189,863

 

 

 

 

Notional Amount

 

Credit Equivalent

 

Risk Weighted

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Assets

 

 

 

Mar

 

Sep

 

Mar

 

Sep

 

Mar

 

Sep

 

 

 

2006

 

2005

 

2006

 

2005

 

2006

 

2005

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Off-balance sheet exposures3

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Direct credit substitutes

 

9,193

 

9,657

 

9,193

 

9,657

 

6,732

 

7,337

 

Trade and performance related items

 

14,534

 

13,175

 

6,170

 

5,683

 

5,451

 

4,953

 

Commitments

 

89,236

 

87,319

 

13,352

 

14,017

 

11,983

 

12,249

 

Foreign exchange, interest rate and other market
related transactions

 

1,029,803

 

782,380

 

19,116

 

12,309

 

5,354

 

3,681

 

Total off balance sheet exposures - credit risk

 

1,142,766

 

892,531

 

47,831

 

41,666

 

29,520

 

28,220

 

Total risk weighted assets - credit risk

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

229,000

 

218,083

 

Risk weighted assets - market risk

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,653

 

1,490

 

Total risk weighted assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

230,653

 

219,573

 

1.               Includes $5,086 million in assets excluded for risk weighting calculations for Australian Prudential Regulation Authority reporting purposes

2.               Refer Note 24

3.               Excludes off balance sheet exposures in subsidiaries consolidated on adoption of AIFRS from 1 October 2004 as required by Australian Prudential Regulation Authority

 

83




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

15.            Average balance sheet and related interest - statutory basis

Averages used in the following tables are predominantly daily averages.  Interest income figures are presented on a tax-equivalent basis.  Impaired loans are included under the interest earning asset category, “loans, advances and bills discounted”.  Intragroup interest earning assets and interest bearing liabilities are treated as external assets and liabilities for the geographic segments.

 

Half year Mar 06

 

Half year Sep 05

 

Half year Mar 05

 

 

 

Ave bal

 

Int

 

Rate

 

Ave bal

 

Int

 

Rate

 

Ave bal

 

Int

 

Rate

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

Interest earning assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due from other financial institutions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

1,320

 

32

 

4.9

%

880

 

24

 

5.4

%

733

 

19

 

5.2

%

New Zealand

 

2,131

 

69

 

6.5

%

2,092

 

63

 

6.0

%

2,392

 

63

 

5.3

%

Overseas markets

 

4,586

 

99

 

4.3

%

3,108

 

58

 

3.7

%

2,218

 

32

 

2.9

%

Trading and available for sale and other assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

15,255

 

433

 

5.7

%

11,300

 

309

 

5.5

%

10,296

 

280

 

5.5

%

New Zealand

 

2,292

 

83

 

7.3

%

2,052

 

63

 

6.1

%

2,401

 

70

 

5.8

%

Overseas markets

 

2,687

 

57

 

4.3

%

2,805

 

49

 

3.5

%

3,179

 

51

 

3.2

%

Loans and advances

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

165,103

 

5,987

 

7.3

%

157,694

 

5,590

 

7.1

%

148,104

 

5,081

 

6.9

%

New Zealand

 

65,866

 

2,849

 

8.7

%

62,829

 

2,648

 

8.4

%

59,230

 

2,423

 

8.2

%

Overseas markets

 

9,172

 

308

 

6.7

%

8,770

 

244

 

5.5

%

9,352

 

217

 

4.7

%

Acceptances1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

13,725

 

464

 

6.8

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Overseas markets

 

170

 

4

 

4.7

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Other assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

3,337

 

128

 

7.7

%

2,533

 

61

 

4.8

%

1,897

 

47

 

5.0

%

New Zealand

 

4,417

 

133

 

6.0

%

3,340

 

91

 

5.4

%

2,481

 

71

 

5.7

%

Overseas markets

 

4,303

 

131

 

6.1

%

4,011

 

109

 

5.4

%

2,623

 

81

 

6.2

%

Intragroup assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Overseas markets

 

12,046

 

272

 

4.5

%

9,242

 

179

 

3.9

%

9,706

 

151

 

3.1

%

 

 

306,410

 

11,049

 

 

 

270,656

 

9,488

 

 

 

254,612

 

8,586

 

 

 

Intragroup elimination

 

(12,046

)

(272

)

 

 

(9,242

)

(179

)

 

 

(9,706

)

(151

)

 

 

 

 

294,364

 

10,777

 

7.3

%

261,414

 

9,309

 

7.1

%

244,906

 

8,435

 

6.9

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-interest earning assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Derivatives

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

6,708

 

 

 

 

 

6,134

 

 

 

 

 

4,024

 

 

 

 

 

New Zealand

 

2,180

 

 

 

 

 

1,584

 

 

 

 

 

1,707

 

 

 

 

 

Overseas markets

 

(564

)

 

 

 

 

(364

)

 

 

 

 

(445

)

 

 

 

 

Premises and equipment

 

1,078

 

 

 

 

 

1,155

 

 

 

 

 

1,033

 

 

 

 

 

Acceptances

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

13,258

 

 

 

 

 

13,073

 

 

 

 

 

Overseas markets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

86

 

 

 

 

 

61

 

 

 

 

 

Other assets

 

13,794

 

 

 

 

 

13,516

 

 

 

 

 

12,683

 

 

 

 

 

Provisions for credit impairment

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

(1,499

)

 

 

 

 

(1,852

)

 

 

 

 

(1,792

)

 

 

 

 

New Zealand

 

(432

)

 

 

 

 

(621

)

 

 

 

 

(594

)

 

 

 

 

Overseas markets

 

(185

)

 

 

 

 

2

 

 

 

 

 

(32

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

21,080

 

 

 

 

 

32,898

 

 

 

 

 

29,718

 

 

 

 

 

Total average assets

 

315,444

 

 

 

 

 

294,312

 

 

 

 

 

274,624

 

 

 

 

 

 

1.                       Acceptances have been classified as interest earning assets following adoption of AIFRS on 1 October 2005.  This is consistent with the reclassification of commercial bill margins from fees to net interest.  Refer Note 24

84




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

15.           Average balance sheet and related interest - statutory basis, cont’d

 

Half year Mar 06

 

Half year Sep 05

 

Half year Mar 05

 

 

 

Ave bal

 

Int

 

Rate

 

Ave bal

 

Int

 

Rate

 

Ave bal

 

Int

 

Rate

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

$M

 

$M

 

%

 

Interest bearing liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Time deposits

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

41,323

 

1,151

 

5.6

%

40,122

 

1,106

 

5.5

%

38,650

 

1,020

 

5.3

%

New Zealand

 

26,868

 

927

 

6.9

%

25,537

 

847

 

6.6

%

25,626

 

813

 

6.4

%

Overseas markets

 

12,802

 

283

 

4.4

%

11,185

 

210

 

3.7

%

10,965

 

173

 

3.2

%

Savings deposits

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

14,765

 

228

 

3.1

%

14,092

 

215

 

3.0

%

13,699

 

199

 

2.9

%

New Zealand

 

7,021

 

151

 

4.3

%

7,264

 

151

 

4.1

%

7,155

 

140

 

3.9

%

Overseas markets

 

502

 

3

 

1.2

%

419

 

1

 

0.5

%

415

 

1

 

0.5

%

Other demand deposits

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

37,384

 

812

 

4.4

%

35,443

 

765

 

4.3

%

32,448

 

666

 

4.1

%

New Zealand

 

8,375

 

242

 

5.8

%

8,165

 

219

 

5.3

%

7,818

 

193

 

5.0

%

Overseas markets

 

968

 

9

 

1.9

%

805

 

7

 

1.7

%

783

 

6

 

1.5

%

Due to other financial institutions

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

3,012

 

78

 

5.2

%

1,515

 

47

 

6.2

%

1,397

 

39

 

5.6

%

New Zealand

 

2,128

 

58

 

5.5

%

1,567

 

47

 

6.0

%

1,793

 

45

 

5.0

%

Overseas markets

 

6,602

 

164

 

5.0

%

5,073

 

101

 

4.0

%

4,209

 

64

 

3.0

%

Commercial paper

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

9,605

 

275

 

5.7

%

7,770

 

226

 

5.8

%

7,988

 

218

 

5.5

%

New Zealand

 

6,879

 

253

 

7.4

%

7,769

 

268

 

6.9

%

7,664

 

253

 

6.6

%

Overseas markets

 

8,626

 

180

 

4.2

%

6,421

 

103

 

3.2

%

6,099

 

69

 

2.3

%

Borrowing corporations' debt

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

9,124

 

257

 

5.6

%

9,276

 

264

 

5.7

%

9,396

 

254

 

5.4

%

New Zealand

 

1,962

 

67

 

6.8

%

1,927

 

64

 

6.6

%

1,981

 

62

 

6.3

%

Acceptances1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

13,725

 

384

 

5.6

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Overseas markets

 

170

 

4

 

4.7

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Loan capital, bonds and notes

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

43,593

 

1,252

 

5.8

%

41,281

 

1,176

 

5.7

%

35,312

 

962

 

5.5

%

New Zealand

 

8,891

 

331

 

7.5

%

5,906

 

211

 

7.1

%

3,601

 

124

 

6.9

%

Overseas markets

 

137

 

3

 

4.4

%

136

 

2

 

2.9

%

139

 

2

 

2.9

%

Other liabilities2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

4,847

 

233

 

n/a

 

4,729

 

243

 

n/a

 

4,460

 

206

 

n/a

 

New Zealand

 

234

 

50

 

n/a

 

150

 

66

 

n/a

 

64

 

35

 

n/a

 

Overseas markets

 

469

 

14

 

n/a

 

95

 

7

 

n/a

 

86

 

11

 

n/a

 

Intragroup liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

5,724

 

82

 

2.9

%

3,100

 

(6

)

-0.4

%

4,190

 

(8

)

-0.4

%

New Zealand

 

6,322

 

190

 

6.0

%

6,142

 

185

 

6.0

%

5,516

 

159

 

5.8

%

 

 

282,058

 

7,681

 

 

 

245,889

 

6,525

 

 

 

231,454

 

5,706

 

 

 

Intragroup elimination

 

(12,046

)

(272

)

 

 

(9,242

)

(179

)

 

 

(9,706

)

(151

)

 

 

 

 

270,012

 

7,409

 

5.5

%

236,647

 

6,346

 

5.3

%

221,748

 

5,555

 

5.0

%

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Non-interest bearing liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deposits

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

4,387

 

 

 

 

 

4,173

 

 

 

 

 

4,121

 

 

 

 

 

New Zealand

 

3,858

 

 

 

 

 

3,771

 

 

 

 

 

3,298

 

 

 

 

 

Overseas markets

 

1,104

 

 

 

 

 

1,071

 

 

 

 

 

881

 

 

 

 

 

Acceptances

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

13,258

 

 

 

 

 

13,073

 

 

 

 

 

Overseas markets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

86

 

 

 

 

 

61

 

 

 

 

 

 

1.                       Acceptances have been classified as interest bearing liabilities following adoption of AIFRS on 1 October 2005.  This is consistent with the reclassification of commercial bill margins from fees to net interest.  Refer Note 24

2.                       Includes foreign exchange swap costs

85




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

15.           Average balance sheet and related interest - statutory basis, cont’d

 

Half
year
Mar 06
$M

 

Half
year
Sep 05
$M

 

Half
year
Mar 05
$M

 

Total average assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

211,498

 

197,692

 

183,465

 

New Zealand

 

81,736

 

76,470

 

72,463

 

Overseas markets

 

34,256

 

29,392

 

28,402

 

less intragroup elimination

 

(12,046

)

(9,242

)

(9,706

)

 

 

315,444

 

294,312

 

274,624

 

% of total average assets attributable

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

to overseas activities

 

33.0

%

32.8

%

33.2

%

Average interest earning assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

198,740

 

172,407

 

161,030

 

New Zealand

 

74,706

 

70,313

 

66,504

 

Overseas markets

 

32,964

 

27,936

 

27,078

 

less intragroup elimination

 

(12,046

)

(9,242

)

(9,706

)

 

 

294,364

 

261,414

 

244,906

 

Total average liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

201,742

 

187,111

 

173,496

 

New Zealand

 

75,838

 

71,910

 

68,164

 

Overseas markets

 

31,776

 

25,457

 

24,484

 

less intragroup elimination

 

(12,046

)

(9,242

)

(9,706

)

 

 

297,310

 

275,236

 

256,438

 

Tota l av erage shareholders’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ordinary share capital

 

17,263

 

17,218

 

16,677

 

Preference share capital

 

871

 

1,858

 

1,509

 

 

 

18,134

 

19,076

 

18,186

 

Total average liabilities and shareholders’ equity

 

315,444

 

294,312

 

274,624

 

% of total average liabilities attributable to overseas activities

 

34.1

%

33.1

%

34.0

%

 

86




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

16.   Interest spreads and net interest average margins — statutory basis

Intragroup interest earning assets and interest bearing liabilities are treated as external assets and liabilities for the geographic segments.

 

Half
year
Mar 06
%

 

Half
year
Sep 05
%

 

Half
year
Mar 05
%

 

Gross earnings rate1

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

7.11

 

6.92

 

6.76

 

New Zealand

 

8.41

 

8.13

 

7.92

 

Overseas markets

 

5.30

 

4.56

 

3.93

 

Total Group

 

7.34

 

7.10

 

6.91

 

Interest spread and net interest average margin may be analysed as follows:

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Australia

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross interest spread

 

1.91

 

1.81

 

1.94

 

Interest not recognised on impaired assets

 

(0.00

)

(0.01

)

(0.01

)

Net interest spread

 

1.91

 

1.80

 

1.93

 

Interest attributable to net non-interest bearing items

 

0.40

 

0.45

 

0.40

 

Net interest average margin - Australia

 

2.31

 

2.25

 

2.33

 

New Zealand

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross interest spread

 

1.80

 

1.76

 

1.96

 

Interest not recognised on impaired assets

 

(0.02

)

(0.00

)

(0.01

)

Net interest spread

 

1.78

 

1.76

 

1.95

 

Interest attributable to net non-interest bearing items

 

0.54

 

0.53

 

0.48

 

Net interest average margin - New Zealand

 

2.32

 

2.29

 

2.43

 

Overseas markets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross interest spread

 

0.95

 

1.00

 

1.09

 

Interest not recognised on impaired assets

 

(0.02

)

(0.01

)

(0.04

)

Net interest spread

 

0.93

 

0.99

 

1.05

 

Interest attributable to net non-interest bearing items

 

0.36

 

0.49

 

0.47

 

Net interest average margin - Overseas markets

 

1.29

 

1.48

 

1.52

 

Group

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Gross interest spread

 

1.85

 

1.76

 

1.90

 

Interest not recognised on impaired assets

 

(0.01

)

(0.01

)

(0.01

)

Net interest spread

 

1.84

 

1.75

 

1.89

 

Interest attributable to net non-interest bearing items

 

0.45

 

0.51

 

0.47

 

Net interest average margin

 

2.29

 

2.26

 

2.36

 

 

1.                       Average interest rate received on interest earning assets

87




NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

17.   Segment analysis

The following analysis shows segment revenue, total assets and result for each business segment.

Industry

 

Half
year
Mar 06
$M

 

Half
year
Sep 05
$M

 

Half
year
Mar 05
$M

 

Movt
Mar 06
v. Sep 05
%

 

Movt
Mar 06
v. Mar 05
%

 

Income1,2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

4,371

 

4,153

 

3,794

 

5

%

15

%

Institutional

 

2,908

 

2,317

 

2,520

 

26

%

15

%

New Zealand Businesses

 

2,883

 

2,693

 

2,384

 

7

%

21

%

Corporate Australia

 

1,073

 

855

 

804

 

25

%

33

%

Esanda and UDC

 

637

 

645

 

616

 

-1

%

3

%

Asia Pacific

 

266

 

246

 

227

 

8

%

17

%

Non-continuing businesses

 

59

 

166

 

135

 

-64

%

-56

%

Group Centre3

 

2,634

 

2,065

 

1,317

 

28

%

100

%

Intragroup eliminations

 

(2,459

)

(1,980

)

(1,660

)

24

%

48

%

Income

 

12,372

 

11,160

 

10,137

 

11

%

22

%

Net profit after income tax2

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

542

 

485

 

468

 

12

%

16

%

Institutional

 

486

 

461

 

450

 

5

%

8

%

New Zealand Businesses

 

335

 

265

 

295

 

26

%

14

%

Corporate Australia

 

212

 

194

 

182

 

9

%

16

%

Esanda and UDC

 

53

 

55

 

66

 

-4

%

-20

%

Asia Pacific

 

46

 

44

 

39

 

5

%

18

%

Non-continuing businesses

 

30

 

63

 

63

 

-52

%

-52

%

Group Centre3

 

107

 

53

 

(8

)

Large

 

Large

 

Net profit

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

12

%

16

%

Total assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Personal Banking Australia

 

114,408

 

107,521

 

101,660

 

6

%

13

%

Institutional

 

82,002

 

69,843

 

63,840

 

17

%

28

%

New Zealand Businesses

 

60,672

 

59,962

 

55,907

 

1

%

9

%

Corporate Australia

 

24,071

 

22,902

 

21,768

 

5

%

11

%

Esanda and UDC

 

15,583

 

15,342

 

14,729

 

2

%

6

%

Asia Pacific

 

3,281

 

2,888

 

2,521

 

14

%

30

%

Non-continuing businesses

 

1,260

 

2,122

 

4,871

 

-41

%

-74

%

Group Centre3

 

18,086

 

17,524

 

17,488

 

3

%

3

%

Total assets

 

319,363

 

298,104

 

282,784

 

7

%

13

%

 

1.

 

Refer definitions on pages 124 to 125

2.

 

Equity standardised. Refer definitions on pages 124 to 125

3.

 

Group Centre includes Treasury, Operations, Technology and Shared Services and allocations required to report business units on a comparable basis

88




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

18.  Contingent liabilities and contingent assets

Contingent liabilities

§  General

There are outstanding court proceedings, claims and possible claims against the Group, the aggregate amount of which cannot readily be quantified.  Appropriate legal advice has been obtained and, in the light of such advice, provisions as deemed necessary have been made.  In some instances we have not disclosed the estimated financial impact as this may prejudice the interests of the Group.

§  Sale of Grindlays businesses

On 31 July 2000, ANZ completed the sale to Standard Chartered Bank (SCB) of ANZ Grindlays Bank Limited and the private banking business of ANZ in the United Kingdom and Jersey, together with ANZ Grindlays (Jersey) Holdings Limited and its subsidiaries, for USD1.3 billion in cash.  ANZ provided warranties and certain indemnities relating to those businesses and, where it is anticipated that payments would be likely under the warranties or indemnities, made provisions to cover the anticipated liability.  The issues below have not impacted our reported results.  All settlements and costs have been covered within the provisions established at the time.  ANZ may be held liable in relation to the following:

-           FERA

In 1991 certain amounts were transferred from non-convertible Indian Rupee accounts maintained with Grindlays in India.  These transactions may not have complied with the provisions of the Foreign Exchange Regulation Act, 1973.  Grindlays, on its own initiative, brought these transactions to the attention of the Reserve Bank of India.  The Indian authorities have served notices on Grindlays and certain of its officers in India that could lead to possible penalties.  Criminal prosecutions have also been foreshadowed and, in the case of two former officers and the bank, commenced.  Grindlays is contesting the validity of these prosecutions.

-           Differential Cheques

In June 2003, Grindlays was successful in its appeal against orders to repay, with interest, two payments it received from a stockbroker in 1991 in connection with securities transactions. These orders had directed repayment of Indian Rupees 24 million (plus interest accruing at 24% since 1991). Since the appeal decision was handed down, no further action has been taken against Grindlays in relation to notices in respect of a further eleven payments received by it in 1991 in similar circumstances totalling Indian Rupees 225 million.

In addition, ANZ provided an indemnity relating to tax liabilities of Grindlays (and its subsidiaries) and the Jersey Sub-Group to the extent to which such liabilities were not provided for in the Grindlays accounts as at 31 July 2000.  Claims have been made under this indemnity with no material impact on the Group expected.

§  Contingent tax liability

The Group in Australia was during 2005 subjected to client risk reviews by the Australian Taxation Office (ATO) across a broad spectrum of matters, as part of normal ATO procedures. The reviews mainly covered years up to 2003.  Matters listed by the ATO for further investigation remain outstanding.

The ATO is also reviewing the taxation treatment of certain other transactions undertaken by the Group in the course of normal business activities.

In addition, at the Company’s request the ATO is reviewing the taxation treatment of the sale of Grindlays in 2000. It is also reviewing the transfer of the life and funds management businesses into the joint venture with ING in 2002.

The Group in New Zealand is being audited by the Inland Revenue Department (IRD) as part of normal revenue authority procedures, with a particular focus on certain kinds of structured finance transactions.  The IRD has issued Notices of Proposed Adjustment (the ‘Notices’) in respect of some of those structured finance transactions.  The Notices are not tax assessments and do not establish a tax liability, but are the first step in a formal disputes process.  In addition, some tax assessments have been received.  Should the same position be adopted by the IRD on the remaining transactions of that kind as reflected in the Notices and tax assessments received, the maximum potential tax liability would be approximately NZD451 million (including interest tax effected) for the period to 31 March 2006.  Of that maximum potential liability, approximately NZD129 million is subject to tax indemnities provided by Lloyds TSB Bank PLC under the agreement by which ANZ acquired the National Bank of New Zealand and which relate to transactions undertaken by the National Bank of New Zealand before December 2003.

General or issue-specific audits and other investigations are being undertaken by revenue authorities in the United States, the United Kingdom and in other jurisdictions as part of normal revenue authority activity in those countries.

The Company has assessed these and other taxation claims arising in Australia, New Zealand and elsewhere, including seeking independent advice where appropriate, and believes that it holds appropriate provisions.

89




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

18.  Contingent liabilities and contingent assets, cont’d

§  Interbank Deposit Agreement

ANZ has entered into an Interbank Deposit Agreement with the major banks in the payments system. This agreement is a payment system support facility certified by the Australian Prudential Regulation Authority, where the terms are such that if any bank is experiencing liquidity problems, the other participants are required to deposit equal amounts of up to $2 billion for a period of 30 days. At the end of 30 days the deposit holder has the option to repay the deposit in cash or by way of assignment of mortgages to the value of the deposit.

§  Clearing and Settlement Obligations

In accordance with the clearing and settlement arrangements set out:

-              in the Australian Payments Clearing Association Limited (APCA) Regulations for the Australian Paper Clearing System, the Bulk Electronic Clearing System, the Consumer Electronic Clearing System and the High Value Clearing System (HVCS), the Company has a commitment to rules which could result in a bilateral exposure and loss in the event of a failure to settle by a member institution; and

-              in the Austraclear System Regulations and the CLS Bank International Rules, the Company has a commitment to participate in loss-sharing arrangements in the event of a failure to settle by a member institution.

For both the APCA HVCS and Austraclear, the obligation arises only in limited circumstances.

Contingent asset matters

§  National Housing Bank

In 1992, Grindlays received a claim aggregating to approximately Indian Rupees 5.06 billion from the National Housing Bank (NHB) in India.  The claim arose out of cheques drawn by NHB in favour of Grindlays, the proceeds of which were credited to the account of a Grindlays customer.

Grindlays won an arbitration award in March 1997, under which NHB paid Grindlays an award of Indian Rupees 9.12 billion.  NHB subsequently won an appeal to the Special Court of Mumbai, after which Grindlays filed an appeal with the Supreme Court of India.  Grindlays paid the disputed money including interest into court.  Ultimately, the parties settled the matter and agreed to share the moneys paid into court which by then totalled Indian Rupees 16.45 billion (AUD 661 million at 19 January 2002 exchange rates), with Grindlays receiving Indian Rupees 6.20 billion (AUD 248 million at 19 January 2002 exchange rates) of the disputed monies.  ANZ in turn received a payment of USD124 million (USD equivalent of the Indian Rupees received by Grindlays) from Standard Chartered Bank under the terms of an indemnity given in connection with the sale of Grindlays to Standard Chartered Bank.

ANZ Claims

ANZ has pursued two separate actions arising from the above.

-                A $130 million plus interest claim against its insurers. $130 million being the balance of the limit of indemnity under ANZ’s insurance arrangements for the 1991-92 policy year.

ANZ has settled the claim for $114.3 million which has been recognised in these accounts, less an amount of $0.9 million which was recognised in the accounts at 30 September 2005.

-                ANZ is entitled to share with NHB in the proceeds of any recovery from the estate of the customer whose account was credited with the cheques drawn by NHB.  However, the Indian Taxation Department is claiming a statutory priority to all of the funds available for distribution to creditors of that customer.  Proceedings are currently on foot in the Special Court, Mumbai to determine these issues.

90




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

19.  Note to the Cash Flow Statement

(a)          Reconciliation of profit after income tax to net cash provided by operating activities

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

 

 

Inflows

 

Inflows

 

Inflows

 

 

 

(Outflows)

 

(Outflows)

 

(Outflows)

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Reconciliation of profit after income tax to
net cash provided by operating activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Profit after income tax

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

Adjustments to reconcile to net cash
provided by operating activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

224

 

296

 

284

 

Depreciation and amortisation

 

145

 

244

 

240

 

Provision for restructuring and other provisions

 

78

 

261

 

295

 

Payments from provisions

 

(102

)

(218

)

(280

)

(Profit) loss on property disposals

 

3

 

5

 

17

 

(Increase) decrease in trading securities

 

881

 

(183

)

(638

)

(Increase) decrease in Liquid assets - greater than 3 months

 

(1,798

)

(358

)

(370

)

(Increase)decrease in Due from other banks-more than 90 days

 

806

 

(358

)

(13

)

(Increase) decrease in loans and advances

 

(16,502

)

(13,365

)

(15,423

)

(Increase) decrease in regulatory deposits

 

(47

)

(19

)

24

 

Decrease (increase) in interest receivable

 

(22

)

67

 

21

 

Increase (decrease) in deposits and other borrowings

 

8,729

 

5,802

 

14,054

 

Increase (decrease) in due to other financial insititutions

 

1,159

 

2,080

 

2,892

 

Increase (decrease) in payables and other liabilities

 

119

 

(652

)

(687

)

(Decrease) increase in interest payable

 

110

 

202

 

12

 

(Increase) decrease in net tax assets

 

121

 

38

 

124

 

Other

 

(196

)

(162

)

(770

)

Net cash provided by operating activities

 

(4,481

)

(4,700

)

1,337

 

 

(b)          Reconciliation of cash and cash equivalents

Cash at the end of the period is as follows

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liquid assets - less than 3 months

 

9,943

 

9,600

 

7,180

 

Due from other financial institutions - less than 3 months

 

6,902

 

4,102

 

4,516

 

 

 

16,845

 

13,702

 

11,696

 

Non-cash financing and investment activities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Share capital issues

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Dividend reinvestment plan

 

85

 

75

 

78

 

 

91




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

20.   Changes in composition of the Group

Newly controlled entities

The following securitisation special purpose entities were consolidated as part of the Group from 1 October 2004 because of the application of new AASB UIG Interpretation 112: ‘Consolidation - Special Purpose Entities’.  The entities were not included in the previous year’s financial statements because AASB UIG 112 became operative on 1 October 2005.

§  Arc Funding Pty Ltd

§    Kingfisher Trust No. 2

§    Omeros II Trust

§  Aurora Securitisation

§    Kingfisher Trust 2001-1G

§    Orion Funding Pty Ltd

§  Echo Funding Pty Ltd

§    Kingfisher Trust 2004-1G

§    Solera Trust

§  Eos Trust

§    Kingfisher Securitisation Pty Ltd

§    Stellar Funding Pty Ltd

§  Kingfisher Trust No. 1

§    Omeros Trust

§    Coral Finance Ltd

 

The impact of the consolidation of these entities is explained in Note 24.

Disposal of controlled entities

There were no material controlled entities disposed of during the half year to 31 March 2006.  On 30 September 2005, the controlled entities NBNZ Life Insurance Limited and NBNZ Investment Services Limited were sold.  The profit before tax on disposal was $14 million ($14 million after tax).  The after tax contribution prior to disposal was $9 million in the September 2005 half (Mar 2005 half: $9 million).

21.   Associates, joint venture entities and investments

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Aggregate associates and joint venture entities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Operating profit

 

90

 

93

 

108

 

Profit after income tax

 

90

 

93

 

108

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Material contributions to profit

 

Contribution to
Group pre-tax profit

 

 

 

Ownership interest
held by Group

 

 

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

As at

 

As at

 

 

 

 

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

As at

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

%

 

%

 

Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Associates

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

PT Panin Indonesia Bank

 

12

 

16

 

21

 

29

 

29

 

29

 

E*Trade

 

3

 

3

 

3

 

34

 

34

 

35

 

Joint ventures

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

ING Australia Limited

 

57

 

69

 

80

 

49

 

49

 

49

 

ING (NZ) Holdings Limited1

 

11

 

-

 

-

 

49

 

49

 

n/a

 

 

1.         A joint venture entity from 30 September 2005.

 

92




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

22.   Exchange rates

Major exchange rates used in translation of results of offshore controlled entities and branches into the Group accounts for each reporting period were as follows:

 

 

Balance Sheet

 

 

 

Profit and Loss Average

 

 

 

As at

 

As at

 

As at

 

Half

 

Half

 

Half

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

year

 

year

 

year

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mar 06

 

Sep 05

 

Mar 05

 

Euro

 

0.5890

 

0.6325

 

0.5970

 

0.6202

 

0.6164

 

0.5883

 

Great British pound

 

0.4104

 

0.4325

 

0.4107

 

0.4237

 

0.4199

 

0.4085

 

New Zealand dollar

 

1.1700

 

1.0998

 

1.0899

 

1.0921

 

1.0862

 

1.0832

 

United States dollar

 

0.7162

 

0.7623

 

0.7719

 

0.7418

 

0.7643

 

0.7671

 

 

23.   Significant events since balance date

On 1 September 2006, the Group announced that it had agreed to sell Esanda FleetPartners to Nikko Principal Investments, the Australian private equity arm of Nikko Cordial Corporation.

The sale price of $379 million represents a premium of $234 million to the estimated net assets of $145 million.   The sale is subject to regulatory approval and is expected to be completed by the end of October 2006.

93




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

24.   Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS)

The Group implemented accounting policies in accordance with Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS) on 1 October 2004, except for those relating to financial instruments and insurance contracts, which were implemented on 1 October 2005.

The transition was accounted for in accordance with Accounting Standard AASB 1: ‘First time adoption of Australian equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards’.

The impacts set out below are separated between those applicable from 1 October 2004 (and impacting the comparative periods) and those applicable from 1 October 2005.  All amounts are stated on a before tax basis, unless otherwise noted.  The reconciliation tables set out in pages 99 to 108 reconcile previous AGAAP to AIFRS and cross reference to the notes below.

AIFRS adjustments with effect from 1 October 2004

(i)

Goodwill

 

 

 Initial reduction in retained earnings.   Potential volatility in future earnings.

The adoption of AIFRS reduced the carrying amount of goodwill on transition by $5 million at 1 October 2004 (refer Table 1) and $15 million at 1 October 2005 (refer Table 6) related to the acquisition of assets and liabilities that did not meet the AIFRS definition of a business combination.  The Group elected not to restate the classification and accounting treatment of past business combinations that occurred prior to 1 October 2004.

Under AIFRS, the past practice of systematically amortising goodwill over the expected period of benefit ceased and was replaced by impairment testing annually or more frequently if events or circumstances indicate that goodwill might be impaired.

This change in accounting policy resulted in:

§            a decrease in the amortisation expense of $224 million for the year to 30 September 2005 (31 March 2005: $110 million), including notional INGA and associates’ goodwill of $45 million (31 March 2005: $23 million) (refer Tables 2 and 3); and

§            a corresponding increase in the carrying value of goodwill, associates and joint venture entities (refer Tables 4
and 5).

(ii)

Defined benefit superannuation schemes

 

 Initial reduction in retained earnings.   Actuarial movements recognised in retained earnings.

On adoption of AASB 119: ‘Employee Benefits’, surpluses (assets) and/or deficits (liabilities) that arise within defined benefit superannuation schemes are recognised on the Balance Sheet.

Under previous AGAAP, the Group accounted for the defined benefit superannuation schemes on a cash basis and did not recognise an asset or liability for the net position of the defined benefit superannuation schemes.

The Group elected to apply the option available under AASB 119 to recognise actuarial gains and losses in the Balance Sheet (i.e. the ‘direct to retained earnings’ approach).  The non-cash expense reflecting the notional cost of the benefits accruing to members of the defined benefit schemes in respect of service provided over the reporting period is charged to the Income Statement.  All transitional adjustments were, and ongoing movements reported for each scheme are, actuarially determined in accordance with AASB 119.  Contributions to the schemes are made in accordance with the governing rules of the relevant schemes and there is no present liability to fund any deficits.

At 1 October 2004, the Group recognised a liability position of $200 million, an asset of $2 million, and a deferred tax asset of $57 million, resulting in a $141 million decrease in retained earnings (refer Table 1).

For the AIFRS comparative year ended 30 September 2005, the Group recognised a decrease in the liability of $34 million (31 March 2005: $10 million) and an increase in the asset of $6 million (31 March 2005: $2 million) largely representing an actuarial gain and a deferred tax adjustment of $16 million (31 March 2005: $4 million).  The actuarial gain of $25 million after tax (31 March 2005: $7 million after tax) was adjusted against retained earnings (refer Tables 4 and 5).

(iii)

Share based payments

 

 Initial reduction in shareholders’ equity.   Higher ongoing expenses.

Under previous AGAAP, the Group recognised an expense equal to the full fair value of all deferred shares issued as part of the short term and long term incentive arrangements.  The deferred shares vest over one to three years and may be forfeited under certain conditions.  The Group did not recognise an expense for options issued to staff or for shares issued under the $1,000 employee share plan.  On adoption of AASB 2: ‘Share-based Payment’, the Group recognised an expense for all share based remuneration, including deferred shares and options, and recognises this expense over the relevant vesting period.

The Group elected to retrospectively apply AASB 2 to share based payments granted prior to 7 November 2002.

94




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

24.   Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

AIFRS adjustments with effect from 1 October 2004, cont’d

(iii)

Share based payments, cont’d.

On 1 October 2004, this change in accounting policy resulted in:

§            the establishment of a share options reserve of $44 million to reflect the fair value of options granted to employees;

§            a reduction in paid up capital of $64 million representing the fair value of unvested shares;

§            recognition of a deferred tax liability of $24 million; and

§            a net decrease to retained earnings of $4 million after tax

(refer Table 1).

For the AIFRS comparative year ended 30 September 2005, the impact of the change was:

§            an increase in the share options reserve of $23 million (31 March 2005: $12 million);

§            an increase in paid up capital of $41 million (31 March 2005: $16 million);

§            an accrual for $1,000 shares of $16 million (31 March 2005: $11 million);

§            a reduction in deferred tax of $17 million (31 March 2005: $7 million); and

§            a decrease in profit after tax of $63 million (31 March 2005: $32 million)

(refer Tables 4 and 5).

(iv)

Securitisation

 

 Additional assets/liabilities recognised.   Immaterial impact on net profit.

 

AIFRS has introduced new requirements for the recognition of financial assets, including those transferred to a special purpose entity for securitisation.  The accounting treatment of existing securitisations has been reassessed.  Consequently, some vehicles, which were previously not consolidated, are being consolidated by the Group.  This resulted in an increase in assets and liabilities recorded within the Balance Sheet of $5 billion as at 1 October 2004 for the Group (refer Table 1).  For the comparative AIFRS year ended 30 September 2005, the Group recognised a decrease of $388 million in both assets and liabilities (31 March 2005: $268 million in assets and $269 million in liabilities), reflecting the net impact of repayment and securitisation of new assets during the year (refer Tables 4 and 5).

The impact on the Income Statement is that income and expenses increased to recognise the income and expense items recorded within these vehicles, with the overall impact on net profit being immaterial.

(v)

Foreign currency translation reserve

 

 Initial increase in retained earnings, no change to shareholders’ equity.

 

The Group has elected to apply the option under AASB 121: ‘The Effects of Changes in Foreign Exchange Rates’, to reset amounts recorded within the foreign currency translation reserve to zero.  On 1 October 2004, adopting this election resulted in an increase in retained earnings of $218 million (refer Table 1).

(vi)

Asset revaluation reserve — balance relating to land and buildings

 

 Initial increase in retained earnings, no change to shareholders’ equity.

 

The Group has elected to apply the option under AASB 1: ‘First time Adoption of Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards’, to recognise the value of Land and Buildings at deemed cost.  As a result, the Group’s asset revaluation reserve of $31 million relating to Land and Buildings was reset to zero as at 1 October 2004 and adjusted against retained earnings (refer Table 1).

(vii)

Taxation

 

 Change in methodology.  Immaterial impacts.

 

Under AASB 112: ‘Income Taxes’, a balance sheet method of tax effect accounting has been adopted, replacing the ‘Income Statement’ approach previously used by the Group.

Income tax expense comprises current and deferred taxes, with income tax expense recognised in the Income Statement, or recognised in equity to the extent that it relates to items recognised directly in equity.

Deferred tax is calculated using the balance sheet method by determining temporary differences between the carrying amount of assets and liabilities for financial reporting purposes and the tax base of those assets and liabilities as used for taxation purposes.

At 1 October 2004, a reduction to deferred tax liabilities of $18 million was recognised with a corresponding increase of $16 million after tax to retained earnings and an increase to Share Capital of $2 million representing share issue costs previously offset against Share Capital (refer Table 1).

95




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

24.   Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

AIFRS adjustments with effect from 1 October 2004, cont’d

(viii)

Software reclassification

 

 Reclassification only.

 

On transition to AIFRS, capitalised software assets were reclassified from Premises and Equipment to a separately identifiable intangible asset.  This resulted in a reclassification of $435 million as at 1 October 2004 (refer Table 1).  The amount reclassified decreased by $29 million and $48 million as at 31 March 2005 and 30 September 2005 respectively (refer Tables 4 and 5).

(ix)

Derivatives reclassification

 

 Reclassification only.

 

At 1 October 2004, there was a reclassification of $4.5 billion from Other Assets and $5.7 billion from Payables and Other Liabilities, to the new AIFRS Balance Sheet line items of Derivative Financial Assets and Derivative Financial Liabilities respectively (refer Table 1).

The amount reclassified from Other Assets decreased by $706 million at 30 September 2005 (31 March 2005: $434 million), and the amount reclassified from Other Liabilities decreased by $1.43 billion at 30 September 2005 (31 March 2005: $669 million) (refer Tables 4 and 5).

(x)

Other

The comparative AIFRS year ended 30 September 2005 and half year ended 31 March 2005 income statements contains minor leasing and tax remeasurement adjustments together with the impact of securitisation and defined benefit plan adjustments (refer Tables 2 and 3).

The balance sheets, as reflected in Tables 1, 4 and 5 also contain other minor remeasurements.

 

96




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

24.                     Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

AIFRS adjustments with effect from 1 October 2005

 

(a)

 

Credit loss provisioning

 

 

Initial increase in retained earnings. Volatility in future earnings.

AASB 139: ‘Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement’ adopts an incurred loss approach for credit loss provisioning and provides guidance on the measurement of incurred losses.  Provisions are raised for losses that have already been incurred for exposures that are known to be impaired.  The estimated losses on these impaired exposures are then discounted to their present value using the original effective interest rate.  As this discount unwinds during the period between recognition of impairment and recovery of the written down amount, it is recognised in the Income Statement as interest income.

The General Provision in the Balance Sheet was replaced on adoption of AIFRS by a Collective Provision.

Exposures not individually known to be impaired are placed into pools of similar assets with similar risk characteristics to be collectively assessed for losses that have been incurred, but not identified yet.  The required provision is estimated on the basis of historical loss experience for assets with credit risk characteristics similar to those in the collective pool.  The historical loss experience is adjusted based on current observable data.

The Collective Provision under AIFRS shares the same underlying measurement objectives as the previous AGAAP General Provision.  However, as a result of the application of a new estimation methodology, certain judgemental risk measures have changed.

The Group believes that the resulting Collective Provision, while lower than the previous General Provision, comfortably falls within the probable range of losses that have been incurred but not identified in our portfolio.

On adoption of AIFRS, the previous Economic Loss Provisioning (ELP) charge to profit was replaced by a charge for individual provisions on impaired exposures together with a charge for movements in the Collective Provision.

As a result of these changes:

               at 1 October 2005, there was an increase of $1 million to retained earnings relating to individual provisions on impaired exposures as a result of the net impact of including expected interest cash flows in the calculation of the individual provision and discounting estimated future cash flows;

               at 1 October 2005, the Collective Provision was $288 million less than the AGAAP General Provision.  After tax, this resulted in an increase to retained earnings of $207 million and a decrease in the foreign currency translation reserve of $23 million at 1 October 2005;

             individual provisions and movements in the Collective Provision are charged direct to the Income Statement, driving increased earnings volatility; and

             movements in the Collective Provision are driven by changes in portfolio size, portfolio mix, credit risk and economic cycles.

(b)

 

Fee revenue - financial service fees recognised as an adjustment to yield

 

 

Initial reduction in retained earnings

                                    Under AASB 139: ‘Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement’, fee income (such as loan approval fees) integral to the yield of an originated financial instrument (such as loans and advances measured at amortised cost), net of any direct incremental costs, are capitalised and deferred over the expected life of the financial instrument.

                                    On 1 October 2005, certain fees that have previously been recognised in the Income Statement, were deferred and recognised against net loans and advances in the Balance Sheet with a corresponding reduction to retained earnings of $276 million after tax.  The annual impact on net profit from this change is not material.  However, there was an increase in interest income (offset by a reduction in fee income) and a reclassification to interest earning assets of customers’ liabilities for acceptances of $13.4 billion.

 

(c)

 

Derivative financial instruments, including hedging

 

 

Initial reduction in retained earnings.  Volatility in future earnings.  New assets and liabilities recognised.

At 1 October 2005, recognition of the fair value of derivatives relating to securitisation vehicles and structured finance transactions reduced retained earnings by $78 million.  The Group continues to evaluate hedging relationships and effectiveness for certain structured finance transactions, which introduces volatility within the Income Statement.

AIFRS permits hedge accounting (if certain criteria are met) for fair value hedges, cash flow hedges and hedges of investments in foreign operations.  Fair value and cash flow hedge accounting can only be considered where prospective and retrospective effectiveness tests are met and the hedge relationship has been adequately documented.  Ineffectiveness precludes the use of hedge accounting.

 

 

 

 

97




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

24.   Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

AIFRS adjustments with effect from 1 October 2005, cont’d

(c)

 

Derivative financial instruments, including hedging, cont’d

 

At 1 October 2005, the Group designated certain fair value and cash flow hedges and financial liabilities as fair value through other income in the profit and loss, resulting in an increase in net assets of $86 million represented by a decrease in retained earnings of $75 million, and an increase in reserves of $161 million.

(d)

 

Financial instruments classification and measurement

 

 

Certain assets reclassified and measured at fair value.  Initial decrease in retained earnings.

 

Under AIFRS, certain financial assets of the Group previously carried at amortised cost were either:

               reclassified as available-for-sale assets, resulting in measurement at fair value with movements being taken to an available-for-sale equity reserve (1 October 2005: $17 million); or

               reclassified as financial assets held at fair value through the profit and loss, with movements in fair value through other income in the profit and loss resulting in a decrease in retained earnings (1 October 2005: $3 million).

All derivative financial instruments, including those used as hedging instruments, are measured at fair value and recognised in the Balance Sheet.  This requires an adjustment to reflect the market value of counterparty risk in the fair value of derivatives, which resulted in a decrease in retained earnings of $29 million at 1 October 2005.  (Under AGAAP, counterparty risk was notionally allowed for as part of the General Provision.)

Financial instruments are measured under AIFRS at ‘bid’ or ‘offer’ prices rather than the previous AGAAP use of ‘mid’ prices.  On 1 October 2005, this change in measurement resulted in a decrease to retained earnings of $5 million.

(e)

 

Classification of hybrid financial instruments

 

 

Reclassification of ANZ StEPS from equity to debt.

Under AASB 132: ‘Financial Instruments: Presentation’, ANZ StEPS, a hybrid Tier 1 instrument treated as equity under previous AGAAP, was reclassified as debt. Prepaid issue costs, offset against the preference share capital balance under previous AGAAP, were capitalised and amortised to interest over a 5 year period from the date of issue.

At 1 October 2005, loan Capital increased to $1 billion representing the transfer of $987 million from Preference Share Capital to Loan Capital, capitalised prepaid issue costs of $11 million, deferred tax liability of $4 million and a decrease in retained earnings after tax of $6 million representing amortisation of prepaid issue costs. Ongoing distributions to the holders of ANZ StEPS will be treated as an interest expense in the Income Statement rather than as dividends under previous AGAAP.

 

(f)

 

Accounting for INGA

 

 

Initial reduction in retained earnings and increase in notional goodwill..

                                   

Under AASB 131: ‘Interests in Joint Ventures’, and in line with previous AGAAP, the Group is required to equity account for its interest in INGA.  The adoption of AIFRS by INGA resulted in the following significant measurement and recognition differences to previous AGAAP:

             reclassification and measurement of shareholder investments as available-for-sale assets.  This change in measurement results in a reduction in investment return volatility experienced by INGA, as only realised gains and losses are reported in its net profit;

             increased policy liabilities resulting from a change in the discount rates applied in the actuarial calculation of policy liabilities and the separate presentation and change in basis of deferred acquisition costs (largely commissions) previously included within net policy liabilities (total impact is a decrease to retained earnings of $107 million);

             initial entry fee income previously taken upfront is deferred and amortised to income over time (total impact is a decrease to retained earnings of $23 million); and

             other sundry items (total impact is a decrease to retained earnings of $16 million)

Under AIFRS, the excess of the market value over net assets (EMVONA) for INGA’s life insurance controlled entities is no longer recognised.  Accordingly, an adjustment for this amount has been made to notional goodwill of $72 million.

The Group’s 49% share of INGA’s net AIFRS adjustment is a decrease of $146 million to retained earnings and an increase of $8 million to the available-for-sale reserve, resulting in a reduction in the carrying value of the Group’s interest in INGA of $138 million as at 1 October 2005.

 

 

Explanation of material AIFRS adjustments to the AGAAP cash flow statement for 31 March 2005 and 30 September 2005

Various assets and liabilities (principally loans and advances and deposits and other borrowings) which were classified as investing or financing cash flows, are now reclassified as operating cash flows under AIFRS.  The Group’s net cash position has not changed.  There are no other material differences between the cash flow statement presented under AIFRS and that presented under previous AGAAP.

 

98




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

24.   Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

Reconciliation tables

References are to the notes on pages  94 to 98.

Table 1: Balance sheet as at 1 October 2004

 

 

 

Defined Benefit

 

Share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Superannuation

 

Based

 

Securitisation

 

 

 

AGAAP 1

 

Schemes

 

Payments

 

Vehicles

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(note

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(note (ii))

 

(iii))

 

(note (iv))

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liquid assets

 

6,363

 

-

 

-

 

2

 

Due from other financial institutions

 

4,781

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Trading securities

 

5,478

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(8

)

Investment securities

 

7,746

 

-

 

-

 

2,797

 

Net loans and advances

 

204,962

 

-

 

-

 

2,144

 

Customer’s liability for acceptances

 

12,466

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Regulatory deposits

 

176

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Shares in associates and joint venture entities

 

1,960

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Deferred tax assets

 

1,454

 

57

 

-

 

2

 

Goodwill and other intangible assets

 

3,269

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Other assets

 

9,158

 

2

 

-

 

89

 

Premises and equipment

 

1,532

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Total assets

 

259,345

 

59

 

-

 

5,026

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due to other financial institutions

 

7,349

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

168,557

 

-

 

-

 

5,037

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(2

)

Liability for acceptances

 

12,466

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Income tax liabilities

 

1,914

 

-

 

24

 

-

 

Payables and other liabilities

 

14,212

 

200

 

-

 

(6

)

Provisions

 

845

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Bonds and notes

 

27,602

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Loan capital

 

8,475

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Total liabilities

 

241,420

 

200

 

24

 

5,029

 

Net assets

 

17,925

 

(141

)

(24

)

(3

)

Shareholders’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ordinary share capital

 

8,005

 

-

 

(64

)

-

 

Preference share capital

 

987

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Reserves

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

— Foreign currency translation reserve

 

218

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

— Asset revaluation reserve

 

31

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

— Share options reserve

 

-

 

-

 

44

 

-

 

— Other reserves

 

330

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Total reserves

 

579

 

-

 

44

 

-

 

Retained profits

 

8,336

 

(141

)

(4

)

(3

)

Share capital and reserves attributable

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

to shareholders of the Company

 

17,907

 

(141

)

(24

)

(3

)

Minority interest

 

18

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Total shareholders’ equity

 

17,925

 

(141

)

(24

)

(3

)

1.         Reported financial position as at 30 September 2004

2.         Other includes $39 million relating to the reclassification of legacy foreign currency translation and asset revaluation balances at 1 October 2004

 

99




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

24.   Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

Effect of transition to AIFRS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Software

 

Derivatives

 

 

 

Total AIFRS

 

 

 

Resetting

 

Taxation

 

Reclassification

 

Reclassification

 

Other 2

 

Adjustments

 

AIFRS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(notes (v)

 

(note

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

& (vi))

 

(vii))

 

(note (viii))

 

(note (ix))

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

2

 

6,365

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

4,781

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

5,478

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

4,456

 

-

 

4,448

 

4,448

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

2,797

 

10,543

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

2,144

 

207,106

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

12,466

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

176

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

9

 

9

 

1,969

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

1

 

60

 

1,514

 

-

 

-

 

435

 

-

 

(5

)

430

 

3,699

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(4,456

)

-

 

(4,365

)

4,793

 

-

 

-

 

(435

)

-

 

-

 

(435

)

1,097

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

5

 

5,090

 

264,435

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

7,349

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

5,037

 

173,594

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

5,656

 

-

 

5,654

 

5,654

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

12,466

 

-

 

(18

)

-

 

-

 

1

 

7

 

1,921

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(5,656

)

50

 

(5,412

)

8,800

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

845

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

27,602

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

8,475

 

-

 

(18

)

-

 

-

 

51

 

5,286

 

246,706

 

-

 

18

 

-

 

-

 

(46

)

(196

)

17,729

 

-

 

2

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(62

)

7,943

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

987

 

(218

)

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(218

)

-

 

(31

)

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(31

)

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

44

 

44

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

330

 

(249

)

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

205

 

374

 

249

 

16

 

-

 

-

 

(46

)

71

 

8,407

 

-

 

18

 

-

 

-

 

(46

)

(196

)

17,711

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

18

 

-

 

18

 

-

 

-

 

(46

)

(196

)

17,729

 

 

100




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

 

24.   Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

Table 2: Income statement for the half year ended 31 March 2005

 

 

 

 

Effect of transition to AIFRS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Goodwill

 

Based

 

 

 

Total AIFRS

 

 

 

Reference

 

AGAAP1

 

Amortisation

 

Payments

 

Other2

 

Adjustments

 

AIFRS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(note (i))

 

(note (iii))

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Total income

 

9,981

 

23

 

-

 

133

 

156

 

10,137

 

Interest income

 

8,277

 

-

 

-

 

143

 

143

 

8,420

 

Interest expense

 

(5,424

)

-

 

-

 

(131

)

(131

)

(5,555

)

Net interest income

 

2,853

 

-

 

-

 

12

 

12

 

2,865

 

Profit from disposal of investments

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

-

 

 

 

Other operating income

 

1,704

 

23

 

-

 

(10

)

13

 

1,717

 

Operating income

 

4,557

 

23

 

-

 

2

 

25

 

4,582

 

Operating expenses

 

(2,200

)

87

 

(39

)

-

 

48

 

(2,152

)

Profit before doubtful debts and income tax

 

2,357

 

110

 

(39

)

2

 

73

 

2,430

 

Provision for doubtful debts

 

(284

)

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(284

)

Profit before income tax

 

2,073

 

110

 

(39

)

2

 

73

 

2,146

 

Income tax expense

 

(597

)

-

 

7

 

-

 

7

 

(590

)

Profit after income tax

 

1,476

 

110

 

(32

)

2

 

80

 

1,556

 

Net profit attributable to minority interest

 

(1

)

-

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

(1

)

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

1,475

 

110

 

(32

)

2

 

80

 

1,555

 

1.          Reported performance for the period ended 31 March 2005

2.          Mainly relates to the impact of additional securitisation vehicles brought onto balance sheet

101




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

24.                               Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

Table 3:  Income statement for the year ended 30 September 2005

 

 

 

 

 

Effect of transition to AIFRS

 

 

 

 

 

AGAAP1

 

Goodwill
Amortisation

 

Share Based
Payments

 

Other2

 

Total AIFRS
Adjustments

 

AIFRS

 

Reference

 

 

 

(note (i))

 

(note (iii))

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Total income

 

20,979

 

45

 

 

273

 

318

 

21,297

 

Interest income

 

17,427

 

 

 

292

 

292

 

17,719

 

Interest expense

 

(11,629

)

 

 

(272

)

(272

)

(11,901

)

Net interest income

 

5,798

 

 

 

20

 

20

 

5,818

 

Other operating income

 

3,552

 

45

 

 

(19

)

26

 

3,578

 

Operating income

 

9,350

 

45

 

 

1

 

46

 

9,396

 

Operating expenses

 

(4,515

)

179

 

(80

)

(2

)

97

 

(4,418

)

Profit before doubtful debts and income tax

 

4,835

 

224

 

(80

)

(1

)

143

 

4,978

 

Provision for doubtful debts

 

(580

)

 

 

 

 

(580

)

Profit before income tax

 

4,255

 

224

 

(80

)

(1

)

143

 

4,398

 

Income tax expense

 

(1,234

)

 

17

 

(3

)

14

 

(1,220

)

Profit after income tax

 

3,021

 

224

 

(63

)

(4

)

157

 

3,178

 

Net profit attributable to minority interest

 

(3

)

 

 

 

 

(3

)

Net profit attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

3,018

 

224

 

(63

)

(4

)

157

 

3,175

 



1.                     Reported performance for the year ended 30 September 2005

2.                    Mainly relates to the impact of additional securitisation vehicles brought onto balance sheet

102




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

24.                               Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

Table 4:  Balance sheet as at 31 March 2005

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

AGAAP1

 

1 October
2004 AIFRS
Adjustments

 

Goodwill

 

Defined
Benefit
Superannuation
Schemes

 

Reference

 

 

 

(from Table 1)

 

(note (i))

 

(note (ii))

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liquid assets

 

8,855

 

2

 

 

 

Due from other financial institutions

 

6,428

 

 

 

 

Trading securities

 

6,108

 

 

 

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

 

4,448

 

 

 

Investment securities

 

6,745

 

2,797

 

 

 

Net loans and advances

 

218,558

 

2,144

 

 

 

Customer’s liability for acceptances

 

12,922

 

 

 

 

Regulatory deposits

 

143

 

 

 

 

Shares in associates and joint venture entities

 

1,764

 

9

 

23

 

 

Deferred tax assets

 

1,234

 

60

 

 

(3

)

Goodwill and other intangible assets

 

3,118

 

430

 

87

 

 

Other assets

 

10,493

 

(4,365

)

 

2

 

Premises and equipment

 

1,481

 

(435

)

 

 

Total assets

 

277,849

 

5,090

 

110

 

(1

)

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due to other financial institutions

 

10,056

 

 

 

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

180,410

 

5,037

 

 

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

 

5,654

 

 

 

Liability for acceptances

 

12,922

 

 

 

 

Income tax liabilities

 

1,715

 

7

 

 

1

 

Payables and other liabilities

 

12,431

 

(5,412

)

 

(10

)

Provisions

 

865

 

 

 

 

Bonds and notes

 

32,321

 

 

 

 

Loan capital

 

8,121

 

 

 

 

Total liabilities

 

258,841

 

5,286

 

 

(9

)

Net assets

 

19,008

 

(196

)

110

 

8

 

Shareholders’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ordinary share capital

 

8,028

 

(62

)

 

 

Preference share capital

 

1,858

 

 

 

 

Reserves

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 - Foreign currency translation reserve

 

(66

)

(218

)

 

 

 - Asset revaluation reserve

 

31

 

(31

)

 

 

 - Share options reserve

 

 

44

 

 

 

 - Other reserves

 

330

 

 

 

 

Total reserves

 

295

 

(205

)

 

 

Retained profits

 

8,809

 

71

 

110

 

1

 

 - Actuarial gain/loss on defined benefit plans

 

 

 

 

7

 

Total retained profits

 

8,809

 

71

 

110

 

8

 

Share capital and reserves attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

18,990

 

(196

)

110

 

8

 

Minority interest

 

18

 

 

 

 

Total shareholders’ equity

 

19,008

 

(196

)

110

 

8

 

 


1.                     Reported financial position for the period ended 31 March 2005

103




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (continued)

24.          Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

Effect of transition to AIFRS

 

 

 

Share Based
Payments

 

Securitisation
Vehicles

 

Software
Reclassification

 

Derivatives
Reclassification

 

Other

 

Total AIFRS
Adjustments

 

AIFRS

 

(note (iii))

 

(note (iv))

 

(note (viii))

 

(note (ix))

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(1

)

 

 

 

1

 

8,856

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

6,428

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

6,108

 

 

(12

)

 

(434

)

 

4,002

 

4,002

 

 

44

 

 

 

 

2,841

 

9,586

 

 

(308

)

 

 

 

1,836

 

220,394

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

12,922

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

143

 

 

 

 

 

 

32

 

1,796

 

2

 

(10

)

 

 

 

49

 

1,283

 

 

 

(29

)

 

2

 

490

 

3,608

 

 

19

 

 

434

 

 

(3,910

)

6,583

 

 

 

29

 

 

 

(406

)

1,075

 

2

 

(268

)

 

 

2

 

4,935

 

282,784

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

10,056

 

 

(270

)

 

 

 

4,767

 

185,177

 

 

2

 

 

(669

)

 

4,987

 

4,987

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

12,922

 

(5

)

(13

)

 

 

 

(10

)

1,705

 

11

 

12

 

 

669

 

2

 

(4,728

)

7,703

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

865

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

32,321

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

8,121

 

6

 

(269

)

 

 

2

 

5,016

 

263,857

 

(4

)

1

 

 

 

 

(81

)

18,927

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

16

 

 

 

 

 

(46

)

7,982

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,858

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(218

)

(284

)

 

 

 

 

 

(31

)

 

12

 

 

 

 

 

56

 

56

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

330

 

12

 

 

 

 

 

(193

)

102

 

(32

)

1

 

 

 

 

151

 

8,960

 

 

 

 

 

 

7

 

7

 

(32

)

1

 

 

 

 

158

 

8,967

 

(4

)

1

 

 

 

 

(81

)

18,909

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

18

 

(4

)

1

 

 

 

 

(81

)

18,927

 

 

104




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

24.          Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

Table 5:        Balance sheet as at 30 September 2005

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

AGAAP1

 

1 October
2004 AIFRS
Adjustments

 

Goodwill

 

Defined Benefit
Superannuation
Schemes

 

Reference

 

 

 

(from Table 1)

 

(note (i))

 

(note (ii))

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liquid assets

 

11,600

 

2

 

 

 

Due from other financial institutions

 

6,348

 

 

 

 

Trading securities

 

6,285

 

 

 

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

 

4,448

 

 

 

Investment securities

 

6,941

 

2,797

 

 

 

Net loans and advances

 

230,952

 

2,144

 

 

 

Customer’s liability for acceptances

 

13,449

 

 

 

 

Regulatory deposits

 

159

 

 

 

 

Shares in associates and joint venture entities

 

1,872

 

9

 

45

 

 

Deferred tax assets

 

1,337

 

60

 

 

(13

)

Goodwill and other intangible assets

 

2,898

 

430

 

179

 

 

Other assets

 

9,903

 

(4,365

)

 

6

 

Premises and equipment

 

1,441

 

(435

)

 

 

Total assets

 

293,185

 

5,090

 

224

 

(7

)

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due to other financial institutions

 

12,027

 

 

 

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

185,693

 

5,037

 

 

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

 

5,654

 

 

 

Liability for acceptances

 

13,449

 

 

 

 

Income tax liabilities

 

1,797

 

7

 

 

3

 

Payables and other liabilities

 

11,607

 

(5,412

)

 

(34

)

Provisions

 

914

 

 

 

 

Bonds and notes

 

39,073

 

 

 

 

Loan capital

 

9,137

 

 

 

 

Total liabilities

 

273,697

 

5,286

 

 

(31

)

Net assets

 

19,488

 

(196

)

224

 

24

 

Shareholders’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ordinary share capital

 

8,074

 

(62

)

 

 

Preference share capital

 

1,858

 

 

 

 

Reserves

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

- Foreign currency translation reserve

 

(225

)

(218

)

 

 

- Asset revaluation reserve

 

31

 

(31

)

 

 

- Share options reserve

 

 

44

 

 

 

- Other reserves

 

330

 

 

 

 

Total reserves

 

136

 

(205

)

 

 

Retained profits

 

9,393

 

71

 

224

 

(1

)

- Actuarial gain /loss on defined benefit plans

 

 

 

 

25

 

Total retained profits

 

9,393

 

71

 

224

 

24

 

Share capital and reserves attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

19,461

 

(196

)

224

 

24

 

Minority interest

 

27

 

 

 

 

Total shareholders’ equity

 

19,488

 

(196

)

224

 

24

 


1.    Reported financial position for the financial year ended 30 September 2005

 

105




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

24.  Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

Effect of transition to AIFRS

 

 

 

Share

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Based

 

Securitisation

 

Software

 

Derivatives

 

 

 

Total AIFRS

 

 

 

Payments

 

Vehicles

 

Reclassification

 

Reclassification

 

Other

 

Adjustments

 

AIFRS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(note(iii)

)

(note (iv)

)

(note (viii)

)

(note (ix)

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

$M

 

$

M

 

$

M

 

$

M

 

$

M

 

$

M

 

$

M

 

 

(1

)

 

 

 

1

 

11,601

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

6,348

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

6,285

 

 

(12

)

 

(706

)

 

3,730

 

3,730

 

 

304

 

 

 

 

3,101

 

10,042

 

 

(606

)

 

 

 

1,538

 

232,490

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

13,449

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

159

 

 

 

 

 

 

54

 

1,926

 

5

 

 

 

 

 

52

 

1,389

 

 

 

(48

)

 

(5

)

556

 

3,454

 

 

(73

)

 

706

 

 

(3,726

)

6,177

 

 

 

48

 

 

 

(387

)

1,054

 

5

 

(388

)

 

 

(5

)

4,919

 

298,104

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

12,027

 

 

(408

)

 

 

 

4,629

 

190,322

 

 

 

 

(1,429

)

 

4,225

 

4,225

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

13,449

 

(12)

 

4

 

 

 

2

 

4

 

1,801

 

16

 

16

 

 

1,429

 

(4

)

(3,989

)

7,618

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

914

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

39,073

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

9,137

 

4

 

(388

)

 

 

(2

)

4,869

 

278,566

 

1

 

 

 

 

(3

)

50

 

19,538

 

41

 

 

 

 

 

(21

)

8,053

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

1,858

 

 

 

 

 

 

(218

)

(443

)

 

 

 

 

 

(31

)

 

23

 

 

 

 

 

67

 

67

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

330

 

23

 

 

 

 

 

(182

)

(46

)

(63)

 

 

 

 

(3

)

228

 

9,621

 

 

 

 

 

 

25

 

25

 

(63)

 

 

 

 

(3

)

253

 

9,646

 

1

 

 

 

 

(3

)

50

 

19,511

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

27

 

1

 

 

 

 

(3

)

50

 

19,538

 

 

106




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

24.  Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

Table 6:        Balance sheet as at 1 October 2005

 

 

 

 

30

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

September

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

2005 AIFRS

 

Credit Loss

 

Fee

 

 

 

AGAAP(1)

 

Adjustments

 

Provisioning

 

Revenue

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(from Table

 

 

 

 

 

Reference

 

 

 

(note 5)

 

(note (a))

 

(note (b))

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liquid assets

 

11,600

 

1

 

 

 

Due from other financial institutions

 

6,348

 

 

 

 

Trading securities

 

6,285

 

 

 

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

 

3,730

 

 

 

Available for sale assets

 

 

 

 

 

Investment securities

 

6,941

 

3,101

 

 

 

Net loans and advances

 

230,952

 

1,538

 

289

 

(382

)

Customer’s liability for acceptances

 

13,449

 

 

 

 

Regulatory deposits

 

159

 

 

 

 

Shares in associates and joint venture entities

 

1,872

 

54

 

 

 

Deferred tax assets

 

1,337

 

52

 

(105

)

121

 

Goodwill and other intangible assets

 

2,898

 

556

 

 

 

Other assets

 

9,903

 

(3,726

)

 

(15

)

Premises and equipment

 

1,441

 

(387

)

 

 

Total assets

 

293,185

 

4,919

 

184

 

(276

)

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due to other financial institutions

 

12,027

 

 

 

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

185,693

 

4,629

 

 

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

 

4,225

 

 

 

Liability for acceptances

 

13,449

 

 

 

 

 

Income tax liabilities

 

1,797

 

4

 

 

 

Payables and other liabilities

 

11,607

 

(3,989

)

 

 

Provisions

 

914

 

 

 

 

Bonds and notes

 

39,073

 

 

 

 

Loan capital

 

9,137

 

 

 

 

Total liabilities

 

273,697

 

4,869

 

 

 

Net assets

 

19,488

 

50

 

184

 

(276

)

Shareholders’ equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ordinary share capital

 

8,074

 

(21

)

 

 

Preference share capital

 

1,858

 

 

 

 

Reserves

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

- Foreign currency translation reserve

 

(225

)

(218

)

(23

)

 

- Asset revaluation reserve

 

31

 

(31

)

 

 

- Share options reserve

 

 

67

 

 

 

- Cashflow hedging reserve

 

 

 

 

 

- Available for sale reserve

 

 

 

 

 

- Other reserves

 

330

 

 

 

 

Total reserves

 

136

 

(182

)

(23

)

 

Retained profits

 

9,393

 

228

 

207

 

(276

)

Share capital and reserves attributable to shareholders’ of the Company

 

19,461

 

50

 

184

 

(276

)

Minority Interest

 

27

 

 

 

 

Total shareholders’ equity

 

19,488

 

50

 

184

 

(276

)

 

(1)             Reported financial position for the financial year ended 30 September 2005

107




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

24.  Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), cont’d

Effect of transition to AIFRS

 

 

 

Derivative

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Accounting

 

Financial

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Including

 

Instruments

 

Reclassification

 

 

 

Accounting

 

Total AIFRS

 

 

 

Hedging

 

Remeasurement

 

of StEPS

 

for INGA

 

Other

 

Adjustments

 

AIFRS

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

(note (c))

 

(note (d))

 

(note (e))

 

(note (f))

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

 

 

 

 

 

1

 

11,601

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

6,348

 

 

(112

)

 

 

 

(112

)

6,173

 

275

 

(42

)

 

 

 

3,963

 

3,963

 

1

 

11,153

 

 

 

 

11,154

 

11,154

 

(11)

 

(10,031

)

 

 

 

(6,941

)

 

(214)

 

(1,129

)

 

 

 

102

 

231,054

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

13,449

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

159

 

 

 

 

(138

)

 

(84

)

1,788

 

49

 

 

 

 

3

 

116

 

1,453

 

 

 

(4

)

 

(15

)

541

 

3,439

 

(11)

 

(38

)

11

 

 

(2

)

(3,781

)

6,122

 

 

 

 

 

 

(387

)

1,054

 

89

 

(199

)

7

 

(138

)

(14

)

4,572

 

297,757

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

12,027

 

(70)

 

 

 

 

 

4,559

 

190,252

 

35

 

6

 

 

 

 

4,266

 

4,266

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

13,449

 

54

 

(20

)

 

 

(9

)

29

 

1,826

 

4

 

(131

)

 

 

(1

)

(4,117

)

7,490

 

 

 

 

 

16

 

16

 

930

 

(7)

 

 

 

 

 

(7

)

39,066

 

65

 

 

1,000

 

 

 

1,065

 

10,202

 

81

 

(145

)

1,000

 

 

6

 

5,811

 

279,508

 

8

 

(54

)

(993

)

(138

)

(20

)

(1,239

)

18,249

 

 

 

 

 

 

(21

)

8,053

 

 

 

(987

)

 

 

(987

)

871

 

 

 

 

 

 

(241

)

(466

)

 

 

 

 

 

(31

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

67

 

67

 

162

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

162

 

162

 

(1)

 

(17

)

 

8

 

 

(10

)

(10

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

330

 

161

 

(17

)

 

8

 

 

(53

)

83

 

(153)

 

(37

)

(6

)

(146

)

(20

)

(203

)

9,190

 

8

 

(54

)

(993

)

(138

)

(20

)

(1,239

)

18,222

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

27

 

8

 

(54

)

(993

)

(138

)

(20

)

(1,239

)

18,249

 

108




NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

25.          US GAAP Reconciliation

The following is a condensed consolidated Statement of Net Income of the Group under US GAAP, for the half-years ended 31 March 2006, 30 September 2005 and 31 March 2005 and for the full year ended 30 September 2005:

 

 

 

Half
year
 Mar 06
$M

 

Full
year
Sep 05
$M

 

Half
year
 Sep 05
$M

 

Half
year
Mar 05
$M

 

Total income

 

12,283

 

21,184

 

11,110

 

10,074

 

Interest income

 

10,731

 

18,177

 

9,507

 

8,670

 

Interest expense

 

(7,453

)

(11,925

)

(6,337

)

(5,588

)

Net interest income

 

3,278

 

6,252

 

3,170

 

3,082

 

Lending fees

 

243

 

403

 

208

 

195

 

Non-lending fees and commissions

 

937

 

1,810

 

941

 

869

 

Total fee and commission income

 

1,180

 

2,213

 

1,149

 

1,064

 

Fee and commission expense

 

(139

)

(232

)

(115

)

(117

)

Net fee and commission income

 

1,041

 

1,981

 

1,034

 

947

 

Other income

 

511

 

1,026

 

569

 

457

 

Total other operating income

 

1,552

 

3,007

 

1,603

 

1,404

 

Personnel expense

 

(1,401

)

(2,516

)

(1,284

)

(1,232

)

Premises expenses

 

(210

)

(379

)

(193

)

(186

)

Computer expenses

 

(264

)

(558

)

(295

)

(263

)

Other expenses

 

(448

)

(1,006

)

(499

)

(507

)

Restructuring

 

(23

)

(52

)

(22

)

(30

)

Operating expenses

 

(2,346

)

(4,511

)

(2,293

)

(2,218

)

Net income before loan loss charge and income tax

 

2,484

 

4,748

 

2,480

 

2,268

 

Allowance for loan loss charge

 

(243

)

(316

)

(32

)

(284

)

Net income before income tax

 

2,241

 

4,432

 

2,448

 

1,984

 

Income tax expense

 

(653

)

(1,256

)

(701

)

(555

)

Profit after income tax

 

1,588

 

3,176

 

1,747

 

1,429

 

Net income attributable to minority interest

 

(1

)

(3

)

(2

)

(1

)

Net income attributable to shareholders of the Company

 

1,587

 

3,173

 

1,745

 

1,428

 

Earnings per share (cents) according to US GAAP

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Basic

 

87

 

174

 

96

 

78

 

Diluted

 

85

 

170

 

94

 

76

 

 

109




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

25.          US GAAP Reconciliation, cont’d

The following is a condensed consolidated Balance Sheet of the Group under US GAAP, as at 31 March 2006, 30 September 2005 and 31 March 2005:

 

 

Half
year
Mar 06
$M

 

Half
year
 Sep 05
$M

 

Half
year
Mar 05
$M

 

Assets

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Liquid assets

 

13,870

 

11,601

 

8,856

 

Due from other financial institutions

 

8,336

 

6,348

 

6,428

 

Trading securities

 

8,721

 

6,285

 

6,108

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

7,485

 

3,723

 

4,002

 

Available for sale assets

 

13,283

 

10,045

 

9,604

 

Net loans and advances

 

240,041

 

230,999

 

218,830

 

Customer’s liability for acceptances

 

13,692

 

13,449

 

12,922

 

Regulatory deposits

 

214

 

159

 

143

 

Shares in controlled entities and associates

 

1,774

 

1,675

 

1,571

 

Deferred tax assets

 

506

 

761

 

1,653

 

Goodwill and other intangible assets

 

3,574

 

3,829

 

3,937

 

Other assets

 

4,939

 

6,611

 

6,681

 

Premises and equipment

 

926

 

917

 

937

 

Total assets

 

317,361

 

296,402

 

281,672

 

Liabilities

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Due to other financial institutions

 

13,345

 

12,027

 

10,056

 

Deposits and other borrowings

 

195,477

 

188,899

 

183,492

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

6,134

 

4,235

 

4,999

 

Liability for acceptances

 

13,692

 

13,449

 

12,922

 

Income tax liabilities

 

1,076

 

1,354

 

2,111

 

Payables and other liabilities

 

9,679

 

7,561

 

7,684

 

Provisions

 

908

 

914

 

865

 

Bonds and notes

 

46,849

 

39,103

 

32,348

 

Loan Capital

 

11,978

 

10,953

 

9,121

 

Total liabilities

 

299,138

 

278,495

 

263,598

 

Net Assets

 

18,223

 

17,907

 

18,074

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Shareholders’ Equity

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Ordinary share capital

 

8,091

 

8,076

 

8,030

 

Preference share capital

 

 

 

871

 

Reserves

 

(355

)

(405

)

(222

)

Retained Earnings

 

10,453

 

10,209

 

9,377

 

Share capital and reserves attributable to shareholders of the company

 

18,189

 

17,880

 

18,056

 

Minority interest

 

34

 

27

 

18

 

Total shareholders’ equity

 

18,223

 

17,907

 

18,074

 

 

110




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

25.          US GAAP Reconciliation, cont’d

The consolidated financial statements of the Group are prepared in accordance with Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS), which differ in some respects from Generally Accepted Accounting Principles in the United States (US GAAP).

As discussed in Note 1, the Group revised its accounting policies on 1 October 2005 to enable the preparation of financial statements that comply with AIFRS.  An explanation of how the transition from previous Australian GAAP to AIFRS has impacted the Group’s reported financial position, financial performance and cash flow is set out in Note 24.

The AIFRS accounting policies have been consistently applied by all consolidated entities and to all periods presented in the consolidated financial report and the opening AIFRS balance sheet as at 1 October 2004, except for those policies relating to Standards for which comparatives are not restated, as permitted under the first time adoption transitional provisions. These Standards are AASB 132: “Financial Instruments: Presentation and Disclosure”, AASB 139: “Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement”, and AASB 4: “Insurance Contracts”.  Accordingly, comparative information with respect to financial instruments and insurance contracts for local reporting is prepared under the Group’s previous accounting policies.

The following tables reconcile AIFRS net income, equity and gross assets to US GAAP net income, equity and gross assets.

Reconciliation of AIFRS to US GAAP

 

 

Note

 

Half
year
Mar 06
$M

 

Half
year
 Sep 05
$M

 

Half
year
Mar 05
$M

 

Net profit reported under AIFRS

 

 

 

1,811

 

1,620

 

1,555

 

Items having the effect of increasing (decreasing) net income according to US GAAP (total tax impact of adjustments shown separately)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Adjustment to goodwill

 

(ii)

 

(38

)

 

 

Pension expense adjustment and deficit amortisation

 

(v)

 

(7

)

(9

)

(10

)

Provision for loan impairment

 

(vii)

 

(19

)

264

 

 

Deconsolidation of special purpose vehicles

 

(viii)

 

(7

)

(5

)

(3

)

Mark to market of non compliant hedges

 

(x)

 

(109

)

(42

)

(53

)

Effective yield adjustment

 

(xi)

 

10

 

(10

)

 

Adjustment on entering joint venture

 

(xii)

 

 

(19

)

 

Guarantee fee obligation

 

(xiii)

 

 

(1

)

(4

)

Employee share issue and options

 

(xiv)

 

(38

)

42

 

(3

)

Interest on reclassified preference shares and amortisation of costs

 

(xv)

 

 

(35

)

(33

)

Deconsolidation of trust preferred structure

 

(xvi)

 

(12

)

66

 

 

Amortisation of core deposit intangible

 

(xviii)

 

(52

)

(59

)

(66

)

Life insurance and funds management business

 

(xix)

 

(35

)

(7

)

 

Other adjustments

 

(xx)

 

(6

)

11

 

10

 

Total tax impact of the above adjustments (refer below)

 

 

 

89

 

(71

)

35

 

Net income according to US GAAP

 

 

 

1,587

 

1,745

 

1,428

 

Adjustments to determine other comprehensive income to US GAAP

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income according to US GAAP

 

 

 

1,587

 

1,745

 

1,428

 

Pension plan deficit net of tax (Tax is; Mar 2006: $16m; Sep 2005: $1m; Mar 2005; -$6m)

 

(v)

 

37

 

2

 

(14

)

Realised profit (loss) on sale of available for sale securities net of tax: (Tax is; Mar 2006: $nil; Sep 2005: $nil; Mar 2005; -$3m)

 

(vi)

 

 

 

(7

)

Unrealised profit (loss) on available for sale securities net of tax: (Tax is; Mar 2006: -$1m; Sep 2005: -$4m; Mar 2005; $5m)

 

(vi)

 

(3

)

(10

)

12

 

Currency translation adjustments, net of net investment hedges after tax: (Tax is; Mar 2006: $15m; Sep 2005: $13m; Mar 2005; $19m)

 

(ix)

 

(365

)

(159

)

(284

)

Mark to market of cash flow hedges net of tax: (Tax is; Mar 2006: $1m; Sep 2005: -$7m; Mar 2005; $16m)

 

(x)

 

3

 

(18

)

38

 

Total comprehensive income according to US GAAP

 

 

 

1,259

 

1,560

 

1,173

 

 

111




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

25.          US GAAP Reconciliation, cont’d



 

 

 

Half
year
Mar 06
$M

 

Half
year
 Sep 05
$M

 

Half
year
Mar 05
$M

 

Total tax (expense)/benefit of the above adjustments comprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Employee share issue and options

 

 

 

6

 

(6

)

(9

)

Pension expense adjustment and deficit amortisation

 

 

 

2

 

3

 

3

 

Effective yield adjustment

 

 

 

(3

)

3

 

 

Provisioning for loan impairment

 

 

 

11

 

(97

)

 

Amortisation of core deposit intangible

 

 

 

17

 

19

 

22

 

Mark to market of non-compliant derivative hedges

 

 

 

37

 

14

 

16

 

Guarantee revenue

 

 

 

 

 

1

 

Deconsolidation of trust preferred structure

 

 

 

 

(25

)

 

Adjustment to goodwill

 

 

 

11

 

 

 

Life insurance and funds management business

 

 

 

2

 

2

 

 

Other adjustments

 

 

 

6

 

16

 

2

 

Total tax impact

 

 

 

89

 

(71

)

35

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Shareholders’ equity reported under AIFRS

 

Note

 

18,762

 

19,511

 

18,909

 

Adjustment to accumulated depreciation on buildings revalued

 

(i)

 

55

 

54

 

53

 

Elimination of gross asset revaluation reserves

 

(i)

 

(191

)

(193

)

(195

)

Accumulated amortisation of goodwill

 

(ii)

 

(263

)

(263

)

(263

)

Restoration of previously deducted goodwill

 

(ii)

 

695

 

695

 

695

 

Adjustment to goodwill

 

(ii)

 

(17

)

7

 

7

 

Deferred profit on sale and leaseback transactions

 

(iii)

 

(16

)

(18

)

(22

)

Pension expense adjustment

 

(v)

 

89

 

79

 

106

 

Unrealised (profit) loss on available for sale securities

 

(vi)

 

(11

)

3

 

18

 

Provision for loan impairment

 

(vii)

 

(25

)

264

 

 

Deconsolidation of special purpose entities

 

(viii)

 

(15

)

(5

)

1

 

Adjustment to reserves

 

(ix)

 

 

19

 

19

 

Mark to market of non compliant hedges

 

(x)

 

(28

)

10

 

70

 

Effective yield adjustment

 

(xi)

 

412

 

(6

)

4

 

Adjustment on entering into joint venture

 

(xii)

 

(237

)

(237

)

(218

)

Guarantee fee obligation

 

(xiii)

 

(28

)

(28

)

(27

)

Employee share issue and options

 

(xiv)

 

(9

)

23

 

28

 

Reclassification of preference shares

 

(xv)

 

 

(992

)

(991

)

Deconsolidation of trust preferred structure

 

(xvi)

 

(828

)

(787

)

 

Leasing

 

(xvii)

 

40

 

 

 

Accumulated amortisation of core deposit intangible

 

(xviii)

 

(177

)

(125

)

(65

)

Acquisition cost of NBNZ purchase adjustment

 

(xviii)

 

(37

)

(37

)

(37

)

Life insurance and funds management business

 

(xix)

 

99

 

(14

)

(7

)

Other adjustments

 

(xx)

 

9

 

19

 

3

 

Total tax impact of the above adjustments (refer below)

 

 

 

(90

)

(99

)

(32

)

Shareholders’ equity according to US GAAP

 

 

 

18,189

 

17,880

 

18,056

 

 

112




 

NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

25.          US GAAP Reconciliation, cont’d

 

 

 

 

Half
year
Mar 06
$M

 

Half
year
Sep 05
$M

 

Half
year
Mar 05
$M

 

Total tax (expense)/benefit of the above adjustments comprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deferred profit on sale and leaseback transactions

 

 

 

5

 

6

 

7

 

Pension expense adjustment

 

 

 

(27

)

(24

)

(32

)

Effective yield adjustment

 

 

 

(127

)

2

 

(1

)

Provisioning for loan impairment

 

 

 

8

 

(97

)

 

Accumulated amortisation of core deposit intangible

 

 

 

58

 

41

 

21

 

Derivative and hedging activities

 

 

 

8

 

(3

)

(21

)

Deconsolidation of trust preferred structure

 

 

 

(25

)

(25

)

 

Deconsolidation of special purpose entities

 

 

 

4

 

1

 

 

Goodwill adjustment

 

 

 

5

 

(2

)

(2

)

Unrealised (profit) loss on available for sale securities

 

 

 

3

 

(1

)

(5

)

Leasing

 

 

 

(12

)

 

 

Guarantee fee obligation

 

 

 

8

 

8

 

8

 

Other adjustments

 

 

 

2

 

(5

)

(7

)

Total tax impact

 

 

 

(90

)

(99

)

(32

)

 

Total assets reported under AIFRS

 

Note

 

319,363

 

298,104

 

282,784

 

Adjustment to accumulated depreciation on buildings revalued

 

(i)

 

55

 

54

 

53

 

Elimination of gross incremental revaluations

 

(i)

 

(190

)

(191

)

(191

)

Accumulated amortisation of goodwill

 

(ii)

 

(263

)

(263

)

(263

)

Restoration of previously deducted goodwill

 

(ii)

 

695

 

695

 

695

 

Adjustment to goodwill

 

(ii)

 

(17

)

1

 

1

 

Reclassification of deferred tax assets against deferred tax liabilities

 

(iv)

 

(949

)

(635

)

376

 

Deferred tax assets

 

(iv)

 

 

16

 

 

Prepaid pension adjustment

 

(v)

 

(5

)

(3

)

(4

)

Unrealised (profit) loss on available for sale securities

 

(vi)

 

(15

)

3

 

18

 

Provision for impairment

 

(vii)

 

(25

)

264

 

 

Deconsolidation of special purpose entities

 

(viii)

 

(1,373

)

(1,403

)

(1,602

)

Mark to market of non compliant hedges

 

(x)

 

(134

)

63

 

121

 

Effective yield adjustment

 

(xi)

 

408

 

(9

)

1

 

Adjustment on entering into joint venture

 

(xii)

 

(237

)

(237

)

(218

)

Guarantee receivable

 

(xiii)

 

4

 

4

 

3

 

Employee share issue and options

 

(xiv)

 

(5

)

(5

)

(2

)

Issue Costs

 

(xv)

 

 

8

 

9

 

Deconsolidation of trust preferred structure

 

(xvi)

 

3

 

4

 

 

Leasing

 

(xvii)

 

49

 

 

 

Accumulated amortisation of core deposit intangible

 

(xviii)

 

(177

)

(125

)

(66

)

Adjustment to goodwill on recognition of deferred tax liability

 

(xviii)

 

104

 

104

 

 

NBNZ goodwill due to acquisition cost adjustment

 

(xviii)

 

(37

)

(37

)

(37

)

Life insurance and funds management business

 

(xix)

 

99

 

(14

)

(7

)

Other adjustments

 

(xx)

 

9

 

4

 

1

 

Total assets according to US GAAP

 

 

 

317,361

 

296,402

 

281,672

 

 

113




Reconciliation of previous Australian GAAP to US GAAP:

 

Full year Sep 05

 

Full year Sep 04

 

Full year Sep 03

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Net profit reported under Australian GAAP

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Items having the effect of increasing (decreasing) net income according to US GAAP (total tax impact of adjustments shown separately)

 

3,018

 

2,815

 

2,348

 

Amortisation of goodwill

 

224

 

189

 

62

 

Pension expense adjustment and deficit amortisation

 

(17

)

(16

)

2

 

Provisioning for loan impairment – change in methodology

 

264

 

-

 

-

 

Mark to market of non compliant hedges

 

(95

)

(89

)

(47

)

Loan origination

 

(10

)

-

 

-

 

Adjustment on entering joint venture

 

(19

)

(14

)

-

 

Guarantee fee obligation

 

(5

)

(23

)

-

 

Employee share issue and options

 

(42

)

(43

)

(21

)

Interest on reclassified preference shares and amortisation of costs

 

(68

)

(64

)

(1

)

Deconsolidation of special purpose vehicles

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Deconsolidation of trust preferred structure

 

66

 

-

 

-

 

Acquisition cost of NBNZ adjustment

 

-

 

(37

)

-

 

Amortisation of core deposit intangible

 

(125

)

-

 

-

 

Life insurance and funds management business

 

(7

)

-

 

-

 

Other adjustments

 

11

 

30

 

25

 

Total tax impact of the above adjustments (refer below)

 

(22

)

40

 

12

 

Net income according to US GAAP

 

3,173

 

2,788

 

2,380

 

Adjustments to determine other comprehensive income to US GAAP

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Net income according to US GAAP

 

3,173

 

2,788

 

2,380

 

Pension plan deficit net of tax (Tax is; Sep 2005: -$5m; Sep 2004: -$6m; Sep 03; -$42m)

 

(12

)

(14

)

(99

)

Realised gain on sale of available for sale securities net of tax: (Tax is; Sep 2005: -$3m; Sep 2004: $Nil; Sep 03; $Nil)

 

(7

)

-

 

-

 

Unrealised profit (loss) on available for sale securities net of tax: (Tax is; Sep 2005: $1m; Sep 2004: $3m; Sep 03; -$1m)

 

2

 

7

 

(2

)

Currency translation adjustments net of hedges after tax: (Tax is; Sep 2005: $13m; Sep 2004: $9m; Sep 03; -$54m)

 

(443

)

233

 

(356

)

Mark to market of cash flow hedges net of tax: (Tax is; Sep 2005: $9m; Sep 2004: -$40m; Sep 03; $33m)

 

20

 

(94

)

76

 

Total comprehensive income according to US GAAP

 

2,733

 

2,920

 

1,999

 

Total tax (expense)/benefit of the above adjustments comprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pension expense adjustment and deficit amortisation

 

4

 

6

 

(1

)

Loan origination

 

3

 

-

 

-

 

Provisioning for loan impairment

 

(97

)

-

 

-

 

Amortisation of core deposit intangible

 

41

 

-

 

-

 

Marked to market of non-compliant derivative hedges

 

30

 

27

 

14

 

Guarantee revenue

 

2

 

7

 

-

 

Deconsolidation of trust preferred structure

 

(25

)

-

 

-

 

Other adjustments

 

20

 

-

 

(1

)

Total tax impact

 

(22

)

40

 

12

 

 

114




 

 

Full year Sep 05

 

Full year Sep 04

 

Full year Sep 03

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Shareholders’ equity reported under Australian GAAP

 

19,461

 

17,907

 

13,770

 

Adjustment to accumulated depreciation on buildings revalued

 

54

 

52

 

50

 

Elimination of gross asset revaluation reserves

 

(213

)

(224

)

(247

)

Accumulated amortisation of goodwill

 

(39

)

(263

)

(452

)

Restoration of previously deducted goodwill

 

695

 

695

 

695

 

Deferred profit on sale and leaseback transactions

 

(19

)

(20

)

(17

)

Pension expense adjustment

 

(81

)

(48

)

(14

)

Unrealised profit (loss) on available for sale securities

 

2

 

8

 

1

 

Provision for loan impairment – change in methodology

 

264

 

-

 

-

 

Mark to market of non compliant hedges

 

11

 

69

 

309

 

Loan origination

 

(10

)

-

 

-

 

Adjustment on entering into joint venture

 

(236

)

(217

)

(203

)

Guarantee fee obligation

 

(20

)

(16

)

-

 

Reclassification of preference shares

 

(992

)

(990

)

(988

)

Deconsolidation of trust preferred structure

 

(787

)

-

 

-

 

Accumulated amortisation of core deposit intangible

 

(125

)

-

 

-

 

Acquisition cost of NBNZ purchase adjustment

 

(37

)

(37

)

-

 

Other adjustments

 

(11

)

-

 

-

 

Total tax impact of the above adjustments (refer below)

 

(37

)

1

 

(84

)

Shareholders’ equity according to US GAAP

 

17,880

 

16,917

 

12,820

 

Total assets reported under Australian GAAP

 

293,185

 

259,345

 

195,591

 

Adjustment to accumulated depreciation on buildings revalued

 

54

 

52

 

50

 

Elimination of gross incremental revaluations

 

(191

)

(191

)

(203

)

Accumulated amortisation of goodwill

 

(39

)

(263

)

(452

)

Restoration of previously deducted goodwill

 

695

 

695

 

695

 

Reclassification of deferred tax assets against deferred tax liabilities

 

(635

)

(672

)

(726

)

Deferred tax assets

 

16

 

-

 

-

 

Prepaid pension adjustment

 

49

 

58

 

66

 

Unrealised profit (loss) on available for sale securities

 

3

 

12

 

2

 

Provision for impairment - change in methodology

 

264

 

-

 

-

 

Consolidation of variable interest entities

 

3,236

 

3,036

 

-

 

Mark to market of non compliant hedges

 

57

 

192

 

397

 

Loan origination

 

(10

)

-

 

-

 

Adjustment on entering into joint venture

 

(236

)

(217

)

(203

)

Guarantee receivable

 

4

 

4

 

-

 

Issue Costs

 

12

 

10

 

13

 

Accumulated amortisation of core deposit intangible

 

(125

)

-

 

-

 

Adjustment to goodwill on recognition of deferred tax liability

 

104

 

-

 

-

 

NBNZ goodwill due to acquisition cost adjustment

 

(37

)

(37

)

-

 

Other adjustments

 

(4

)

-

 

-

 

Total assets according to US GAAP

 

296,402

 

262,024

 

195,230

 

Total tax (expense)/benefit of the above adjustments comprises

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Deferred profit on sale and leaseback transactions

 

6

 

6

 

5

 

Pension expense adjustment

 

24

 

14

 

4

 

Loan origination

 

3

 

-

 

-

 

Provisioning for loan impairment

 

(97

)

-

 

-

 

Accumulated amortisation of core deposit intangible

 

41

 

-

 

-

 

Derivative and hedging activities

 

(9

)

(19

)

(93

)

Deconsolidation of trust preferred structure

 

(25

)

-

 

-

 

Other adjustments

 

20

 

-

 

-

 

Total tax impact

 

(37

)

1

 

(84

)

 

115




 

We have outlined in the following notes the significant differences between AIFRS, previous Australian GAAP and US GAAP.  A more detailed discussion of the AIFRS policies is contained in Note 1 and the impacts of transition to AIFRS in Note 24.

During the period, consequent to the transition to AIFRS, the Group reviewed in detail its US GAAP reporting.  This review identified several interpretational differences in the Group’s application of US GAAP.  These differences impact the current and prior years.  In accordance with APB 20 “Accounting Changes” and SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin No. 99 “Materiality”, these have been adjusted for in the US GAAP reconciliation in the current period, 2006, as they are not material, individually or in aggregate.  These adjustments aggregated to a $85 million decrease in net income in the half year to 31 March 2006 and principally relate to life insurance and funds management, intangibles and financial instruments.

As a result of the review, the Group has enhanced US GAAP reporting resources and processes.

(i)        Premises and equipment

In the past the Group at various times has revalued properties, increasing the book value of these assets as permitted under previous Australian GAAP.  Under AIFRS, the Group holds its properties at a deemed cost value.  Any increments on revaluation were credited directly to the Asset Revaluation Reserve (ARR), and decrements were debited to the ARR to the extent of any previous revaluation increments.

Under US GAAP, revaluation of properties is not permitted except for decrements, which are recorded in the Statement of Net Income.  Subsequent recoveries to the Statement of Net Income are not allowed.

The impact of previous upward revaluations under AIFRS is that depreciation charges are higher and profits on disposal are lower than those recorded under US GAAP.  The depreciation charges, together with the profits and losses on revalued assets sold have been adjusted to historical cost in the US GAAP reconciliation.

(ii)       Goodwill

The requirements of AIFRS and US GAAP are the same with respect to goodwill.  Under AIFRS, the past practice stipulated by previous Australian GAAP of systematically amortising goodwill over the expected period of benefit ceased and was replaced by impairment testing annually or more frequently if events or circumstances indicate that goodwill might be impaired.

Prior to 1 October 2002, under US GAAP goodwill was capitalised and amortised over the period of time during which the benefits were expected to arise.  Post this date, a review for impairment applies rather than systematic goodwill amortisation. Until 1 October 2002, adjustments were made in the US GAAP reconciliation to restore goodwill written-off in full under Australia GAAP and to amortise such goodwill over the period of the expected benefits.

During the period, a reclassification between goodwill and finite life intangible assets was identified.  As a result of this, a cumulative prior period adjustment (total impact after tax is $(19) million) has been made in the Statement of Net Income in the current period to reflect prior period amortisation.  In addition, the Group has reassessed the useful life of a component of this intangible asset from 10 years to 4 years and has charged the impact to the Statement of Net Income.

(iii)      Sale-leaseback transactions

Under AIFRS, gains on disposal under sale-leaseback transactions for operating leases can be recognised in the period of sale.

Under US GAAP, the gain is amortised over the lease term (typically this is between 5 and 10 years).  This difference in treatment has been adjusted in the US GAAP reconciliation.

(iv)      Income taxes

Under US GAAP, deferred tax liabilities and deferred tax assets are offset and presented for each tax paying component of an enterprise and within each particular tax jurisdiction.  The impact of the difference in this approach to AIFRS has been adjusted for in the US GAAP reconciliation.

An adjustment of $2 million has been made to net income in the current period to reflect the cumulative impact of deferred tax assets not previously booked.

(v)       Pension commitments

Under previous Australian GAAP, the Group accounted for the defined benefit superannuation schemes on a cash basis and did not recognise an asset or liability for the net position of the defined benefit superannuation schemes.

On adoption of AIFRS, surpluses (assets) and/or deficits (liabilities) that arise within defined benefit superannuation schemes are recognised on the Balance Sheet, which is consistent with the requirements of US GAAP.

The Group elected to apply the option available under AIFRS to recognise actuarial gains and losses in the Balance Sheet (i.e. the “direct to retained earnings” approach). The non-cash expense reflecting the notional cost of the benefits accruing to members of the defined benefit schemes in respect of service provided over the reporting period is charged to the Income Statement.

Recognition of an additional minimum liability is required under US GAAP where the accumulated benefit obligation exceeds the fair value of plan assets and an asset has been recognised as prepaid pension cost, or the liability already recognised as unfunded accrued pension cost, is less than the unfunded accumulated benefit obligation.   This requirement differs to AIFRS.

116




 

(v)       Pension commitments, cont’d

During the current period, the other comprehensive income impact of the NZ defined benefit scheme was reviewed.  An adjustment was identified as part of this review and has been booked through other comprehensive income in the current period (impact after tax is $20 million).

(vi)      Available for sale securities

US GAAP requires that investments not classified as trading securities or as held to maturity securities shall be classified as available for sale securities and be recorded at market value in accordance with SFAS 115 ‘Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities’.

Under AIFRS, as at 1 October 2005 certain financial assets of the Group previously carried at amortised cost were reclassified as available-for-sale assets, resulting in measurement at fair value with movements being taken to an available-for-sale equity reserve.  Included in the available for sale classification at this time were loans.

While AIFRS and US GAAP are broadly consistent with respect to the available for sale classification, loans cannot be treated as available for sale under US GAAP and accordingly an adjustment has been made in the US GAAP reconciliation.

During the period, it was identified that certain equity securities had not been appropriately booked as available for sale for US GAAP purposes (total impact after tax is $(25) million).  This adjustment was booked on transition to AIFRS to opening retained earnings.  For US GAAP purposes, this has been booked through other comprehensive income in the current period.

(vii)     Accounting for the impairment of loans

AASB 139 is more prescriptive in its guidance on impairment provisioning than either previous Australian GAAP or US GAAP.

For impairment provisioning, AASB 139 requires that there be objective evidence of impairment, resulting from an identified loss event, which has an impact on the present value of estimated future cash flows of a financial asset or a group of financial assets. It is an incurred loss approach, focussed on the balance sheet and requiring consideration of individual provisions (for specific impairments) and a collective provision (where a loss event has occurred but where the Group is unable to specifically identify the individual loans impacted).

This led the Group in 2005 to refine its previous method for determining impairment expense, referred to as ‘Economic Loss Provisioning’ (ELP) through discounting cash flows and changing certain judgemental risk measures.  ELP determined an expense, based on the average one year loss expected to be incurred if the same loan portfolio was held over an economic cycle. Specific provisions were not charged directly to earnings but were treated as transfers from the general provision.

To assess the collective provisions, exposures are placed into pools having similar risk characteristics. The required provision is estimated on the basis of historical loss experience for assets with credit risk characteristics similar to those in the collective pool. The historical loss experience is adjusted based on current observable data.

The collective provision shares the same underlying measurement objectives as the previous GAAP general provision it replaces.

In preparation for the implementation of AASB 139 “Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement” from 1 October, 2005, the Group added greater precision to the estimates used in its allowance for loan loss methodology in order to comply with AIFRS.

The Group substantially completed its analysis of the loan loss methodology in September 2005 and included this in the 2005 US GAAP reconciliation.  Over the period subsequent to the finalisation of the US Form 20-F in December 2005, the Group continued to work on the transition to AIFRS.  Along with other AIFRS matters, the Group completed and presented its analysis of the allowance for loan loss methodology in the March 2006 interim financial statements.

US GAAP is consistent with AIFRS in accounting for the impairment of loans with the exception of the discounting of cash flows.  Discounting is not applied to smaller—balance homogenous loans that are collectively evaluated for impairment for US GAAP purposes.

We have further treated this adjustment as a change of estimate in preparing our US GAAP reconciliation, taking the impact to net income (impact after tax is $(8) million).

 

117




(viii)        Accounting for transfers and servicing of financial assets and extinguishments of liabilities and variable interest entities

For AIFRS purposes, the Group consolidates its subsidiaries where it is determined that there is a capacity to control or ANZ holds the majority of risks and benefits.

Securitised assets are derecognised when the right to receive cash flows has expired or the risks and rewards of ownership are transferred substantially.

SFAS 140 ‘Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities’ prescribes the accounting and disclosure requirements for transfers of financial assets and extinguishments of liabilities.

The Group retains servicing and (for some loans) custodian responsibilities for sold loans.  These interests have been included in the Group’s US GAAP reconciliation.

In the year ended 30 September 2004, the Group first applied the provisions of FASB Interpretation No. 46 (Revised) “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities” (“FIN 46R”).  The Group is required to consolidate those Variable Interest Entities for which the Group is the primary beneficiary.

FIN 46R does not require the consolidation of Kingfisher Trust 2001-1G and Kingfisher Trust 2004-1G.  This outcome differs to AIFRS and has been adjusted in the US GAAP reconciliation.

The current period net income includes a cumulative prior period adjustment of $(6) million after tax to reflect the profit impact of certain special purpose vehicles.

(ix)          Comprehensive income

SFAS 130 ‘Reporting Comprehensive Income’ establishes standards for reporting and display of comprehensive income and its components.

Comprehensive income is defined as all changes in shareholders’ equity during a period excluding those resulting from investments by shareholders and distributions to shareholders.  Total other comprehensive income is as follows (all amounts are post-tax):

 

Half year Mar 06

 

Half year Sep 05

 

Half year Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Foreign currency translation reserve

 

(570

)

(424

)

(265

)

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Mark to market of cash flow hedge

 

-

 

(3

)

14

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Unrealised profit (loss) on available for sale securities

 

146

 

2

 

13

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pension plan deficit

 

(79

)

(117

)

(118

)

Total other comprehensive income

 

(503

)

(542

)

(356

)

 

On transition to AIFRS, an adjustment to the foreign currency translation reserve was identified for local reporting purposes (impact after tax is $(19) million).  This adjustment was booked on transition to AIFRS to opening retained earnings.  For US GAAP purposes, this has been booked through other comprehensive income in the current period.

118




 

(x)           Accounting for derivative instruments and hedging activities

The Group has adopted SFAS 133 ‘Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities’ as amended by SFAS 138 ‘Accounting for Certain Derivative Instruments and Certain Hedging Activities’ and SFAS 149 ‘Amendment of Statement 133 on Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities’ in its US GAAP reconciliation from 1 October 2000.

Consistent with AIFRS, SFAS 133 requires all derivatives to be recognised on balance sheet at fair value.  Movements in the fair value of derivatives are taken to the statement of financial performance, unless the derivatives meet the criteria prescribed in SFAS 133 for fair value, cash flow, or net investment hedges.  If certain criteria are met derivatives can be designated as hedges.

Under SFAS 133 normal banking hedging practices may not qualify for hedge accounting, notwithstanding their ability to hedge existing balance sheet positions from an economic perspective.

As a result future fair value movements recognised in the US GAAP reconciliation may not be indicative of the Group’s risk profile.  The Group uses instruments and hedging techniques that are effective in managing interest rate risk and foreign exchange risk.

Consistent with AIFRS, under SFAS 133, movements in the value of derivatives designated as fair value hedges are taken to the Statement of Net Income, along with the movement in the fair value of the underlying exposure that is being hedged to the extent the hedge is effective.  Any ineffectiveness is recognised in the Statement of Net Income.

US GAAP includes the concept of the shortcut method.    Under the shortcut method, an entity may assume that there is no ineffectiveness in a hedging relationship of interest rate risk involving a recognised interest-bearing asset or liability and an interest rate swap if certain stringent conditions are met.  This method is not permitted under AIFRS.

Movements in the effective portion of the fair value of derivatives designated as cash flow hedges are taken to other comprehensive income.  Any ineffectiveness is recognised in the US GAAP statement of financial performance immediately. Amounts are subsequently reclassified out of other comprehensive income into earnings as the hedged transaction impacts earnings or the hedge is de-designated and transactions become probable.

A cumulative adjustment of $(34) million after tax has been made in the current period to net income to reflect the fair value of certain economic hedge relationships that do not meet the criteria for hedge accounting under FAS 133 or AIFRS.  These adjustments were identified as part of the Group’s AIFRS transition and typically relate to structured products and have not previously been adjusted for US GAAP purposes.  For AIFRS purposes, these adjustments were booked to opening retained earnings on transition.

(xi)      Effective yield adjustment

Under AIFRS, internal loan origination costs, other than loan commissions, cannot be deferred as an adjustment to yield, unless direct and incremental costs.

Under US GAAP, certain direct costs and non-refundable loan fees are deferred and recognised over the period of the related loan or facility.

Certain lending fees have been reclassified as interest income in the comparative period, $326 million in the half year to 30 September 2005 and $309 million in the half year to 31 March 2006.  This reclassification has not resulted in a change to net income.

(xii)        Gain and non-capitalisable costs recognised on entering joint ventures

In accordance with previous Australian GAAP the Group recognised profits (net of transaction costs) based on the difference between fair value and carrying value of the share of businesses transferred to an external party on entering into a joint venture.

The Group elected not to restate on transition to AIFRS those business combinations that took place prior to transition date.

Under US GAAP the gains may not be recognised as they occurred as a result of a non-monetary transaction, which involved transferring ownership of controlled entities in exchange for a non-controlling ownership interest in the joint venture.

This has been adjusted for in the US GAAP reconciliation.

119




 

(xiii)       Guarantees

The Group accounts for guarantee arrangements in which it is the guarantor by applying the guidance in FIN 45 ‘Guarantors Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantors, including Indirect Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others’ (FIN 45). FIN 45 applies to all guarantees issued or modified after 15 December 2002 and requires that a guarantor recognise a liability equal to the fair value of the obligation undertaken at inception of the arrangement. The fair value of the obligation in issuing the guarantee at inception is typically equal to the net present value of the future amount of the premium receivable under the contract.  Typically for AIFRS, if these facilities have a tenure of less than 12 months, the fee received is recognised upfront.  In these situations, an adjustment is made in the US GAAP reconciliation.

(xiv)       Accounting for stock — compensation plans

Under previous Australian GAAP, the Group recognised an expense equal to the full fair value of all deferred shares issued as part of the short term and long term incentive arrangements.  The deferred shares vest over one to three years and may be forfeited under certain conditions.  The Group did not recognise an expense for options issued to staff or for shares issued under the $1,000 employee share plan.  On adoption of AIFRS, the Group recognised an expense for all share based remuneration, including deferred shares and options, and recognises this expense over the relevant vesting period.

For US GAAP and issues to 1 October 2005, APB No. 25 share-based employee compensation cost for variable share option plans (those with performance hurdles) is measured using the intrinsic value method.  US GAAP compensation cost is determined at date of issue and is expensed if the strike price is less than the market price at the time and it is probable that performance hurdles are met.

To the extent that the intrinsic value increases in subsequent periods an additional expense is recorded.

In December 2004, the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) issued Statement No. 123 (revised 2004) Share-Based Payment.  This Statement requires measurement of the cost of employee services received in exchange for an award of equity instruments based on the grant-date fair value of the award (with limited exceptions) and more closely aligns AIFRS and US GAAP.  That cost is recognised over the period during which an employee is required to provide service in exchange for the award—the requisite service period (usually the vesting period).   FAS 123R eliminates the alternative to use the intrinsic value method of accounting that was previously applied by the Group.   This revision applies to all share and option issues post 1 October 2005.  The impact of applying FAS 123R to new issues in the current period, rather than the intrinsic value method, has been to increase net income by $37 million after tax by decreasing personnel expenses.

The tax effect is recognised under AIFRS and therefore no adjustment is made in the US GAAP reconciliation.

(xv)          Classification of financial instruments with characteristics of both liability and equity

Under previous Australian GAAP, ANZ Stapled Exchangeable Preferred Securities (known as ANZ StEPS) were classified as equity instruments as they are not considered to be mandatorily converting to ordinary shares and do not meet the classification requirements of a financial liability upon issue.

Under US GAAP, StEPS is considered to be a hybrid security which has predominant characteristics of the stapled note liability.  Accordingly, it is accounted for as a liability until such time as the note and the preference shares are unbundled and the investor holds preference shares.

On transition to AIFRS, StEPS has been reclassified as a debt instrument and is no longer a reconciling item between AIFRS and US GAAP under AASB 132 from 1 October 2005.

(xvi)        Deconsolidation of trust preferred structure (under FIN46R)

The Group has applied the principles of FIN46R to its preferred structure. The impact of application has been to deconsolidate the following trust:

Instrument

 

Trust

 

Euro Trust Securities

 

ANZ Capital Trust III

 

 

The consequence of not consolidating the above trust is that the trust securities are considered to be debt for US GAAP purposes.  This has resulted in the following impact on the US GAAP reconciliation:

·                      Distributions are now classified as interest

·                      Issue costs are amortised over a five year period

·                      Euro trust securities have been classified as debt and have been revalued to Australian dollars at the year-end spot rate.  From 1 October 2005, the Group has hedged this foreign currency exposure for US GAAP purposes.

120




 

(xvii)       Leasing

US GAAP requires ANZ to record its investment in the lease as follows:

·                     Rentals receivable, net of that portion of the rental applicable to principal and interest on the non-recourse debt.

·                     A receivable for the amount of investment tax credit to be realised on the transaction.

·                     The estimated residual value of the leased asset.

·                     Unearned and deferred income.

Typically under US GAAP, the lessor’s net investment in a leveraged lease declines during the early years once the investment is completed and rises during the later years of the lease.

Under AIFRS, a leveraged lease is considered to be a finance lease.  As a result, income is recognised on a constant periodic rate of return on net investment.

(xviii)      Core deposit intangible

On 1 December 2003, the Company acquired 100% of the issued share capital of NBNZ Holdings Ltd and its controlled entities.

In this acquisition ANZ acquired what would be termed long term customer relationship intangible assets.  An asset is required to be booked at fair value on acquisition for long term customer relationship intangible assets which meet the criteria identified in SFAS 141.

ANZ recognises a core deposit intangible separately from goodwill in relation to this acquisition for US GAAP purposes.  This asset is not recognised for AIFRS purposes as the Group elected not to restate on transition those business combinations that took place prior to transition date.  This intangible asset is equal to $316 million before tax ($212 million after tax) and is to be amortised on a non-linear basis over a period of approximately 4 years.  The written down value of the asset as at 31 March 2006 is equal to $139 million (accumulated amortisation to date is equal to $177 million).

(xix)        Life insurance and funds management

For US GAAP, contracts are distinguished between “long duration contracts” and “investment” contracts.  This characterisation drives the accounting.  US GAAP does not permit any loss reversals to be recognised upfront for long duration investment contracts, resulting in an adjusting difference to AIFRS.

Under AIFRS, acquisition costs are usually recognised as expenses in the reporting period in which they are incurred.  This is generally offset by identifying a portion of the planned margins included in life insurance liabilities as relating to the recovery of acquisition costs.

Under US GAAP, the deferred acquisition cost balance for a long duration contract reflects expenses that vary with and are primarily related to the acquisition of new and renewal insurance contracts, and amortised in line with premiums.  For an investment contract, a gross-up of initial commissions and up-front fees is required by establishing a deferred income reserve and running off in-line with deferred acquisition cost asset.

As part of the Group’s AIFRS transition work, certain adjustments in relation to the prior period treatment of leases held by the life insurance joint venture and the amortisation of finite life intangible assets were reviewed.  This review identified adjustable differences that whilst immaterial in isolation and in aggregate, were booked to the opening balance sheet on transition to AIFRS (impact after tax is $(28) million).  For US GAAP purposes, the cumulative prior period impact has been adjusted in the statement of net income in the current period.

(xx)         Other

Other includes the effect of certain other differences between AIFRS and US GAAP, which both individually and in aggregate have no significant effect on shareholders’ equity, net income or total assets for the period.

(xxi)    Earnings per share

Under US GAAP, EPS is computed in accordance with SFAS 128 ‘Earnings Per Share’. This Standard is broadly similar to AIFRS.

In calculating EPS in accordance with SFAS 128, instruments that have the characteristics of both debt and equity have been considered. Such instruments have been treated as follows in the calculation of dilutive EPS for US GAAP purposes:

·                      ANZ Stapled Exchangeable Preferred Securities (ANZ StEPS):  Have been excluded from the dilutive EPS calculation as it is classified as debt for US GAAP purposes.  On exchange, a holder will receive (at the Company’s discretion) either $100 cash for each ANZ StEPS exchanged or a number of ordinary shares calculated in accordance with a conversion ratio based on $100 divided by the market price of ordinary shares at the date of conversion less 2.5%.  Based on the experience of similar issues in Australia it is considered more likely that the securities will be repaid in cash rather than in ordinary shares.  For AIFRS purposes, ANZ StEPS is considered to be dilutive.

·                      US Trust Securities: Have been included in the dilutive EPS as if the securities are not redeemed or bought back prior to 15 December 2053 they will convert into preference shares, which in turn manditorily convert into a number of ordinary shares.  For AIFRS purposes, US Trust Securities are also considered to be dilutive.

·                      Euro Trust Securities:  Have been excluded from the dilutive EPS as if the securities are not redeemed or bought back prior to 15 December 2053, they will convert into preference shares.  These preference shares do not convert into ordinary share capital.  For AIFRS purposes, Euro Trust Securities are also excluded from the dilutive and basic EPS calculation.

121




 

(xxii)       Details of Pension Expense

The elements of the net periodic pension cost are as follows:

 

 

Half year Mar 06

 

Half year Sep 05

 

Half year Mar 05

 

 

 

$M

 

$M

 

$M

 

Service cost

 

6

 

6

 

8

 

Interest cost

 

31

 

35

 

32

 

Expected return on schemes’ assets

 

(30

)

(32

)

(33

)

Amortisation net transition asset

 

-

 

(2

)

(2

)

Recognised gains/losses

 

2

 

1

 

3

 

Recognised prior service cost

 

5

 

4

 

2

 

Net periodic pension cost

 

14

 

12

 

10

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Amortisation of prepaid pension expense

 

-

 

-

 

-

 

Employer contributions

 

(9

)

(8

)

(7

)

Net pension expense

 

5

 

4

 

3

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Pension plan deficit amortisation

 

6

 

5

 

5

 

Pension expense adjustment and deficit amortisation

 

11

 

9

 

8

 

 

(xxiii)     Recently issued Australian accounting standards

The following standards and amendments were available for early adoption but have not been applied by the Group:

·                     AASB 7: ‘Financial Instruments: Disclosure’.  AASB 7 is applicable for annual reporting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2007

·                     AASB 2005-1: ‘Amendments to Australian Accounting Standards’ (May 2005) amending AASB 139.  AASB 2005-1 is applicable for annual reporting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2006

·                     AASB 2005-9: ‘Amendments to Australian Accounting Standards’ (September 2005) replacing the presentation requirements for financial instruments in AASB 132.  AASB 132 is applicable for annual reporting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2007

·                     AASB 2005-10: ‘Amendments to Australian Accounting Standards’ (September 2005) makes consequential amendments to AASB 132: ‘Financial Instruments: Disclosure and Presentation’, AASB 101: ‘Presentation of Financial Statements’, AASB 114: ‘Segment Reporting’, AASB 117: ‘Leases’, AASB 133: ‘Earnings per Share’, AASB 139 ‘Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement’, AASB 1, AASB 4, AASB 1023: ‘General Insurance Contracts’ and AASB 1038: ‘Life Insurance Contracts’ arising from the release of AASB 7.  AASB 2005-10 is applicable for annual reporting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2007.

The initial application of AASB 7 and AASB 2005-10 are not expected to have an impact on the financial results of the Group as the standard and the amendment are only concerned with disclosures.  AASB 7 requires the disclosure of the significance of financial instruments for an entity’s financial position and performance and of qualitative and quantitative information about exposure to risks arising from financial instruments.  AASB 2005-10 amendments arise from the release of AASB 7 and are only applicable when an entity adopts AASB 7.

The initial application of AASB 2005-9 could have an impact on the financial results of the Group as the amendment could result in liabilities being recognised for financial guarantee contracts that have been provided for by the Group.  The impact of application of AASB 2005-9 has not yet been quantified.

AASB 2005-1 does not permit the foreign currency risk of a highly probable intragroup forecast transaction to qualify as the hedged item.  The initial application of AASB 2005-1 could have an impact on the financial results of the Group.  An exercise to quantify the financial impact is currently being undertaken by the Group.

122




 

(xxiv)      Recently issued United States accounting standards

The following Standards will impact ANZ from 1 October 2006:

·                     Summary of Statement No. 154 Accounting Changes and Error Corrections “FAS 154” was issued in May 2005 and replaces APB Opinion No. 20, Accounting Changes, and FASB Statement No. 3, Reporting Accounting Changes in Interim Financial Statements, and changes the requirements for the accounting for and reporting of a change in accounting principle.

Opinion 20 previously required that most voluntary changes in accounting principle be included as a cumulative adjustment to net income in the period of the change to the new accounting principle.  FAS 154 requires retrospective application to prior periods’ financial statements of changes in accounting principle, unless it is impracticable to determine either the period-specific effects or the cumulative effect of the change.  The Group does not expect that adoption of FAS 154 will have a material impact to total shareholders’ equity and net income for US GAAP purposes since the adoption of FAS 154 will contribute to the alignment of International Financial Reporting Standards and US GAAP.

·                     Summary of Statement No. 155 Accounting for Certain Hybrid Financial Instruments (“FAS 155”) was issued in February 2006 and amends FASB Statements No. 133, Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities, and No. 140, Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities.

The new Standard permits fair value re-measurement for any hybrid financial instrument that contains an embedded derivative that otherwise would require bifurcation.  It also requires all entities to evaluate interests in securitised financial assets to identify interests that are freestanding derivatives or that are hybrid financial instruments that contain an embedded derivative.  The impact of application of this FAS 155 has not yet been quantified, however is not expected to be material to the Group.

·                     Summary of Statement No. 156 Accounting for Servicing of Financial Assets (“FAS 156”) was issued in March 2006 and amends FASB Statement No. 140, Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities, with respect to the accounting for separately recognised servicing assets and servicing liabilities.  FAS 156 requires an entity to recognise a servicing asset or servicing liability each time it undertakes an obligation to service a financial asset by entering into a servicing contract.  This asset or liability must be initially recognised at fair value, if practicable.  Subsequently, measurement is permitted via an amortisation or fair value method.  The impact of application of FAS 156 is not expected to be material to the Group.

·                     In November 2005, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position (“FSP”) FAS 115-1, “The Meaning of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment and Its Application to Certain Investments”.  The FSP nullifies the accounting guidance relating to the recognition of investment portfolio other-than-temporary impairments of EITF 03-01, “The Meaning of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment and Its Application to Certain Investments”; carries forward the disclosure requirements included in the EITF 03-01 which have been effective and applied by the Group; supersedes EITF Topic No. D-44, “Recognition of Other-Than-Temporary Impairment upon the Planned Sale of a Security Whose Cost Exceeds Fair Value”; and references existing other-than-temporary impairment guidance including FAS 115, “Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities and SEC Staff Accounting Bulletin Topic 5M, “Other-Than-Temporary Impairment of Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities”. The FSP is effective from 1 October, 2006 and is not expected to have a material impact on the Group’s US GAAP equity and net income.

123




 

DEFINITIONS

 

Adjusted common equity (ACE) is Tier 1 capital less preference shares and other Hybrid Capital at current rates and regulatory deductions from total capital.

 

AIFRS - Australian Equivalents of International Accounting Standards

 

Business Unit description:

 

Personal Banking Australia

-            Banking Products manufactures deposit, transaction account and margin lending products.

-            Consumer Finance provides consumer and commercial credit cards, ePayment products, personal loans, and merchant payment and ATM facilities.

-            Mortgages provides mortgage finance secured by residential real estate in Australia.

-            Rural Commercial and Agribusiness Products provides a full range of banking services to personal customers across Australia, and to small business and agricultural customers in rural Australia.

-            Investment & Insurance Products comprises the equity accounted earnings from INGA’s core business operations (excludes investment earnings), the Financial Planning distribution business, margin lending, the trustee business and E*Trade.

-            Other includes the branch network, whose costs are fully recovered from product business units, Private Banking and marketing and support costs.

 

Institutional

-            Client Relationship Group manages customer relationships and develops financial services solutions and strategies for large businesses with a turnover greater than $100 million in Australia and New Zealand and, through corporate clients where the Group has an existing customer relationship, in the United Kingdom, United States and Asia.

-            Corporate and Structured Financing provides complex financing and advisory services, structured financial products, leasing, private equity, project and leveraged finance and infrastructure investment to ANZ’s Institutional, Corporate and Small Business customers.

-            Debt Product Group manages Institutional’s balance sheet with particular focus on credit quality, diversification and maximising risk adjusted returns.

-            Markets provides origination, underwriting, structuring, risk management, advice and sale of credit and derivative products, foreign exchange and commodity trading and sales-related services globally.

-            Trade and Transaction Services provides cash management, trade finance, international payments, clearing and custodian services principally to institutional and corporate customers.

 

New Zealand Businesses

-            ANZ Retail operating under the ANZ brand in New Zealand provides a full range of banking service to personal and business banking customers.

-            Corporate Banking in New Zealand incorporates the ANZ and NBNZ brands, and provides financial solutions through a relationship management model for medium-sized businesses with a turnover up to NZD100 million.

-            National Bank Retail operating under the National Bank brand in New Zealand, provides a full range of banking services to personal customers from youth through to private banking, and business banking customers with turnover up to NZD5 million.

-            NBNZ refers to the operations of the National Bank of New Zealand Limited purchased on 1 December 2003.  These operations were amalgamated with ANZ Banking Group (New Zealand) Limited on 26 June 2004 to form ANZ National Bank Limited (ANZ NB).  NBNZ was reported as a separate business unit until 30 September 2004.

-            Rural Banking in New Zealand provides a full range of banking services to rural and agribusiness customers.

 

Corporate Australia

-            Business Banking in Australia provides a full range of banking services to metropolitan-based small to medium businesses, with turnover up to $10 million and business banking funds under management of more than $50,000.

-            Corporate Banking Australia manages customer relationships and develops financial solutions for medium-sized businesses with a turnover of $10 million to $150 million.

-            Small Business Banking in Australia provides business banking services to metropolitan-based small businesses, with business banking funds under management of up to $50,000.

 

Non-continuing Businesses comprises the London headquartered project finance business the run-off of New Zealand conduit transactions and certain structured finance transactions that ANZ has exited as part of its de-risking strategy.

 

Group Centre

-            Treasury is the banker to all ANZ businesses charged with providing cashflow support, ensuring liquidity, managing interest rate risk and providing capital to the businesses.

 

Economic loss provisioning (ELP) charge is determined based on the expected average annual loss of principal over the economic cycle for the current risk profile of the lending portfolio.

124




 

DEFINITIONS (continued)

 

Equity standardisation Economic Value Added (EVATM) principles are in use throughout the Group, whereby risk adjusted capital is allocated and charged against business units.  Equity standardised profit is determined by eliminating the impact of earnings on each business unit’s book capital and attributing earnings on the business unit’s risk adjusted capital.  This enhances comparability of business unit performance.  Geographic results are not equity standardised.

 

Impaired assets are those whose carrying value was greater than the amount expected to be recovered over its life.  More specifically, in relation to loans or other credit facilities, impairment may arise where there is reasonable doubt about the collectability of interest, fees (past and future) or principal outstanding, or where concessional terms have been provided because of the financial difficulties of the customer.

 

Income includes external interest income, other external operating income, and if positive and net intersegment interest income.

 

Individual provision charge is the amount of impairment on those loans and advances assessed for impairment on an individual basis (as opposed to on a collective basis).  It takes into account expected cash flow over the lives of those loans and advances.

 

Liquid assets are cash and cash equivalent assets.  Cash equivalent assets are highly liquid investments with short periods to maturity, are readily convertible to cash at ANZ’s option and are subject to an insignificant risk of changes in value.

 

Net advances include gross loans and advances and acceptances less income yet to mature and provisions (for both as at and average volumes).

 

Net inter business unit expenses - consists of the charges made between business units for the provision of support services.  Both payments and receipts by business units are shown as net inter business unit expenses.

 

Net interest margin is net interest income as a percentage of average interest earning assets.  Non-assessable interest income is grossed up to the equivalent before tax amount for the purpose of these calculations.

 

Net interest spread is the average interest rate received on interest earning assets less the average interest rate paid on interest bearing liabilities.  Non-assessable interest income is grossed up to the equivalent before tax amount for the purpose of these calculations.

 

Net non-interest bearing items, referred to in the analysis of interest spread and net interest average margin, includes shareholders’ equity, impairment of loans and advances, and deposits not bearing interest and other liabilities not bearing interest, offset by premises and equipment and other non-interest earning assets.  Impaired loans are included within interest bearing loans, advances and bills discounted.

 

Net tangible assets equals share capital and reserves attributable to shareholders of the company less preference share capital and unamortised intangible assets (including software).

 

Operating expenses exclude the provision for impairment of loans and advances charge.

 

Operating income in business segments includes equity standardised net interest and other operating income.

 

Overseas Markets includes all operations outside of Australia and New Zealand.  The Group’s geographic segments are Australia, New Zealand and Overseas Markets.

 

Profit on a fully comparable AIFRS basis is management’s estimate of prior year results adjusted for the impact of those AIFRS standards, principally financial instrument and insurance related, which became effective from 1 October 2005.  No adjustment has been made to retrospectively designate derivatives hedging the Group’s funding on the basis of impracticability.

 

Return on asset ratios include net intra group assets which are risk weighted at 0% for return on risk weighted assets calculations.

 

Significant items are items that have a material impact (typically >$10 million) on profit after tax, or the earnings used in the earnings per share calculation.  Significant items also do not arise in the normal course of business and are infrequent in nature.  Divestments are typically defined as significant items.

 

Total advances include gross loans and advances and acceptances less income yet to mature (for both as at and average volumes).  Loans and advances classified as available-for-sale are excluded from total advances.

 

Unproductive facilities comprise facilities (such as standby letters of credit, bill endorsements, documentary letters of credit, guarantees to third parties, undrawn facilities to which the Group is irrevocably committed and market related exposures) where the customer status is non-accrual.

 

 

125




 

ALPHABETICAL INDEX

 

 

PAGE

 

Associates, joint venture entities and investments

 

92

 

Average balance sheet and related interest

 

84

 

Business Performance Review

 

38

 

Capital management

 

82

 

Chief Financial Officer’s Review

 

8

 

Changes in the composition of the Group

 

92

 

Contingent liabilities and contingent assets

 

89

 

Consolidated Condensed Cash flow statement

 

60

 

Consolidated Condensed Income Statement

 

57

 

Consolidated Condensed Balance Sheet

 

58

 

Consolidated Condensed Statement of recognised income and expense

 

59

 

Definitions

 

111

 

Derivative financial instruments

 

72

 

Dividends

 

70

 

Earnings per share

 

71

 

Exchange rates

 

93

 

Financial Highlights

 

2

 

Four year summary by half year

 

52

 

Geographic Segment Performance

 

51

 

Highlights

 

1

 

Impact of adopting Australian Equivalents to International Financial Reporting Standards (AIFRS)

 

94

 

Impaired financial assets

 

76

 

Income

 

67

 

Income tax expense

 

69

 

Interest spreads and net interest average margins

 

87

 

Loan capital

 

79

 

Net loans and advances

 

74

 

Note to the Cash Flow Statement

 

91

 

Operating expenses

 

68

 

Provision for credit impairment

 

78

 

Segment analysis

 

88

 

Share Capital

 

79

 

Shareholders’ Equity

 

80

 

Significant accounting policies

 

61

 

Significant events since balance date

 

93

 

US GAAP reconciliation

 

109

 

 

126